Physics for CAPE® Unit 1 Physics for Terry Joyce CAPE® David Crichlow Dwight Carlos de Freitas Hunte Unit 1 3 Great Clarendon Oxford It University furthers and Oxford The © Terry This published rights in means, Press, as Enquiries should must impose British Data by © the No the the sent prior the and Oxford of in in de permitted by law, scholarship, registered other trade mark countries Carlos Hunte 2012 2014 2012 Press by any of licence rights outside Department, in may in writing reprographics reproduction Oxford. asserted publication in a of research, Freitas, Press transmitted, permission in is certain been Ltd University Oxford University this or the Dwight have Thornes Rights of Kingdom excellence University authors appropriate to UK United the 2014 be or Oxford or by any University under terms organization. scope Oxford reproduced, form of the University above Press, at above. not this the part of worldwide. Crichlow, by 6DP, department system, expressly OX2 objective Oxford Nelson concerning be address You of retrieval with a in Joyce published without or agreed Press reserved. a is publishing David, rights edition stored the by illustrations moral First Press Oxford, University’s University Original All the education Text Street, circulate same Library this work condition Cataloguing on in in any any other form and you must acquirer Publication Data available 978-1-4085-1761-1 10 9 8 7 Printed 6 5 in 4 Great Britain by Ashford Colour Press Ltd., Gosport Acknowledgements Cover photograph: Mark Lyndersay, Lyndersay Digital, Trinidad www.lyndersaydigital.com Illustrations: Page Although we copyright cases. the If and the to for the third party information work. ii made every before Services, Publishing effort publication publisher will to Tonbridge, Services, trace this has rectify and not any Kent Tonbridge, contact been errors Kent all possible or in omissions opportunity. materials this have notied, Publishing GreenGate holders earliest Links GreenGate make-up: websites only. contained are provided Oxford in any by disclaims third party Oxford any in good faith responsibility website referenced for in all at of Contents Introduction Module 1 Chapter 1 1. 1 1 Chapter 6 Work, 6. 1 Work and 6.2 Energy SI quantities Dimension 1.3 Scalar and units 42 and unit analysis Measurements 1 2.2 Measurements 2 2.3 Errors 2.4 Uncertainties Circular Chapter 3 Kinematics 3.2 Equations of 3.3 Projectile motion 7 . 1 Motion in a circle 7 .2 Examples of circular motion 1 50 7 .3 Examples of circular motion 2 52 Gravitation 8. 1 Gravitational field 8.2 Gravitational 54 12 measurements potential and satellites 56 14 Revision questions 3 58 Module exam questions 60 1 Practice 16 motion 20 motion 22 Module 2 Oscillations Chapter 9 and waves Oscillations 9. 1 Free oscillations 9.2 Amplitude, 9.3 A 62 Dynamics Dynamics 1 26 4.2 Dynamics 2 28 4.3 Collisions simple period and frequency pendulum mass–spring and 64 a system 66 32 9.4 Revision questions 1 Resonance 68 34 Chapter 10 Refraction Forces 10. 1 Archimedes’ principle, friction Refraction 72 and Revision questions terminal velocity Polygon of forces 4 74 36 and gravity Torque 48 10 4. 1 Chapter 5 46 Kinematics 3. 1 Chapter 4 2 8 measurements in 44 6 Chapter 8 in power 4 Measurements 2. 1 and 2 and vector quantities Chapter 2 5.3 power energy Revision questions Physical quantities and units 1.2 5.2 and Mechanics Chapter 7 5. 1 energy centre of Chapter 11 Waves 38 and moment 11. 1 Waves 76 11.2 Transverse 11.3 Superposition 11.4 Interference 11.5 Interference 40 and longitudinal waves and diffraction 78 82 86 experiments 88 iii Contents 11.6 Measuring the wavelength of 11.7 Stationary 11.8 Sound 11.9 Electromagnetic light waves 90 92 waves Chapter 17 The first law of thermodynamics 94 waves Revision questions 17 . 1 The first 17 .2 Molar law of thermodynamics 5 heat capacities and p–V 98 diagrams 144 Revision questions Chapter 12 12. 1 The The physics of physics of Chapter 13 The 100 physics of Chapter 18 Thermal 18. 1 Thermal 18.2 Measuring thermal 102 18.3 Radiation 13.2 The 104 18.4 Global eye Practice energy transfer conduction Lenses 2 146 and convection 148 sight 13. 1 Module 8 hearing hearing Revision questions 140 96 6 exam questions warming and thermal 108 Revision questions applications of energy transfer Chapter 19 152 154 106 Module 3 Thermal and mechanical conductivity 158 9 Phases of 160 matter properties of matter 19. 1 Chapter 14 Temperature 14.2 Thermometers kinetic and Temperature 14. 1 A and temperature 19.2 Pressure 19.3 Hooke’s Thermal 164 law and the 19.5 energy modulus and specific Experiment to determine the Elastic modulus and plastic deformation Revision questions Module methods for heat Measuring by using a capacities Latent 15.5 Measuring specific heat method of capacities mixing heat 3 specific latent heats iv and Analysis and interpretation Analysis and interpretation: 7 176 gases 178 physical constants 180 and the Glossary gases kinetic theory of exam questions 132 Index The Analysis 130 kinetic theory 16.2 174 124 List of Ideal exam questions interpretation Practice Ideal Practice 126 Revision questions 16. 1 172 120 20. 1 15.4 Chapter 16 10 measuring Chapter 20 15.3 170 118 Electrical specific 168 heat capacity 15.2 166 properties Young Internal 162 114 matter 15. 1 liquids scales 110 19.4 of solids, gases Young Chapter 15 model for 134 gases 136 181 185 Introduction This Study Guide has been developed exclusively with the Caribbean ® Examinations candidates, Council both in (CXC and out ) of to be used school, as an additional following the resource Caribbean by Advanced ® Proficiency Examination It prepared (CAPE ) programme. ® has been teaching and by a team examination. with The expertise contents are in the CAPE designed to syllabus, support learning ® by providing the features and for guidance this activities On ᔢ of Y ourself you problem ᔢ to This an in an for Do examiner will show the key to your includes and concepts syllabus format! electronic techniques: examination-style candidate answers short answers could understanding, be skill level questions. designed questions study which where your specifically refer Physics examination example examination examination inside to build to the examination sample with CAPE master and CD good provide questions, are to in remember interactive developing activities you best requirements answering sections are questions as is in your and guide so to provide helpful that experience feedback you can will revise areas. Answers work syllabus. activities multiple-choice refer easier course type from achieve it activities These confidence T est the the essay feedback you make you Marks and improved. and help Guide assist Y our and of on Study to answer to included requirements full Inside ᔢ tools you unique examination included that on require the CD for calculations, multiple-choice so that you can questions check your and own proceed. combination practice will of focused provide syllabus you with content invaluable and interactive support to help you ® reach your full potential in CAPE Physics. 1 1 Physical 1. 1 SI quantities Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this quantities and recall the section, you A physical can to: SI base units units Physical quantities be quantities quantity measured product ᔢ and of a is with the an numerical property of instrument. magnitude an It and a object is or a typically unit. For phenomenon expressed example, as that the suppose and a student measures his mass and records it as 55 kg. The numerical units magnitude ᔢ determine the units of in this case is 55. The unit of mass is the kilogram (kg). derived quantities SI ᔢ recall commonly ᔢ convert ᔢ define used base quantities Scientists units the mole Avogadro’s Le and and recall worldwide Système or SI In this have agreed Internationale units. All scientific on d’Unites a common (The measurements system of International are made units System using these known of as Units) units. the system there are seven base units which have been defined in constant. such a way represent that the they can standard be size Derived quantities Table 1.1.1 units prefixes easily of a and reproduced particular (T able physical 1.1.1). These units quantity. units SI base quantities and units Physical Physical Symbol quantities other than the base quantities are known as Unit derived quantities (T able 1.1.2). A derived quantity is derived from a quantity combination Mass m kilogram (kg) the of base relationship It is v = defined by quantities. between the the The base following corresponding quantities. unit Speed is a is derived derived from quantity. equation: s Length l metre (m) where v is speed, s is distance travelled and t is the time taken. t Time t second Temperature T kelvin Electric I ampere (s) From the Time is definition, also a base distance quantity a base quantity with is unit s with unit m (metre). (second). (K) s m –1 v = = (A) t = m s s current –1 The Amount of n mole SI unit for speed is therefore m s (mol) Table 1.1.2 Derived quantities and derived units substance Derived quantity Luminous I Relationship Derived intensity unit Name of candela in v base units (cd) 2 Area (A) length × length length × length m – 3 Volume (V) × length m – –3 Density (ρ) mass/volume kg m displacement/time m s – –1 Velocity (v) – –2 Acceleration (a) velocity/time m s – –2 Force (F) mass × acceleration kg m s Work (W) force × distance kg m 2 –2 s 2 Power (P) Charge (Q) work/time kg m current A s × time 2 (V) power/current kg m joule –3 s watt coulomb 2 Voltage newton –3 s –1 A volt unit Chapter 1 Physical quantities and units Prefixes In order to measured avoid is too writing small too or many too zeroes large, when prefixes are a quantity used. being T able 1.1.3 Table 1.1.3 lists Prefix commonly used List of commonly used prefixes the Multiplying Symbol prefixes. factor Examples: –12 pico 10 nano 10 micro 10 p 3 6.2 kilometres 6.2 km = 6.2 × 10 m –9 n –3 2.9 milliamperes 2.9 mA = 2.9 × 10 A 4.1 μm = 4.1 × 10 –6 μ –6 4.1 micrometre m –3 milli 10 centi 10 deci 10 kilo 10 m –12 100 picofarads 100 pF = 100 × 10 3 MW = 3 10 F –2 c 6 3 megawatts × W –1 d 3 Conversion of k units 6 Physics key to exists often requires converting between that between them. you convert units The is to following from first one unit determine examples will to another . the relationship illustrate this mega 10 giga 10 tera 10 M The that 9 G point. 12 T Example –1 a Convert –1 80 km h to m s 2 b Convert 2.5 mm 2 to m –3 c Convert a 80 km h –3 7.9 g cm to kg m 3 80 × 3 10 m 80 × 10 m –1 –1 = = = 1 h 60 × 2 b 22.2 m s 60 s –3 1 mm = 1 mm × 1 mm = 1 × = 2.5 10 –3 m × 2 ∴ 1 × –6 2.5 mm × 1 × 10 10 –6 m = 2.5 × 1 × 2 10 –6 m = 10 2 m 2 m –3 7.9 g 7.9 × 10 kg –3 c –3 7.9 g cm = = = –6 1 cm The One mole of the substance × 1 cm × 1 cm 1 and the Avogadro base can quantities refer to the is ‘the of 10 7900 kg m 3 m constant amount number × of substance’. particles, number The of amount molecules of Key points or 23 number This of ions. number is The number called the in this Avogadro case refers constant to (N a value of 6.02 × 10 . ᔢ ) A physical quantity consists of A the The of mole is particles the as amount there are of in substance 12 grams ( n) of that contains the same product of a numerical value number and a unit. The base carbon-12. ᔢ quantities are mass, 23 ∴1 mol = 6.02 × 10 particles length, The amount given by N of = particles ( N) present in an amount of substance ( n) time, current, is and nN temperature, amount luminous of substance intensity. A ᔢ All other physical quantities are Example derived from Calculate the number of molecules present in 1.2 moles of helium the base quantities. gas. ᔢ Prefixes are used as shorthand, 23 1 mol = 6.02 × 10 for 23 ∴ 1.2 mol = 1.2 × 6.02 × 10 small 23 = 7.224 × 10 writing molecules helium very large or very quantities. of gas ᔢ The mole is equivalent to 23 6.02 × 10 particles. 3 1.2 Dimension Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this and Dimension of section, you The dimension physical to: lists ᔢ recall the dimensions unit of of quantity some of the analysis physical quantities a physical and the quantity base dimensions shows quantities of the base the listed relation in T able between 1.1.1. the T able 1.2.1 quantities. base Table 1.2.1 Dimensions of base q uantities quantities Base ᔢ determine derived ᔢ the dimensions quantities understand the dimensional physical quantity Dimension of importance Mass [M] Length [L] Time [T] Temperature [θ] Electric [A] of analysis. The the current dimensions of relationship derived between physical the quantities corresponding can base be determined quantities is once known. For example, mass [M] –3 density = = = [M L ] 3 volume [L ] –3 The dimension T able 1.2.2 Table 1.2.2 Derived for lists density some is therefore derived [M L physical ]. quantities and their dimensions. Dimensions of derived q uantities physical quantity Dimension 2 Area [L] Volume [L] Density [M L Acceleration [L T Power [M L 3 –3 ] –2 ] 2 –3 T ] Importance of dimensions Dimensions can 1 T o deduce 2 T o check In any the the scientific must equal units are to not be dimensions equation, the of units same, of the on derived an units the then a on the equation s = ut the right-hand the equation + quantity (as shown previously). equation. 1 Consider units used homogeneity the and left-hand side is of the side of the equation. equation If the incorrect. 2 at . It represents the displacement 2 s of a body (where a is after are t, constant). displacement there time two is the where On metre the u is initial left-hand (m). On the velocity side of and the right-hand a is acceleration equation side of the the unit equation terms. –1 The unit for The unit for ut is 1 4 × 2 at 2 m s s = –2 = m s m 1 2 × s = m (The coefficient is 2 of ignored.) Chapter The two unit on terms Since the units on the are being unit the right-hand on side of the equation is m, even though 1 Physical quantities and units the added. the left-hand right-hand side side of the of the equation equation, the is equal equation to is the said to be homogeneous. An equation that is not homogeneous An equation that is homogeneous is may not not cor rect. necessarily be 1 Suppose the same equation above is rewritten as s cor rect. 2 = at . The units on 2 both sides incorrect 3 T o of string is length that x x, T y it the is is y are of the a same (i.e. m). However , units that tension the in velocity the string v T, of a wave mass of on the are of v of T The units of m The units of l = and the dimensions of v = [L T ] = kg m the –2 ∝ [M] x considering M L term T term the + x ] y x + each we in the = x + y 1 = x + z –1 = –2 x of of l m = suggested these T = = [M L T ] [M] [L] relationship we get z –2x [T] the one at a time equations on the left-hand side and following Exam tip 1 Solving of [L] dimension get dimensions dimensions z [L] the dimensions y [M] 0 term the dimensions [M L T side, and and and ∝ right-hand –2 kg m s = –1 Now and –1 m s –1 ] m l constants. = units [L T stretched z The ] a string –2 [L T is l z Considering equation term. –1 The the equations. suggested to the missing form string m and it the related of ∝ equation because predict Suppose v the we get x = 1 , y = – 2 1 , z = 2 2 To T l ½ The equation now becomes v ∝ T –½ m ½ l or v check correct, left-hand side limitation of this method of trying to predict the form of an equation of it cannot equation can determine only be the verified value of the if an equation the units is on the constant of proportionality. side the and the equation. If right-hand they are the is same, that see ∝ m A to determine the equation is homogeneous. This experimentally. Key points ᔢ The dimension of mass, length ᔢ The dimension of derived and time quantities can are be [M], [L] and [T] respectively. determined from base quantities. ᔢ Dimensional ᔢ An equation analysis is can incorrect be if it used is to not check the homogeneity of equations. homogenous. 5 1.3 Scalar and vector Learning outcomes On completion should ᔢ be able of section, you and vector quantities Quantities between scalar A scalar give A vector ᔢ ᔢ add either being a scalar or a vector . magnitude only. has magnitude and direction. of scalar of scalar quantities are mass, length, work, speed, distance, and and power . quantities and and resolve subtract subtract of acceleration, and A be vector end. vectors. can The Scalar are weight, (Figure momentum, velocity, 1.3.1). represented length of the of the arrow and quantities line as a straight represents points in the subtracting are added and line the with an arrow magnitude direction of the of at the one vector . The vector . scalars subtracted numerically . For example, if you vector were interested would perform Mass magnitude of of in finding the the total calculation student = 50 kg, as mass of a student and his back pack you follows: Mass of back pack = 4 kg vector T otal Suppose of Figure 1.3.1 quantities displacement vectors Adding of vector scalars direction direction has quantity Examples add as and energy ᔢ classified quantities examples vector be quantity Examples ᔢ can to: differentiate vector this Scalar quantities representing a vector quantity the mass 90 J of of machine his is is determine input Energy lost Adding and energy Energy Adding student 60 J, = 90 J, inside back supplied Energy the to a the pack 50 machine. energy output machine = = = 90 If lost + 4 the = 54 kg useful inside the energy output machine. 60 J – 60 = 30 J (combining) vectors vector quantities is not as simple as adding scalar quantities. ⃗ b V ector quantities Consider In order drawn ⃗ a ⃗a Figure 1.3.2 ⃗ + b of ⃗a ⃗ b ⃗ – b to Figure 1.3.3 perform ⃗ a ⃗ – b is force a 6 Subtracting two vectors are acting in of the the ⃗ + b form addition, from the drawn on effect the two same is of at ⃗ (– b). point at the is which taken the first of first the same For to the The the vector but then ending ⃗ –b vector point 1.3.3). vector example The ⃗ as b is vector (Figure example ended. length The vector previous drawn. which ⃗a account. ⃗ V ector b ended. vector ⃗a addition. is drawn. resultant Using into 1.3.2. vector ⃗a point vector be Figure vector ⃗a called + to as is ⃗ –b pointing guide then is in the 1.3.4). same direction The an of shown vector ⃗a in the quantity. has starting having (Figure acting (combined a as point saying ⃗a acting vector magnitude Figure 1.3.4 vector direction forces from is as that vectors the vector ⃗a same arrow Vectors two drawn The starting an opposite Force ⃗ ⃗ a – b by simply Adding two vectors the ⃗ and b two from subtraction is drawn ⃗ a these starting then direction vectors ⃗a add ⃗ vector b. V ector ⃗ ⃗ a + b to by is two have unit object both forces. direction. of in forces) In is same can Figure The force the be 1.3.5 resultant the newton direction. found two force by simply forces is (N). The 8 N 3 N to Suppose resultant adding and the 5 N right. the are Chapter Vectors Suppose in acting two Figure forces 1.3.6. Physical acting on resultant of the two forces. The of the two forces. Therefore, an force resultant object is force in found will opposite by act directions subtracting in quantities and units 3 N in opposite directions are The 1 the the direction as 5 N shown magnitude of the larger 8 N the resultant force is 2 N to the right. Figure 1.3.5 Adding vectors acting in the same direction Vectors Suppose Figure The R. forces In force The The must two 1.3.7. 5 N force. acting are order is first be of angle to acting add the force decided at by 4 N R force be For each other angle two of θ vectors, starting can upon. an the drawn of the an to then addition value at from and the to 5 N 4 N ending force by 1 cm other force the determined example, each the shown drawn point results scale can as is of in represent the the drawing. A 1 N. in first. 5 N 3 N 4 N force scale This 2 N means 5 cm that the 4 N respectively. and 5 N force Once the ruler . Suppose scale can be represented drawing is as completed, lengths the 4 cm length and R Figure 1.3.6 is Adding vectors acting in opposite directions measured using a θ = 60°. The length of R will be 7.8 cm. –1 Therefore, R can also R be 2 c = 7.8 cm determined 2 = a × 1 N cm by = 7.8 N. calculation using the cosine rule. 2 + b – 5N 2ab cos θ R 5N 2 c 2 2 = 5 + 4 = 7.8 N – (2 × 5 × 4 × cos 120°) = 61 θ c θ 4N 4N Figure 1.3.7 Finding the resultant of two Resolving vectors vectors acting at an angle to each other A vector can each other . been drawn replaced be replaced Consider using with two the the by x two y origin vectors other plane as the acting at vectors shown in starting right acting Figure point. angles to at right 1.3.8. angles ⃗ vector P The each to ⃗ vector P A can has be other . 5 sin 30° y-axis 1 5 ms ⃗ P 30° 5 cos 30° y-component Figure 1.3.9 θ x-axis O x-component Figure 1.3.8 Key points Resolving a vector into two components ᔢ The horizontal component ( x-component) is found by drawing a A scalar quantity has magnitude vertical only. line from the tip of ⃗ vector P parallel to the y-axis until it meets the x-axis. ᔢ The vertical component ( y-component) is found by drawing a A vector quantity magnitude line from the tip of ⃗ vector P parallel to the x-axis until it has a horizontal meets the and a direction. y-axis. ᔢ Scalar quantities are added and –1 Suppose 30° to a the ball is struck horizontal as such that shown in it travels Figure with a velocity of 5 m s at subtracted ᔢ Vectors account The by horizontal and vertical components can be found by scale drawing calculation. component = 5 × cos 30° = are added their by taking into directions. or ᔢ –1 Horizontal algebraically. 1.3.9. Any vector two vectors can be which resolved act at into right 4.33 m s angles to each other. –1 V ertical component = 5 × cos (90 – 30) = 5 × sin 30° = 2.5 m s 7 2 Measurements 2. 1 Measurements Learning outcomes On completion should ᔢ be able measure rule, lengths vernier measure and this section, using calliper screw weights lever Measuring you to: micrometre ᔢ of 1 a and The metre lengths rule, vernier instruments used length metre is the to calliper measure (m). A and micrometre lengths metre rule in a screw laboratory. would be used gauge The to SI are common unit measure of the width metre of a desk or to measure of a the length of a pendulum. A vernier calliper would be used a the dimensions of a small block of wood or the diameter gauge using a spring the test depends balance ᔢ measure angles ᔢ measure temperature tube. diameter on micrometre a the Measuring using A of piece of magnitude length screw copper of using gauge wire. the would The length a vernier be choice being used of to measure measuring device measured. calliper a Figure 2.1.1 shows a diagram of a vernier calliper . There is a main scale thermometer and ᔢ measure volumes laboratory using standard equipment. a main line vernier scale up scale with that Figure is scale. read the must 2.1.2 Reading is When first. main be = On as main to object the scale. added read an is placed vernier This the gives main between scale, the one of fraction scale. The outside the of markings the vernier jaws, the will millimetre calliper in follows: scale + vernier scale = 56 + 0.7 = 56.7 mm inside jaws main scale vernier scale object 0 outside Figure 2.1.1 10 jaws A vernier calliper Figure 2.1.2 Measuring Figure a 2.1.3 main The shows scale fractional length on scale has micrometre Reading = a the using diagram shaft 50 screw main a micrometre of and a a divisions. gauge scale + in screw micrometre fractional One rotating screw scale on complete Figure 2.1.4 scale Reading a vernier calliper is = a 6.50 gauge. It rotating turn read gauge consists barrel. represents as + 0.50 mm. follows: 0.23 = 6.73 mm 5 0 5 10 15 30 0 45 0 5 25 20 mm 15 Figure 2.1.3 8 A micrometre screw gauge Figure 2.1.4 of The Reading a micrometre screw gauge Chapter Measuring The mass The weight therefore of mass an of be often can be an be often the is object weight measured is Measurements the using using force a a beam exerted spring on balance balance it by (Figure gravity. (Figure 2.1.5). Weight can 2.1.6). angles required that measured trigonometric can object measured Measuring It and 2 by angles taking calculations measured required directly when equilibrium of be measured accurate to determine using in angles. protractors. performing some experiments. measurements ray optic of lengths Where Angles and possible, Measurement experiments or of Figure 2.1.5 using A beam balance angles angles is demonstrating forces. lbs There are optics experiments that require very precise kg measurements 0 0 of angles. In these experiments a spectrometer is used. Figure 1.0 2 2.1.7 4 illustrates a spectrometer . 2.0 6 3.0 8 4.0 10 5.0 12 Measuring temperature 6.0 14 7 .0 16 8.0 T emperature is measured using a thermometer . The SI unit of 18 9.0 20 temperature Celsius is (°C). the kelvin (Refer to (K). 14.2, T emperature is also measured in degrees Thermometers .) Measuring volume The volume of an The volume of regular object is the objects amount can be of space taken determined by up by the object. calculation. Figure 2.1.6 V olume of a cuboid V = V olume of a sphere V = l × b × h (length l, breadth b, height A spring balance h) 4 3 πr (radius of sphere r) 3 2 V olume of cylinder V = πr (radius h of base of cylinder 3 V olume The is volume commonly of displacement of a small an irregularly method. stone. measured shaped Suppose Some in water is you cm are of cylinder h) m can be required into height 3 or object place r, a measured to measure measuring using the cylinder a volume and the Figure 2.1.7 initial final volume volume volume of recorded. recorded. the stone The The (Figure stone is gently difference placed between the into two the water volumes and gives A spectrometer the the 3 2.1.8). measuring 3 cm 500 cylinder 500 Key points 400 ᔢ Standard instruments calliper and the ᔢ Mass measured ᔢ Weight ᔢ Angles ᔢ A ᔢ Temperatures ᔢ The volume of a ᔢ The volume of an used to micrometre measure screw lengths are the metre rule, 400 vernier gauge. 300 is is using measured a using beam a balance spring or an electronic balance. balance. 200 200 water are measured spectrometer is are using used a protractor. when measured regular measuring using object irregularly is a angles optical experiments. 100 object is by method. 100 calculation. determined using a Figure 2.1.8 displacement object thermometer. determined shaped in Measuring volume using a displacement method 9 2.2 Measurements Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this Measuring time section, you The measure time using a clock, and the time base of unit or time of time is the stopwatches. taken for a second Suppose pendulum (s). an to Time durations experiment complete is one are measured performed oscillation. to using measure In order to get stopan watch SI clocks to: the ᔢ 2 accurate value for this time interval, the time taken for 10 oscillations a T is recorded using a stopwatch. The experiment is repeated several 10 cathode-ray oscilloscope times ᔢ measure electrical time quantities and for the one mean (average) oscillation T is time for ten determined oscillations as follows: T is = recorded. T / 10 using standard The 10. laboratory There are instances when the time interval of an event is so small instruments that ᔢ understand calibration ᔢ to how into a to stopwatch oscilloscope use metal curves understand equation how a rearrange cannot (CRO) plates inside frequency is time-base setting can it be be used. used. called attached to the the An instrument The CRO X-plates. X-plates. called consists A sweep This of a a cathode-ray pair generator frequency is of of parallel known adjusted using the an on the front panel of the CRO (Figure 2.2.1). linear form. electron gun cathode deflection anode plates Y-plates grid X-plates fluorescent electron Figure 2.2.1 Figure A screen beam A simple diagram of a cathode-ray oscilloscope 2.2.2 shows a waveform on the screen of a CRO. The time-base B –1 setting is Suppose The calibrated it is at required distance AB is 2 ms cm that 6 cm. the . Each time square interval Therefore, the on the screen between time A interval is and 1 cm B be between × 1 cm. found. A and B –1 6 cm × 2 ms cm Measuring = 12 ms. electrical quantities 1 cm T wo Figure 2.2.2 A waveform on the screen important difference. An electrical electric quantities current is are electric measured cur rent using an and potential instrument called of a CRO an ammeter measured volt (V). type. in In and using The the to a is Calibration that if 10 it had is you no not unit of is the ampere instrument ammeter measurement Suppose an case reference its the scale and the called recorded. recorded as a seen In on A potential voltmeter voltmeter analogue-type is (A). can meter the the be the case of display and an difference its unit analogue is or location of a meter , digital of the the is the digital pointer the instrument. curves were provided markings calibrated. on The with the a mercury-in-glass length of it. thermometer The is thermometer thermometer placed in known is of (A) no use temperatures is Chapter (temperature of pure melting ice 0 °C and the temperature of steam 2 Measurements 100 °C temperature / °C above pure boiling water) and the length of mercury is measured. These calibration curve 100 temperatures are easily reproducible thermometer (B) which is already and chosen calibrated is for this used for reason. Another comparison. Both 80 thermometers and 100 °C. are The placed in substances temperature reading that on have the temperatures calibrated between thermometer (B) 0 °C is 60 recorded A and graph (Figure A. of the the the This the the length calibration mercury against graph is thermometer temperature, from of temperature 2.2.3). When length of curve length the A is the of placed is thermometer mercury calibration mercury to in in a curve then the substance recorded. determine is for the This of (A) recorded. 40 plotted thermometer 20 unknown length unknown is is read off temperature. 0 5 10 15 20 25 length / mm Plotting linear In work practical two a quantities. linear plotted graphs from it If is relationship, against often two required quantities a straight x non-linear to establish and line y are graph relationships related would relationships be such that obtained Figure 2.2.3 between they have when y Exam tip is x Recall The equation A calibration curve of a straight line is of the form y = mx + c, where m is the rules for logarithms the n gradient of the straight line and c is the intercept on the log y-axis. (A) = n log b It is often form of required the that equation an of a expression straight be line. re-written T able 2.2.1 so that shows it resembles some log the (A) + log b A b (B) = log b (AB) b examples. A log (A) – log b (B) = log b b ( B ) Table 2.2.1 Expression What to plot? y x 2 y = constants Gradient y-intercept a and b a (0,b) k and l n (0, lg k) a and b a (0, b) 2 ax + b against Exam tip n T = kl 2 y lg T 2 = ax against lg l 2 + bx y against log is usually written as lg. 10 x x log is usually written as ln, e kt N = Ae ln N against t A and k –k (0, ln A) where e = 2.718 n Suppose T and l are related by the following equation T = kl n lg T = lg (kl ) T ake log on both sides of the equation Key points 10 n lg T = lg k + lg (l lg T = lg k + n lg ) ᔢ A plot of a gradient is Suppose N graph n of and l ← lg T the Linear against lg l y-intercept is form will t are related by the produce a straight line. The ᔢ lg k equation N = N = ln (Ae T ake log on cathode-ray both sides of the used time ᔢ ) measured using a clock to oscilloscope measure very can small intervals. Ae kt ln A be following is stopwatch. kt and Time Electrical current is measured equation e using an ammeter. kt ln N = ln A + ln (e ln N = ln A – kt ln ln N = ln A – kt ) ᔢ e Electrical using ← Linear form ᔢ a Calibration calibrate A plot of gradient a is graph –k of and ln the N against t y-intercept will is ln produce A a straight line. voltage is measured voltmeter. curves are used to instruments. The ᔢ Expressions quantities such can a be involving can way be that a two rearranged linear in graph plotted. 11 or 2.3 Errors in Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this measurements Systematic section, you Whenever there to: be ᔢ differentiate between will a random into identify ways systematic of and reducing random errors This differentiate between a of or is measured, uncertainty systematic large number around of steel some error the and in the random there is the likelihood measurement. er rors . If a Errors physical that can of times, it may be revealed that quantity the is readings is value. known experimenter . ball to fall Some as a readings random Suppose from rest a may error student through a be and larger measures known or usually the vertical smaller . occurs time as a taken distance h. t, The precision distance and a type result for ᔢ quantity error errors errors fluctuate ᔢ an random systematic measured and physical be divided and h is varied and the corresponding time is measured. accuracy. It is known 1 h that h and t are related by the following equation 2 = gt –2 , where g is the acceleration due to free fall (g = 9.81 m s ). 2 √ According h through All the and are relationship, The points the do line. random repeating this this origin. data below there by to the graph not The errors lie the plot on in the the √h against 2.3.1 straight of the finding could will line. a mean taken give plot They from Random the have t shows points experiment. and student of Figure deviation measurements experiment, a in are the of the straight √h be t above indicates can line against scattered line errors several a of that reduced measurements. measurements of In t t for Figure 2.3.1 a given random errors Suppose a obtained All √ height h, and find the average of those times. Graph showing the effect of the different are data student shown points in performs Figure are the same experiment. The results 2.3.2. scattered about the main line. This illustrates a h random origin. In the Either are ᔢ This case all zero However , indicates of a the smaller A This than error Graph showing the effect of error before a systematic error ᔢ An no in longer can when A the For reading is eye 12 easy to way the for to a error constant their true systematic used. the not zeroing error In the in or can this through the error value physical pass experiment. in all one the occur case, quantity the direction. readings because of the is instrument, not if present. possible, long period Instruments are manufacturer being used experimenter quantity, all suppose may on be a by In of to of this time be an makes will be experimenter recorded is as instrument readings as experimenter results scale the the often are as instrument. consistently the and calibrated the the case, 0.2 m to perform the off same by the same accidentally when it is the mistake assumes actually 0.1 m. 1.6 m. accuracy understand game darts. a instrument. a division 1.7 m and consider with of a is being by does experiment. example, smallest Precision An the the the A graph systematic when eliminated used measuring amount. that If a than value. reading techniques experiment. larger the there instrument accurate. Improper is error , calibrated by that there true a be been recommended ᔢ are the gives performing have that their incorrectly may notice systematic readings instrument t Figure 2.3.2 error . of the darts. Figure difference The 2.3.3 between objective illustrates of the the precision game various is to and hit scenarios. accuracy the bull’s Chapter a Precise and accurate Figure 2.3.3 Notice b Precise but not accurate c Accurate but not precise d 2 Measurements Not precise and not accurate A game of darts that accuracy has to do with how close the darts are to the measures the bull’s eye. Precision Suppose has a to do with quantity has how a close true the value of darts x . A are as a student group. 0 quantity a large experiment plotted Figure to is known show 2.3.4 difference number the to times have number illustrates between of times various n using systematic of precision n n, appropriate and a scenarios. and an random particular The errors. reading graphs help x x 0 is obtained. illustrate the x x n 0 x 0 Precise and accurate Figure 2.3.4 graph is n 0 a A x, The accuracy. n 0 instrument. a x 0 x 0 a Precise but not accurate x 0 Accurate but not precise a Not precise and not accurate Experiments having systematic and random errors Key points ᔢ Measurements are accurate ᔢ Measurements are precise if if the the systematic random errors errors are are small. ᔢ Random of small. the result Example Suppose below two students perform an experiment to determine the value for ᔢ errors occur experimenter in an the Random error true errors as a and that is result can above or value. can be reduced –2 the acceleration due to gravity g. g is known to be 9.81 m s . The students by repeat the experiment several times and the value of g is repeating A – 9.80, 9.82, 9.83, 9.81, and recorded. finding Student measurements the mean. 9.82 ᔢ Random errors cannot totally be eliminated. Student B – 8.45, 8.41, 8.42, 8.45, 8.43 ᔢ The results of the experiments performed by student A are both Systematic errors and errors are constant accurate in one direction. precise. ᔢ The results of the experiments performed by student B are precise Systematic errors can be but eliminated. not accurate. ᔢ Precision is a measure reproducibility ᔢ Accuracy closeness to the is a of true of a measure the of the result. of the measured value value. 13 2.4 Uncertainties Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this understand section, you When with to: the terms a fractional error quantity the is in derived quantities measured, measurement. of a metal rod. there Suppose The a metre is an metre rule is error rule able or is to uncertainty used give to associated measure readings to the nearest absolute 0.1 cm. error, measurements Uncertainties length ᔢ in This means that when a reading is taken, the experimenter will and either record to the nearest marking above or below the actual length of percentage error the ᔢ calculate derived the uncertainties quantities. in rod. actual the of The value. smallest the rod 12.40 reading ± This error reading as will on 12.40 cm, be in either the the too measurement metre then 0.05 cm the rule). If a is high or written student information too is as low ±0.05 cm measures recorded from as the the (half length follows: 0.05 cm. The actual or absolute The fractional uncertainty (error) is 0.05 cm. 0.05 or relative uncertainty (error) is = 0.004. 12.40 0.05 The percentage uncertainty × is 100% = 0.4%. 12.40 Adding Consider P = Q = and two subtracting quantities 25.10 ± 62.50 The absolute The fractional ± P and Q 0.05 0.05 uncertainty in P is 0.05 0.05 uncertainty in P is = 0.002 25.10 0.05 The percentage uncertainty in P is × 100% = 0.2% 25.10 The absolute uncertainty The fractional in Q is 0.05 0.05 uncertainty in Q is = 0.0008 62.50 0.05 The percentage uncertainty in Q is × 100% = 0.08% 62.50 Suppose P + Q it and is Q required – P The each absolute + the absolute P + Q absolute the absolute uncertainty in the quantity = 25.1 is + found 62.5 by = 87.6 adding the absolute uncertainties – uncertainty Q = 87.6 ± P = 62.5 – uncertainty is in of + Q is 0.05 + 0.05 = 0.1. 0.1 25.1 found P by = 37.4 adding the absolute uncertainties quantity. Therefore, ∴ 14 Q uncertainty ∴ each find quantity. Therefore, The to P the absolute Q – P uncertainty = 37.4 ± in 0.1 Q – P is 0.05 + 0.05 = 0.1. of Chapter Multiplication, division, Whenever is found quantities by adding are the powers multiplied percentage or and divided Measurements roots the uncertainties 2 percentage of each of the uncertainty quantities involved. Whenever is found a by quantity the uncertainty is quantity Consider P = Q is raised the to a power , power by the the percentage percentage uncertainty uncertainty of the involved. Whenever the quantity multiplying the by following ± 6.24 Determine root of a quantity multiplying is being 1/ n by found, the the percentage percentage uncertainty of involved. 18.2 = nth found 0.1 ± the quantities: 0.02 percentage uncertainties in: P 1 P × 2 Q Q 3 2 3 4 P Q √ Exam tip 0.1 Percentage uncertainty in P is × 100% = 0.5% 18.2 Ensure 0.02 Percentage uncertainty in Q that worked is × 100% = you understand the examples. Uncertainty 0.3% questions 6.24 pose a challenge to students. 1 The percentage uncertainty in P × Q is 0.5 + 0.3 = 0.8% P 2 The percentage uncertainty in is 0.5 + 0.3 is 2 0.5 = 0.8% Q 2 3 The percentage uncertainty in P 4 The percentage uncertainty in × = 1% 1 3 Q is √ × 0.3 = 0.1% 3 Key points Example ᔢ 1 A student wishes to measure the volume V of a wire of length l Measured error obtains the following associated of the wire d = (0.94 ± l = (839 ± an them as the absolute error. 0.04) mm ᔢ Length have with measurements. known Diameter quantities and The absolute error is usually 3) mm taken as half the smallest reading 1 2 The volume V of the wire is given by πd on l the instrument scale. 4 Calculate the percentage uncertainty in the measurement ᔢ of: The fractional absolute i the diameter error the length iii the volume When quantities subtracted, uncertainties uncertainty in the measurement of d = = × ᔢ When or 4% uncertainty in the measurement of l = = in the measurement of V = 2 are ᔢ are multiplied the fractional of the quantities + 8.4% = l added. When a power, Δl d = added. 100% 0.4% Δd uncertainty × 839 l = are quantities divided, uncertainties % added absolute 3 Δl iii are the 100% 0.94 d = % the 0.04 Δd ii by value. V or % the l ᔢ i is divided d measured ii error 2(4) + quantity is raised the fractional to a uncertainty 0.4 of the the quantity is multiplied by power. 15 3 Kinematics 3. 1 Kinematics Kinematics Learning outcomes is considering On completion should be able of this section, define displacement, and represent velocity displacement, and a the speed, acceleration Figure the displacement from under a velocity–time use the time ᔢ use slope graph the graph motion of objects without motion. playing of a in slope to find of a shows travelled displacement only. ends a the up park. path at He the starts taken point by the by the dog. The of the dog. Distance Displacement is, arrow B. at the The point dog. This joining is a however , dotted A, moves A scalar a line path and B the represents quantity vector in gives and quantity. has This a means the displacement– to find and it has a magnitude as well as a direction. It is possible for the dog graph to ᔢ is park 3.1.1 distance that area the the and displacement dog the magnitude find describe acceleration graphically ᔢ to causing speed, around ᔢ used actually you Suppose velocity term is to: Distance ᔢ the what velocity have zero returned but his to displacement the point distance A after his (starting travelled would walk point) have velocity–time a around his the park. displacement non-zero distance If the would dog be had zero, magnitude. travelled acceleration. Definition A Displacement from a fixed is the point in distance a moved stated direction. displacement B Figure 3.1.1 Speed Speed and velocity is defined quantity. you If might total Differentiating between distance and displacement an be as the object rate interested distance of changes travelled in its change its average divided of speed by the distance. several speed. total Speed times The time is a during average taken to scalar its journey, speed is the complete the –1 journey. The SI unit of speed is metres per second Definition Definition Speed is the rate of change of distance. Average initial Equation (m/s speed speed is plus or m s equal to the final Equation s v u = Average speed + v = t 2 –1 v – speed/m s –1 s – distance t – time/s u – initial v – final speed/m s travelled/m –1 16 speed/m s ). half of speed. the Chapter V elocity is defined as the rate of change of displacement. V elocity is 3 Kinematics a –1 vector quantity. The SI unit of velocity Definition Velocity is is metres per second (m s ). 1 Equation the rate of change 25 m s Δs of v = Δt displacement. B –1 v – velocity/m s Δs – change in displacement/m Δt – change in time/s P 1 25 m s A Consider an object P , moving in a circular path at a constant speed of –1 25 m s (Figure 3.1.2). At any point on the circle, the speed of the object –1 is 25 m s . direction The of velocity motion has at the points A and B are different since Figure 3.1.2 An object moving in a circular path the changed. Acceleration Exam tip Acceleration is defined as the rate of change of velocity. An object When the velocity of accelerates therefore when the its velocity direction of changes. motion of Acceleration the object is is a taken vector into quantity consideration. –2 The SI unit of acceleration is metres per second squared (m s increases, the acceleration When the velocity of ). decreases, the Definition an object and is positive. an object acceleration is negative Equation and Acceleration is the rate of change v of a – is referred to as a deceleration. u = t velocity. –2 a – acceleration/m s u – initial –1 velocity/m s –1 v – final t – time/s velocity/m s displacement/m Δ s v = — Δ t Graphical The a motion graph. with of an These object graphs non-uniform equations not representation of of can graphical in a straight particularly acceleration. motion uniform, moving are be If used methods the to motion useful line used to a can when acceleration analyse are in straight be the is motion. analyse represented object is uniform, If line the by moving Δ s the acceleration is motion. Δ t Displacement–time time/s graphs Figure 3.1.3 Suppose a an constant object or P uniform displacement–time The by graph finding Suppose Figure is a the an stationary velocity graph straight gradient object 3.1.4 is is shows in line of a a 3.1.3 through the the straight from point straight Figure dropped the in at a O. It line shows origin. then for moves some the time. motion The of velocity Constant velocity with is The the object. displacement/m determined line. height displacement–time of 2 m graph above for the the ground. motion. The tangent graph for a of this motion is a curve. The object is accelerating uniformly at at –2 rate 9.81 m s . The velocity at any point on the curve is point P determined P by finding The the velocity tangent at gradient at that the of point point. A a P tangent on the tangent is drawn curve a is at that point determined straight line on by drawn the first such curve. drawing that it a t just time/s touches the the velocity curve at the at the point point P . P . The gradient of the tangent is equal to Figure 3.1.4 Non-uniform velocity 17 Chapter 3 Kinematics Velocity–time The motion The area object. the of an under The a graphs object can be velocity–time gradient of a represented graph using measures velocity–time graph a velocity–time graph. the displacement of measures the the acceleration of object. Consider The Figure various 3.1.5. sections It of represents the graph OA – a velocity–time can The be described object graph. as accelerates follows. uniformly from rest. –1 v /m s AB – BC – CD area object is travelling The object decelerates at constant velocity. – The object is uniformly. stationary . Its velocity is zero. 1 DE D O The B A – The object reverses direction and F C accelerates uniformly from The decelerates rest. t /s area 2 EF – object comes to uniformly and then rest. E Figure 3.1.5 The acceleration gradient The of area the at any curve under a at point that in the journey is found by finding the point. velocity–time graph measures displacement. Area 1 gives the displacement of the object from O to C. Area 2 gives the displacement of the object from D to F . Example Figure 3.1.6 shows the velocity–time graph for a journey lasting 1 v /m s R S 20 Q P 10 B A C E D t /s 0 -10 T Figure 3.1.6 Use 18 the information from the graph to find: i the velocity ii the acceleration during iii the acceleration between iv the distance travelled between 10 and 20 seconds v the distance travelled between 20 and 40 seconds. 10 seconds after the the first 40 start 10 and of the journey seconds 45 seconds 50 seconds. Chapter 3 Kinematics –1 i v ii acceleration = 10 m s 10 – 0 10 – 0 20 – (–10) –2 = gradient of line OP = = 1 m s –2 iii acceleration = gradient of line ST = = 40 iv Distance travelled = Area B v Distance travelled = Area C =10 + × 10 Area – = –3 m s 50 100 m D 1 = (10 + 20)10 + (20 × 10) = 150 + 200 = 350 m 2 Example Suppose surface hence a ball and is dropped bounces deduce the from several a fixed times. height Sketch acceleration–time graph above the for the ground velocity–time the motion on a graph of the metal and ball. velocity The initial increases velocity of uniformly the ball because is zero. gravity As the makes it ball falls, its accelerate velocity at a constant –1 rate of in short a 9.81 m s highest again. Figure time point. The . When interval. The ball it Its the graph Acceleration metal velocity changes velocity–time 3.1.7. hits is surface, decreases direction for the defined until again motion as the it and of rate changes it its the of is direction zero at velocity ball is change the increases shown of in velocity. The time gradient of a velocity–time graph gives acceleration. The straight line Figure 3.1.8 portions of the velocity–time graph represent constant acceleration. displacement 1 v /m s t /s time Figure 3.1.9 2 a /m s Key points ᔢ Displacement is the distance t /s moved in ᔢ Speed is ᔢ Velocity a a particular scalar and direction. quantity. acceleration are Figure 3.1.7 vector ᔢ Example Figure Velocity 3.1.8 motion shows velocity–time graph for the motion of a car . of of the car and sketch the displacement–time graph for car velocity the of change of Acceleration accelerates for is the rate of change velocity. car . some uniformly time. The from car rest. then The car decelerates then travels uniformly a constant until it The slope graph of a displacement–time measures velocity. comes ᔢ to rate the ᔢ The the Describe of motion is displacement. ᔢ the quantities. The slope of a velocity–time rest. graph Figure 3.1.9 shows the displacement–time measures acceleration. graph. ᔢ The area graph under a measures velocity–time displacement. 19 3.2 Equations Learning outcomes of motion Derivation of the equations of motion –1 On completion of this section, you Consider an object P , initially travelling at u m s . It then accelerates –2 should be able uniformly to: t ᔢ derive ᔢ use the the solve equations equations of of seconds at to a rate do so of a m s and P –1 to travels achieve a final velocity through a distance of s of v m s metres . It takes (Figure 3.2.1). motion motion to u a v P problems. s Figure 3.2.1 When An object P moving with uniform acceleration deriving the equations of motion, the following assumptions are made. 1 The acceleration 2 The motion The is in velocity–time Acceleration is is a uniform straight graph defined for as (constant). line. the the motion rate of of P change is shown of in Figure 3.2.2. velocity. 1 velocity /m s v Therefore, a – u = t Rearranging this equation we get the following: v ∴ The v = u + displacement at of Displacement P (1) is given by = area under = area of s and is the area under the v– t graph. graph u rectangle + area of triangle 1 0 t s = (u × t) + ( × t(v – × t(at) u) 2 ) time /s But Figure 3.2.2 from equation 1, v – u = at Velocity–time graph for the motion of P 1 s = (u × t) + ( 2 ) 1 2 ∴ s = ut + at (2) 2 v From Equation 1, t – u = a Substituting this v ∴ s = u ( – into + ) v a 2 (2) we get the ( – u ) a 2 2u(v Exam tip ∴ s – u) + (v = – 2 u) 2uv under that you which the know the conditions equations Rearranging, of 2 v motions are 2u 2 + v we get the 2 – 2uv + 2 u v 2 – u = 2a 2a following: 2 – u = 2as = u applicable. 2 v 20 – = 2a Ensure following: 2 1 u a Equation 2 + 2as (3) Chapter Using the equations of 3 Kinematics motion Example –2 A car starts maintains comes to from a rest and constant rest in accelerates speed for 90 s. at a The rate of brake 2.5 m s is then for 5.2 s. applied and It the car 6 s. Calculate: i the maximum ii the total i v ii Distance velocity distance of the car travelled. –1 = u + at = 0 + travelled (2.5 × during 5.2) the = 13 m s acceleration stage is determined as follows: –1 u = 0 m s –2 , a = 2.5 m s , t = 1 5.2 s 1 2 s = ut + 2 at = (0 × 5.2) + Distance = travelled during the stage where 13 m s the , t = 90 s, = (13 a = ut 2 at × 90) + (0)(90) = travelled 13 m s v a – 1170 m during the deceleration stage: –1 , t = 0 u 6 s, – v = 0 m s 13 –2 = = = – 2.17 m s 6 t 2 = 2 –1 u constant: 1 + 2 Distance is 0 m s 2 = velocity –2 1 s 33.8 m 2 –1 u = (2.5)(5.2) 2 2 v = u + 2 2as 2 (0) s = (13) = 38.9 m T otal + distance 2(– 2.17) s travelled = 33.8+ 1170 + 38.9 = 1242.7 m Example Exam tip –1 A ball is thrown Neglecting air vertically resistance, upwards with an initial velocity of 12 m s . determine: When an upwards i the distance travelled by the ball after the velocity iii the time iv the maximum of the ball after and air is thrown vertically resistance is ignored, 0.8 seconds the ii object acceleration is equal to –g 0.8 seconds –2 (– 9.81 m s taken for the ball to reach its maximum When height reached by the ). height an object is released and ball. falls vertically downwards, its –2 [g = 9.81 m s ] –2 acceleration resistance Since the ball is thrown upwards, it decelerates. The acceleration of is is g (9.81 m s ) if air ignored. the –2 ball is – 9.81 m s 1 1 2 i s = ut + at 2 = (12 × 0.8) + 2 (– 9.81)(0.8) = 6.46 m 2 Key point –1 ii v iii At = u the + at = 12 maximum v = u + 0 = 12 t = + (– 9.81 height v = × 0 0.8) = 4.15 m s ᔢ The for at line + (– 9.81 × equations objects at a of motion travelling constant in a are used straight acceleration. t) 12 = 1.22 s 9.81 2 iv v 2 = u + 2 (0) 2as 2 = (12) + 2(– 9.81) s 2 (12) s = = 2 × 7.33 m 9.81 21 3.3 Projectile Learning outcomes On completion should ᔢ be show able that of this Projectile section, you Suppose a motion ball is projected with a velocity V at an angle of θ to the horizontal. to: the motion path taken by a The horizontal component is given by V = V cos θ H projectile is parabolic The vertical component is given by V = V sin θ V ᔢ perform calculations involving Figure projectile 3.3.1 shows the variation with time of the horizontal and vertical motion. components. vertical by The force component gravity and of of gravity the remains ball. acts The constant, vertically horizontal provided and only affects component that air is resistance the unaffected is ignored. –1 v /m s If air resistance longer v sin θ The In is taken into account, the horizontal component is no constant. path order taken to by the analyse ball is parabolic projectile as motion, shown the in Figure horizontal 3.3.2. and vertical v v cos θ H motion are treated separately. v 0 = v sin θ V v t /s v V θ Figure 3.3.1 Variation of the horizontal v = v cos θ H and vertical components with time v sin θ v v H h max v V θ v cos θ Figure 3.3.2 A projectile Showing that the path taken by a projectile is parabolic Object projected horizontally (Figure 3.3.3) Suppose above a the ball is projected horizontally with a velocity v at a height h ground. 1 velocity /m s The horizontal component v = v H v If air the resistance is acceleration The horizontal is ignored, this component remains constant. Therefore, zero. displacement x at time t is given by h 1 2 x = (v)t + (0)t = (v)t 2 x ∴ t = (1) v Figure 3.3.3 horizontally 22 An object projected Initial vertical component of velocity v = V 0 Chapter The vertical displacement y at time t is given 3 Kinematics by 1 2 y = (0)t + (– g)t (2) 2 [Assuming the that positive acceleration Substituting due to Equation velocity gravity (1) x y = (0) ( v into Equation (2): x (– g) 2 that – g.] 1 + ) means becomes ( v the ball is moving upwards, 2 ) g 2 ∴ y = – ( ) 2 2v x 2 This equation is a parabola of the form y = – ax Exam tip Object projected at an angle (Figure 3.3.2) Suppose a ball is projected with a velocity v at an angle of θ to the When asked to find the velocity of horizontal. the The horizontal component of velocity v = object parabolic v cos θ at any path, point along remember the to find the H horizontal If air resistance is ignored, this component remains constant. acceleration The horizontal is vertical components Therefore, at the and that point first. zero. displacement x at time t is given by 1 2 x = (v cos θ)t + (0) t = (v cos θ)t 2 Exam tip x ∴ t = (3) v cos θ Do Initial vertical component of velocity v = v sin θ not learn of flight, the formula for horizontal range time and V maximum The vertical displacement y at time t is given height. Just resolve the by initial velocity into a horizontal and 1 2 y = (v sin θ)t (– g) t + (4) vertical component and apply the 2 equations 1 [Using s = ut + of motion. 2 at , a is taken as –g because the vertical component of 2 the velocity decreases Substituting Equation as the (3) ball into moves Equation upwards] (4): 2 x y = (v sin θ) ( 1 v cos θ ) + x (– g) 2 ( v cos θ ) g sin θ 2 ∴ y = x tan θ – ( 2 2v 2 cos θ ) x [ tan θ = ] cos θ 2 This equation is a parabola of the form y = ax – bx Example A boy kicks (Figure a football such that the ball follows the path shown below 3.3.4). P 1 10 m s h v v H 60° 7m R Figure 3.3.4 23 Chapter 3 Kinematics Ignoring air resistance, calculate: i the initial horizontal ii the initial vertical iii the maximum iv the time taken to reach v the time taken to cover component component height h of of the achieved the the the by velocity velocity the maximum distance of the the ball ball ball height R, of h where R is the range of the projectile vi the distance vii the velocity starting Sketch of air R of the ball at the point P , where P is 7 m from the initial point. Figure 3.3.4 resistance on and the label ball it is A. not Sketch the path B, such that the effect ignored. –1 i Initial horizontal component V = 10 cos 60° = 5 m s H –1 ii Initial vertical component V = 10 sin 60° = 8.66 m s V –1 iii u = 8.66 m s –1 , v = 0 m s –2 , a = – 9.81 m s 2 v = u + 2as 0 = (8.66) 2 + 2(– 9.81)s 2 2(– 9.81) s = s = (8.66) 2 (8.66) = 3.82 m 2(9.81) Maximum height h = 3.82 m –1 iv u = 8.66 m s –1 , v = 0 m s –2 , v = u + 0 = 8.66 a = – 9.81 m s at + (– 9.81) t 8.66 t = = 0.883 s 9.81 v Time taken to reach Time taken to cover R = 2 (0.883) = maximum the u = 5 m s , horizontal = 0.883 seconds distance: 1.766 seconds –1 vi height –2 a = 0 m s , t = 1.766 s 1 2 s = ut + at 2 1 2 = (5 × 1.766) + (0)(1.766) 2 = vii In order velocity to in find the the 8.83 m velocity vertical and of the projectile horizontal at P , direction we at P . need The to find velocity the in 1 v = 5 m s H the θ horizontal acceleration in direction that is constant, since there is no component direction. –1 v = 5 m s H The time taken to reach the point P 1 2 s = ut + at 2 1 v 2 7 = 5t + (0)t 1 v = 5.07 m s 2 V 7 Figure 3.3.5 t = = 5 24 1.4 s is determined as follows: of Chapter The vertical determined component as follows v V of velocity (Figure + at time t = 1.4 seconds 3 Kinematics is 3.3.5): = u at = 8.66 = – 5.07 m s + (– 9.81)(1.4) V –1 V V The resultant velocity is determined 2 v = √ as follows: 2 v + v H V 2 2 5 + 5.07 v = v = 7.12 m s θ = tan √ –1 V 5.07 V –1 ( –1 ) V = tan ( ) 5 = 45.3° H Figure 3.3.6 shows the effect of air resistance on the motion of the ball. A 1 10 m s B 60° Figure 3.3.6 Effect of air resistance on the motion of the ball Key points ᔢ When ᔢ The object ᔢ The horizontal and ᔢ The horizontal component is ᔢ an object is travels projected both at an angle horizontally vertical motions of the it follows and are vertically treated velocity a parabolic path. simultaneously. separately. remains constant if air resistance ignored. Gravity acts vertically and affects the vertical component of the velocity. 25 4 Dynamics 4. 1 Dynamics Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this 1 Linear section, you The linear and to: momentum momentum velocity ( v). momentum ᔢ define linear state of in the same an is object a is vector direction as the Newton’s first and product quantity. the momentum of The velocity its mass direction (Figure ( m) of 4.1.1). the The –1 unit ᔢ is (p) Momentum of momentum, by definition is kg m s second v laws ᔢ p = mv define the m newton. Figure 4.1.1 Defining linear momentum Definition Newton’s first Linear the momentum product velocity in of a a is defined body’s given mass as and direction. If a it to to book move space can is make placed it law of on move. indefinitely affects move in its a a table a rock If in a motion. straight motion it is will straight It is line stay thrown line difficult forever . there in until to On until outer the grasp Earth a force space, it gravity the of applied to continue some concept frictional is will that forces object an are in object always Equation present. slows p = If a ball down the is kicked motion it of will the eventually come to rest because friction ball. mv Newton –1 p – momentum/kg m s m – mass stated continue of to that move a body with a will stay constant at rest velocity or if it unless is moving, acted will upon by an body/kg external force. This law is stating that a force is required to produce a –1 v – velocity of body/m s change in velocity (acceleration) (Figure 4.1.2). a F Newton’s first law v = 0 A force Newton’s first that a body continues law stays to of at move motion rest with or if is required to cause an object to accelerate from rest states moving a F uniform v = constant velocity unless acted upon by an A force external force. is required to make an object accelerate when moving with a constant velocity Figure 4.1.2 Newton’s Newton’s second proportional the Newton’s second law force second to law the law states applied that force the and rate of takes change place in of momentum the direction is in which acts. Mathematically this law can be expressed as follows: Δp Newton’s second law states F that ∝ (1) Δt the rate of change of momentum is Where proportional to the applied force in takes place the force in the acts. direction in is force, Δp is the change in momentum and Δt is the change time. which Consider applied The 26 F and an to object the initial of object mass for momentum t is m travelling seconds mu. and with its a velocity velocity u. changes A to force v. F is Chapter The final momentum The change in is Δp = Dynamics mv momentum ∴ 4 mv is – mv – mu mu (2) Equation Substituting Equation (2) into mv ∴ F – Equation (1): mu F = ma ∝ t The proportionality proportionality sign is constant k now is = k – ( = km v But acceleration a – an equal sign and F – m – force/N mass/kg a – acceleration/m s a ) – ( –2 mu t v F with included. mv F replaced u ) t u = t ∴ F 1 newton is the = force kma required to give a mass of 1 kg an acceleration of –2 1 m s the . The reason equation why equal to the newton is defined in this way is to make k in 1. Example A wooden block of mass 0.50 kg rests on a rough horizontal surface. A wooden force of 15 N is applied to the block. The frictional force acting on a the block block is 6 N (Figure 4.1.3). Calculate F 15 – the acceleration of the block. 15 N 6 N 6 –2 Acceleration a = = = m 18 m s 0.5 Figure 4.1.3 Example A box of Figure mass 4.1.4. 60 kg is being pulled along a rough surface as shown in Calculate: Exam tip a the component of the 80.2 N b the component of the 50 N c the acceleration force in the OX direction Always force in the OX remember that equation acting on it is of the box in the direction Component in the OX direction 80.2 b Component in the OX direction 50 c T otal horizontal + of OX if the frictional F = ma, F is resultant force. force 25 N. a 65.7 in the direction 19.5 force = acting in the × × cos 35° cos 67° direction = = 65.7 N 80.2 N 19.5 N OX to the right 35° 85.2 N box 67° Resultant force acting on the F box = 85.2 – 25 N = 60.2 N 60.2 –2 a = = = m 1.00 m s 60 50 N Key points Figure 4.1.4 ᔢ Linear ᔢ Newton’s first move ᔢ momentum with Newton’s law is states uniform second proportional to the that velocity law the product states a acts. 1 is the force a body unless that applied force the force of body’s stays acted the rate and mass at rest upon of takes by and or an change place in if velocity. moving continues to external force. of momentum the direction in is which –2 ᔢ newton required to give a mass of 1 kg an acceleration of 1 m s 27 4.2 Dynamics Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this 2 Impulse section, you Consider applied to: velocity ᔢ understand ᔢ draw the term an to object the to of object increase mass for to a v. ᔢ mv understand – mu represents the concepts of as Δp, the where and is third give law of examples. The quantity concept of example, when ball he for period If a ball to a longer of time, while a velocity seconds. Newton’s u. A This second force force law F is causes we can the write mv – mu in momentum of the object and can be momentum. time. the travelling to zero. his If ball to the into will in. It This force the time exerted a he reduces the the effect get bat the let hand time for in the in exerted a N s. force. ball to For go further with exerted for ball fall same the a longer into his his direction momentum on The momentum. the the the contact is in is of the bat change would force impulse can by his longer of time greater ball a the keeping moving takes unit batsman by have catch same the bat, the The account cricket, with had at force–time force of F second vary in a to force applied the In ball. object can acts to in in a used on an a how ball cannot the it hand of by the the the ball ball. a player force is it a force graph varies shows a over a constant t exerted as how first strikes difficult of graph by for is the ball the the with racket player struck represents example the force/N by on to the his racket. the apply racket ball a The would constant and the the tennis the area change under the in momentum graph represents ball. force/N F F time/s Δ t Figure 4.2.1 The constant. For momentum illustrate interval deforms be force–time question. to object. time tennis, practice The it be over of shows under change it game time. force area as applied graph with the graph time being Suppose the it Δp impulse. takes of = graphs period of called game strikes reduce The is impulse in a was F–t A Ft fieldsman hand, 28 to t mass Ft Newton’s motion = change p weight state with time interpret force–time expressed and of impulse graphs ᔢ moving According Ft and m period Force–time graphs time/s Chapter Mass The and mass of body is Dynamics Definition weight a 4 the amount of matter contained in it. Bodies have a Mass is the measure of a body’s inertia. property to start moving moving, Mass associated is once a with when it is scalar in it them, is at rest. motion. quantity called It Mass and the inertia. is is SI also a It the is is reluctance reluctance measure unit the the of a of body ’s kilogram a of body a body to stop Definition inertia. (kg). Suppose The your mass is 60 kg on Earth. If you were to take a trip to the Moon, weight exerted mass The will still weight dependent travel to be of on the of an object is the force your by gravity on it. 60 kg. an object the is the force gravitational Moon, where the field exerted by strength. gravitational gravity on Therefore, field it. if strength W eight you is were less W = mg W – weight/N m – mass/kg g – gravitational field strength/N kg is to than that –1 of the Earth, W eight is a you would vector quantity Newton’s third For on in an it. a object The of on the direction. upwards a much and the smaller SI unit is weight the than newton on the Earth. (N). law resting weight vertical vertically have to the surface object acts Therefore, balance the of a table, there downwards. there must weight of be the are The an two object equal object. forces is not force This acting acting force Newton’s third law moving is If B, the nor mal reaction to the surface (Figure a body A exerts a force on body called then body B exerts an equal and 4.2.2). opposite force R – normal on body A. reaction W – weight Figure 4.2.2 Forces acting on an object on a table Examples of 1. Force When a each F between two force is parallel parallel wire B. a Consider current Wire B I in exerts the a conductors two wires same force A motion F A are and direction. flows in the current them is but act same in opposite direction, the repulsive in on wire wires (Figure in force parallel Wire A. F A When between opposite and them each to F each a are other , other , force of equal B current directions, to exerts A directions. the flows conductors adjacent B B magnitude the law of current-carrying current-carring experienced. carrying on Newton’s third is in the wires attractive. the force When between 4.2.3). I I F F B I F B A F A I A Figure 4.2.3 B A B Force between current -carrying conductors 29 Chapter 4 Dynamics 2. Force When two between a between force charges them. F on charged objects are placed Consider object B. close two to each charged Object B other , objects exerts an A equal a force and B. and is experienced Object opposite A exerts force F A object the A. force (Figure on B If the is charges repulsive. are If the the same charges (both are positive different, or the both force negative), is attractive 4.2.4). F F B A + + A B F F B A + A Figure 4.2.4 Force between charged objects 3. Gravitational force The Moon centripetal exerts a B orbits force force F the Earth. required on between two the The for the Moon. Earth’s Moon At the masses gravitational to orbit same the time, field Earth. the provides The Moon the Earth exerts a force E F on the Earth (Figure 4.2.5). M F F M E Moon Earth Figure 4.2.5 4. A rocket When the Force between two masses a rocket exhaust. momentum, law, the gas causing 5. A A it of air to a force the on accelerates When 30 is a a volume out, downward equal and it of force. opposite gas is expelled experiences According force on the a from change to in Newton’s rocket, third therefore helicopter able to change If fly If vertical the because exert in Newton’s blades. resultant stationary. in large pushed accelerate. to the a being an helicopter has According is resulting hovering blades launched, gas exerts helicopter The is As a third this is Newton’s downward momentum law, force motion force of is greater air equal zero on the downwards, the is force third to and than exerts the the the law. air weight weight rise equal of helicopter of the rotating around giving an The and the to them. a force. opposite helicopter , remains helicopter , it upwards. applying Newton’s third law ᔢ The two forces are at all times ᔢ The two forces act in opposite ᔢ The two forces are of the ᔢ The two forces act on same different it is important equal in to note the following: magnitude. directions. type (gravitational, bodies. electric, etc.) Chapter 4 Dynamics Example –1 A ball of mass 0.35 kg hits a wall with a speed of 12 m s and rebounds –1 from with wall the the on wall wall the lasts its for initial 0.2 s. path with Calculate a speed the of average 7.2 m s force . The exerted impact by the ball. mv F along – mu (0.35 = × – 7.2) – (0.35 × 12) = = t 33.6 N 0.2 Example Figure time. 4.2.6 The below mass shows of the how object the is force 2 kg acting and is on an initially object at varies with rest. force/N 40 time/s 0 20 Figure 4.2.6 Calculate: Exam tip a the change b the velocity c the acceleration in momentum of the object of the after mass 10 during the first 10 seconds Always seconds take velocity of the object during the first 10 the a Change b change in in momentum momentum Δp = mv 200 = 2(v) – v = 100 m s of the = area = ½ mass under × 10 × during into direction account of the when finding seconds the d the the 20-second change in momentum of a body. interval. graph 40 = 200 N s mu – 2(0) –1 v – u 100 – 0 –2 c Acceleration = = = t d Change in 10 m s 10 momentum = total area = ½ 20 × under × 40 graph = 400 N s Key points ᔢ Impulse is ᔢ The ᔢ Mass ᔢ Weight ᔢ The mass ᔢ The weight ᔢ Newton’s area is exerts the under the is an time effect a force–time measure the force of a of third equal of the exerted body a of and graph inertia by can states vary that is of equal a gravity remains fixed body law a force. if if and the a opposite force to the change momentum. body. on is it. not affected by gravitational field body A on in exerts location. strength a force on varies. body B, body B body A. 31 4.3 Collisions Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this The section, you to: Figure 4.3.1 B rest is at each ᔢ state the principle conservation of principle of ball shows and is m. conservation of two ball A Ball A identical is moving balls A and towards eventually momentum B collides B on with with a a horizontal velocity ball of surface. v. The Ball mass of B. of During momentum exerts the on collision ball B is of F the and balls, the the magnitude magnitude of of the the force force that that ball B ball A exerts on AB ᔢ apply the principle of ball A is F (Figure 4.3.2). BA conservation of momentum The ᔢ distinguish between elastic balls are in contact for a length of time Δt. After speed of ball A is v , and the speed of ball B is v A inelastic the collision, the and in the directions shown B collisions. in Figure 4.3.3. Analysis A B Ball B v Figure 4.3.1 The initial The final momentum momentum of of ball ball B B is is zero because it is initially at rest. mv B Before collision The change in momentum of the ball B is therefore mv B A B According F to Newton’s law F BA AB F Δt = mv AB Figure 4.3.2 second During collision B Ball A v The initial momentum The final The change of ball A is mv v A B momentum of ball A is mv A in momentum of the ball A is therefore – mv mv A According Figure 4.3.3 to Newton’s second law After collision F Δt = mv BA – mv A Total momentum T otal momentum before T otal momentum after the the collision collision = = mv mv + mv A According ball B by to Newton’s ball A (F ) is third equal law , to the the B magnitude magnitude of of the the force force exerted exerted by on ball AB A by ball B (F ). They act in opposite directions. BA ∴ F = –F AB (Multiplying Equation (1) AB (1) by Δt) F Δt = –F AB Δt AB Definition mv = –(mv B The principle of conservation – of mv = mv – mv B momentum states that for before the collision momentum that total no is after A any ∴ system, mv = mv momentum equal to collision external forces act the total provided on + A the Equation is equal (2) to illustrates shows the the total that the total momentum principle of momentum just after conservation of the Momentum is conser ved in all just mv (2) B before collision. momentum. system. 32 mv) A collisions the This collision example Chapter Elastic In all and inelastic collisions, is conserved. This is not the case with An kinetic energy. Kinetic energy is the energy possessed by a body by elastic its motion. If kinetic energy is conserved in a collision, it is said to elastic said to T able collision . be If kinetic energy is not conserved, the collision energy inelastic kinetic compares elastic and inelastic one in which is conserved. collision is one in which is inelastic 4.3.1 is be An an collision virtue kinetic of Dynamics Definitions collisions momentum 4 energy is not conserved. collisions. Example Table 4.3.1 –1 An object of mass 3 kg travelling at 6 m s strikes another object of mass Elastic Inelastic collision collision Yes Yes Yes No Yes Yes –1 5 kg and travelling move off at 1 m s with a in the velocity same v. direction. Calculate v The (Figure objects stick together 4.3.4). Momentum 1 1 6 ms 1 ms conserved v Kinetic energy 3 kg 8 kg 5 kg before conserved collision after collision Total energy Figure 4.3.4 conserved Assuming T otal no external momentum forces before (3 × 6) act on the collision + (5 system (the two objects): = total momentum 1) = (3 5) v 23 = 8v v = × + after collision 23 –1 = 2.88 m s 8 –1 Both both objects objects Always move were assume off with a originally a sign velocity moving of 2.88 m s in the same direction in. convention. ᔢ Motion to the right ᔢ Motion to the left is is taken taken as as positive negative velocities. velocities. Example –25 A stationary particles A nucleus and B. of The mass 3.65 particles A × 10 and kg B decays move off to in produce opposite two directions. –27 Mass of A Mass of B = 6.64 × 10 Key points kg –25 = 3.59 × 10 kg ᔢ 7 The initial (Figure speed of A is 1.7 × 10 The principle . Calculate the initial speed of of B 4.3.5). momentum system, 7 1.7 × 10 before 1 the ᔢ momentum the In an = total momentum × 10 7 × – 1.7 × 10 ᔢ –25 ) + (3.59 × 10 × –19 = – 1.13 equal after to collision external forces act system. × 10 is collision, kinetic conserved. In an inelastic collision, kinetic v) energy 0 momentum after –27 (6.64 no elastic energy = a after Figure 4.3.5 0 is that for B on before before total collision provided A momentum conservation states ms the T otal of –1 m s is not conserved. –25 + 3.59 × 10 v ᔢ Total energy is conserved in all –19 1.13 × 10 5 v = = 3.14 × 10 –1 m s collisions. –25 3.59 × 10 33 Revision Answers found to on questions the that require questions calculation can be 11 accompanying CD. 1 An object two forces Q and 1 When a substance is heated, the energy required its Energy where a temperature required c is State a = is given mass × c by × the = acted act at 8 N, upon an by angle determine two forces of the θ. Given P and that Q. The P resultant force = 6 N acting to on raise is the object when: expression: change in a θ = 0° b θ = 180° c θ = 90° d θ = 120°. temperature [8] constant. the quantities that are SI base quantities. [2] 12 Distinguish between a systematic and a random error. b Determine SI base the units of the following, in terms units: 13 i energy ii the required A student constant c. base three base wire using quantities and their How corresponding units. [3] b can a A small metal sphere viscous fluid. As drag force SI base F, units of of it falls where F = radius at a krv. r is speed k is a dropped v, it into experiences constant. State r is the of a error in How can the 14 Distinguish 15 A acting the is on a glass given marble, η by is F marble falling = the 6πrηv, P where quantity viscosity of and v is the velocity of the marble. = = P – 6. 12 the units for viscosity. With the aid of The statement written as an example, “The the Explain why respect to an the explain what is meant Write an magnitude of a physical a product equation units equation of a number and a unit”. of b the State the if it must is which principle balance one the [2] random error in diameter? [2] between precision and accuracy. [3] S is determined from the equation of 0.02 m and Q = 1.84 uncertainty in ± 0.02 m. Calculate S. [2] of wishes piece to of wire determine is given the by R resistance = V/I. A of wire. V to be be is homogenous with correct. equations limitation of underlies using using base I are a piece measured. = 12 ± 0.4 V = 1.0 ± 0.2 A absolute the resistance uncertainty of the wire and include the R. [3] [1] homogenous, which and [2] but the base mean ± diameter 0.02 mm. uncertainty of a piece Calculate the of wire is percentage in: a the diameter [2] b the cross-sectional checking units. units The 0.6 [2] Explain systematic quantity incorrect. 8 any by 17 7 gauge. Q. ± Calculate 6 screw eliminate [3] I is reduce the resistance V the student Determine of 5 piece measurement? he percentage student SI a the 16 fluid of [3] a viscous fluid radius diameter the k. The frictional force through the a S 4 measure micrometre the measuring 3 to [2] a State wishes [2] of 2 [3] of area of the wire. [3] [2] to 18 The volume of a cylinder is given by the expression 2 balance equations. [1] V = πr h. The volume measured 9 a State the difference between vector and and height of a cylinder is as: scalar 3 V quantities. h b Give two examples = 12.0 ± examples of a of scalar a vector quantity and = 21.0 ± 0. 1 cm the radius two quantity. [4] Calculate uncertainty. 10 An at object an is angle horizontal being of 30° pulled with force to horizontal. Calculate the and vertical components of of 5 N the acting the 5 N force. [2] 34 0.5 cm [2] of the cylinder, with its [5] Revision questions 19 a Differentiate between displacement and distance 24 A metal ball is thrown vertically upwards with 1 an –1 travelled. b State [2] how you would displacement–time c State and 20 Define how you determine velocity from initial velocity a graph. a Ignoring [1] i the would determine the displacement acceleration from the following a velocity–time graph. air [2] distance determine: travelled by the ball after [2] the velocity iii the time of the taken for ball the after ball 0.9 seconds to reach its [2] maxi- height [2] [2] acceleration. [2] b the The variation with time t of the velocity v of a maximum ball falls Sketch The resistance, ii iv 21 . terms: velocity b 15 m s 0.9 seconds mum a of to height the reached ground the velocity–time and by the bounces graph for the ball. [2] twice. metal ball. cyclist [3] travelling down a slope is illustrated below. c Show how travelled it by is possible the ball to determine between the the first distance bounce and –1 v /m s the 25 An second object is bounce. projected [2] with an initial velocity of –1 15 5 m s at Ignoring an air angle of 30° to the horizontal. resistance: 10 i Calculate the the velocity initial of the horizontal component of object. [1] 5 ii Calculate velocity 0 t /s 10 20 30 40 iii Sketch the of a On the a constant velocity after the graph the velocity of the cyclist initial c the total acceleration of the cyclist car the graph, with show with time. the [1] variation of the the maximum time. [2] height h achieved by distance travelled before approaches a reaching vii light with a speed height Calculate [3] traffic [2] the time taken to reach the maxi- taken to cover the distance [3] constant velocity. A of object. Calculate mum 22 variation [1] vi the the estimate: maximum b the [1] show component Calculate the a of 40 s. v Using to component same vertical reaches component object. graph horizontal cyclist the vertical 50 iv The initial R, where h. the R is [2] time the range viii Calculate the range ix Calculate the velocity of the projectile. [2] R. [2] of of the ball at the point –1 20 m s . The light changes to red. The driver applies P, the brake when at a distance of 40 m from the where P is 2 m from the initial starting lights. point. Calculate rest at the the deceleration of the car if it comes lights. [3] 26 A box plane 23 At a sports day at school, Akil runs a 100 m [3] to race. of at mass 40° 25 kg to the is pulled up horizontal a by smooth a rope inclined which is He parallel to the plane. –2 accelerates from the blocks at a rate of 2 m s for a 4.5 seconds. He runs the remainder of the race at Sketch a diagram to show the forces acting on box. constant b Calculate Calculate his the speed after distance the first travelled 5 s. during acting component parallel The tension to the of the weight inclined of the plane. [2] in the rope is 250 N. [2] Determine the time taken for the race. the velocity–time graph for the Calculate the acceleration Calculate the reaction force of the box. [3] [3] d Sketch the box the first c d Calculate [2] 5 s. c [3] speed. b a the a race. between the box and [3] the plane. [2] 35 5 Forces 5. 1 Archimedes’ and terminal Learning outcomes On completion should ᔢ be able understand upthrust of this principle, friction velocity Archimedes’ section, you When a beach principle ball is placed in water there are two forces acting on it. to: the acting origin of on object an the 1 The weight 2 The upthr ust, of the ball, which which is a acts force vertically acting downwards. vertically upwards. in When the ball is placed in water , it displaces some water . The weight of a fluid this ᔢ explain effects ᔢ the of cause terminal and use the water is equal to the upthrust (Figure 5.1.1). and resistive forces understand of nature, displaced Origin of the concept velocity. Consider h below a upthrust cylinder the of surface height of a h fluid and of cross density sectional ρ (Figure area A at a distance of 5.1.2). 1 (See 19.1 and 19.2 for coverage of density and pressure.) upthrust V olume of fluid displaced = volume Mass of fluid displaced = density Weight of fluid displaced = mass = ρAhg = ρgh of cylinder = Ah = ρAh ball × × volume gravitational field strength water (1) weight Pressure p 1 Figure 5.1.1 Force The forces acting on an exerted on top of 1 surface F = pA = ρgh 1 A 1 object immersed in a fluid Pressure p = ρgh 2 Force p exerted on bottom surface F 2 = pA = ρgh 2 1 Upthrust h A 2 = F 1 – F 2 = 1 ρgh A – ρgh 2 A 1 A = h ρgA(h 2 – h 2 But h = h – ) 1 h 2 1 h Upthrust From = Equations (1) and (2), upthrust = ρgAh (2) weight of fluid displaced. Resistive forces When p a ball is rolled on the floor , it eventually comes to rest. The reason 2 why Figure 5.1.2 Archimedes’ a body an upthrust principle is totally states or the 1 slow down 2 prevent that each of in a fluid, which is it rest is because of friction. Friction is a force the fluid motion the of an motion movement object. of Frictional that moving between two forces: objects and stationary objects in contact with partially is produced when work is done against friction. experiences equal to the In machines, there forces are cause frictional thermal forces energy acting to be on moving produced. parts. This The makes displaced. machines 36 to other . frictional weight comes opposes Heat submerged ball Origin of an upthrust Definition when the less efficient. Lubricating moving parts with oil or grease, Chapter inside wear the and Friction they tear Frictional that forces can using lubricants ᔢ using rollers ᔢ polishing force through acts on a reduce friction. machine surfaces way, at and are the This makes not reduces it more completely microscopic the amount of efficient. smooth. level Forces they Even are though actually rough. ᔢ Drag the because appear and helps inside arises may jagged machine 5 be such and ball surfaces is the fluid . objects resistance is velocities, the the (F to force Air as reduced as oil or grease bearings ensure that opposes travel proportional between they resistance they by: to is a are smooth the motion special through the surfaces air . velocity type At of as of of low the in contact possible. an object frictional velocities, object ( F = as it moves force which the air kv). At higher velocity air resistance is proportional to the square of the velocity of 2 object = kv ). terminal velocity Terminal velocity Consider jumps a parachutist from an jumping aircraft, his from initial an aircraft. velocity is When zero. The the parachutist initial acceleration –2 is 9.81 m s . The initial force acting on the parachutist is his weight, 0 time which acts because downwards. the initial There velocity is is no zero. drag As force he acting falls, his on him velocity at the start increases and drag force his acceleration decreases. his velocity acts The and resultant force The upwards. acting on drag The him force drag is F acting force = W on him therefore – D, is proportional increases where W is as the he D to falls. weight R of the the parachutist fall, his weight force acting on he falling at is (Figure and is the becomes him a D is zero. constant drag equal His force to acting drag force. acceleration velocity. He has is now on At also him. this At some point, zero, reached point the which means terminal in resultant that velocity 5.1.3). weight W Example Figure 5.1.3 An object has a mass of 2.2 kg. When the object falls in air , the Terminal velocity air 2 resistance F is given 2 k = 0.039 N s by F = kv , where v is the velocity of the object and –2 m Key points Calculate: ᔢ a the weight b the terminal c the a W b At of the Archimedes’ principle states that object when a body is totally or partially velocity of the object submerged in a fluid, it experiences –1 acceleration of the object when it is falling with a velocity of 10 m s an upthrust which is equal to the weight of the fluid displaced. = mg = terminal ∴ 2.2 × 9.81 velocity, the W = F F = kv 21.6 = (0.039) v =21.6 N resultant force acting on the object is ᔢ Friction ᔢ When opposes motion. zero. work friction, is heat done is against produced. 2 ᔢ An object reaches terminal 2 velocity when it falls through a 21.6 fluid. –1 v = = √ 23.5 m s 0.039 ᔢ –1 c When v = 10 m s , At resistance F = (0.039)(10) = force velocity, the weight 3.9 N of Resultant terminal 2 air acting on object = W – F = 21.6 – 3.9 = the object equal to the drag 17.7 N force. The F is 17.7 and the resultant force acceleration is is zero zero. –2 a = = m = 8.04 m s 2.2 37 5.2 Polygon Learning outcomes of forces completion of this section, be able use a three body vector triangle to ᔢ in ᔢ the concept of find the object is in (Figure magnitude of drawn be vector an experiment centre irregular Q free and R body act on an diagram object. shows Figure all the 5.2.1(a) forces shows acting on the it. equilibrium. The forces can be used to draw a vector 5.2.1(b)). of shaped the forces. The sides Since the of the object triangle is in represent equilibrium, the the triangle centre gravity describe P, A equilibrium understand of forces diagram. represent triangle forces gravity to: The ᔢ of you free should centre Polygon of forces Suppose On and will a triangle closed will triangle. not be If the closed. object The was vector not in triangle equilibrium, is drawn as the follows: to gravity of 1 One 2 Moving of the forces acting on the object is selected and drawn first (e.g. P). an in an anticlockwise direction, the next force is drawn. The lamina. force 3 The R is drawn force Q is by starting then drawn from by the arrowhead starting at the of P arrowhead of R Q The as directions in the free of all body the forces in the vector triangle are exactly the same diagram. P Suppose and P S. used an In for object this the Suppose is case a vector two in equilibrium vector polygon triangle, forces P and the Q when can polygon act on an acted be upon drawn. can be object. by four Using drawn The the forces, same (Figure object P, Q, R principles 5.2.2). is not in R equilibrium. Q object to be direction The in resultant force equilibrium, opposite to R a must acting force be of on the equal exerted on object is magnitude the body R. to In R, (Figure order acting for in the a 5.2.3). R (a) (b) P P Figure 5.2.1 (a) Three forces acting on a body (b) A vector triangle R S Q P Q P Q (a) (b) P Q R S Q R R (a) Figure 5.2.2 (a) The free body diagram (b) The vector polygon (c) (b) Figure 5.2.3 (a) Free body diagram (b) Resultant force (c) The vector triangle Example A particle point. 38 It of is mass being a Sketch b Draw c Calculate a a 0.51 kg pulled diagram vector the to by a supported the and that by horizontal show triangle angle is forces hence the a string force of acting calculate string makes attached to a fixed 3.2 N. on the with the particle. tension the in the vertical. string. Chapter 5 Forces θ T θ T W = mg 3.2 N 3.2 N W = mg Figure 5.2.4 W = mg Using = 0.51 × Pythagoras’ 2 9.81 = T 2 5 = √ 5.0 N theorem 2 T = + 3.2 35.24 = 5.9 N 3.2 tan θ = 5.0 3.2 –1 θ = Centre of tan ( 5.0 = ) 32.6° (Figure 5.2.4) gravity Finding the Definition centre of gravity of an irregularThe shaped is A lamina gravity is of 1 T wo 2 A a an thin nail is holes placed freely 3 A string 4 A pencil sheet of stiff irregular-shaped small hang centre of a The of near one of In the the the order to following edge of holes the and locate steps the are centre of the point weight of a through body which appears A mass nail 7 The 8 A the act. the lamina is made to to attached mark to several it is then points on attached the to the lamina nail. where the string lamina and points hang all to lamina. string made in is removed step and a straight line is drawn through is placed attached 4. to 6 body taken: mass the a it. mass used lamina, made through from with is are material. hangs. 5 gravity lamina through the second hole and the lamina is made a string to freely. string with a mass attached to it is then attached to the nail. centre pencil is used to mark several points on the lamina where the string of gravity hangs. 9 The the 10 mass and points The point gravity of string made of in is removed step intersection the lamina and a straight line is drawn through 8. of the (Figure two lines drawn is the centre of 5.2.5). Key points Figure 5.2.5 Finding the centre of gravity of an irregular shaped lamina ᔢ A free ᔢ For an body object polygon ᔢ The a diagram can centre body in be of seems shows equilibrium all the forces when acting several forces on a act body. on it, a closed vector drawn. gravity to of a body is the point through which all the weight of act. 39 5.3 Torque and Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this moment The section, moment of There you is to: not is a required ᔢ understand the concept of open a the the door knob middle door . It is of is positioned the door positioned at where at the the a edge larger edge the of a force door door . would in It be to be a large moment about the hinges of the door . The order for moment of a couple force ᔢ to why at torque there and reason positioned a force understand moment of the concept about defined of of a force ᔢ state the conditions for equilibrium ᔢ state ᔢ apply as action a the of Consider pivot is the product the force Figure turning of the from effect force the of and pivot. a the The force. The moment perpendicular SI unit is the of distance newton a force of the metre is line (N m). 5.3.1. F the principle of moments d the principle of moments. O d Definition θ F The moment of a force is defined Figure 5.3.1 as the product perpendicular action of of the force distance of the force from O and the the Defining moment of a force Figure 5.3.2 the line of The moment of force F about O = F × d pivot. Always used is Figure The remember , at right 5.3.2, the moment The when angles of a the moment force F principle of Consider calculating to plank P line of the about of the force O = moment action F F × of the of a force, force determined from as The as shown force F in force balancing Figure produces on a pivot O. Forces F , F an an anticlockwise moment F anticlockwise moment The force F produces a O d d Therefore, 3 2 clockwise moment F Sum of d 3 for the plank clockwise F act on the 3 P to be moments in about O. about O. 1 d 2 3 1 d F 2 d and 2 5.3.3. 1 produces F In follows: moments 1 The distance pivot. d cos θ 1 plank the the 2 about O. 3 equilibrium = Sum = F of anticlockwise moments F 2 F d 3 3 d 1 + F 1 d 2 2 F 1 F 3 Figure 5.3.3 Example Applying the principle of Consider a wheelbarrow filled with some sand. A construction worker is moments about to lift the wheelbarrow with a force P (Figure 5.3.4). Calculate: Definition i The principle of that for a body moments to be in states sum of the minimum the wheelbarrow value the magnitude off of the the vertical force P, needed to raise the legs clockwise of R when the legs of the wheelbarrow just leave moments ground. must be equal anticlockwise same to the sum moments of the about the i T aking moments about the centre of the wheel. pivot. Sum 40 of ground equilibrium, ii the the of clockwise moments = Sum of anticlockwise moments the Chapter 480 × 0.6 = P × Forces 1.4 0.8 m 0.6 m 480 P 5 × 0.6 = 1.4 P = ii Just as the wheelbarrow is 206 N about to leave the ground, it will be in equilibrium. R Sum of upward forces R + = Sum of 206 = 480 R = 480 R = 274 N downward forces 480 N The torque of A couple do not forces consists coincide. F and F 1 The of A 206 Figure 5.3.4 couple two equal couple acting on and tends a to opposite produce steering wheel forces whose rotation of a car only. lines of Consider (Figure F action 1 two 5.3.5). 2 forces F and F 1 a a – are equal and have a turning effect or moment called 2 torque d T orque of couple =F d or F 1 The It SI unit should steering of be equilibrium 2 torque noted wheel is that rotates when d the the newton metre resultant turning anticlockwise. subjected to (N m). The forces F effect steering and F 1 is not wheel zero. is not The in F only. 2 2 Figure 5.3.5 The torque of a couple Example A ruler the of length torque of 0.5 m the is couple pivoted when at its equal centre. and Calculate opposite forces the of magnitude magnitude of 3 N 3 N 60° are applied T orque of as shown couple = Conditions for In order for a in F Figure × d = 5.3.6. 3 × 0.5 sin 60° = 1.3 N m equilibrium system to be in equilibrium, the following conditions must apply. ᔢ The resultant force acting ᔢ The resultant torque ᔢ The resultant moment on the system is zero. 60° is 3 N zero. Figure 5.3.6 is zero. Key points ᔢ The moment distance ᔢ The of the principle sum of the of a force line of of is the action moments clockwise product of the force the force from states moments of that for is equal a to the body the and the perpendicular pivot. to sum be of in equilibrium, the the anticlockwise moments. ᔢ A couple not ᔢ A ᔢ The consists of two equal and opposite forces whose lines of action do coincide. couple tends torque of perpendicular a to produce couple distance is rotation the only. product between of one of the forces and the the forces. 41 6 Work, 6. 1 Work energy and Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this and energy Energy section, Energy you is ᔢ identify state various the describe forms principle conservation ᔢ the capacity or ability to do work. to: V arious ᔢ power of of forms of energy include: energy of ᔢ mechanical ᔢ ᔢ (kinetic and potential) ᔢ electrical thermal ᔢ nuclear chemical ᔢ solar energy examples of (T able 6.1.1). energy conversion Energy ᔢ define conversion work. The Sun reaching Energy Table 6.1.1 is the the primary Earth cannot be is in source the created example, gasoline chemical energy has of but to of can chemical converts energy form for light be the and converted energy thermal locked and Earth. infrared from up Most of radiation one inside mechanical form it. the energy (heat to energy). another . When burnt, For the energy . Examples of energy conversion Example Energy 1 An incandescent bulb 2 A book falling from 3 A photovoltaic 4 A battery 5 A hydroelectric 6 A lighted 7 A catapult a being shelf switched to on conversion Electrical the floor Gravitational cell Light energy Chemical plant Chemical released Elastic Energy to light potential into energy Gravitational candle being energy into potential into heat energy electrical to energy light energy kinetic energy and sound energy energy electrical potential energy and into and into energy kinetic energy and then into electrical energy heat kinetic energy conservation Renewable sources of energy are derived from natural sources (sunlight, Definition waves, The principle energy be states created of conservation that nor can neither destroyed, but can one form to be another. Most of fossil fuels. the energy Fossil replenished. gas. As T o The global Therefore, 42 geothermal, hydroelectric) and are replenished over time. of energy converted from wind, in conserve used fuels the factories oil depends and gas there and heavily on diminish, is a transportation This greater means fossil prices need that fuels, of for lights ᔢ Use fluorescent ᔢ Use natural ᔢ Do ᔢ Switch ᔢ Car ᔢ W alk bulbs instead refrigerator electrical with use leaving a of incandescent a other doors bulbs. open. appliances when people. bicycle instead of a car . not in use. such energy room. lighting. leave off when comes they these energy: off or of Caribbean, Switch pool homes, non-renewable. Caribbean reserves ᔢ not in are from cannot as fuels oil be and increase. conservation. Chapter Alternative sources of energy 6 Work, energy and power in the Caribbean Table 6.1.2 Alternative source of 1 Main feature/use Advantages Disadvantages Region for energy potential Solar Solar from energy the Solar water homes harnessed Abundance Sun. in heaters and – Can hotels. of sunlight the Caribbean. the be attached roof of to Sunlight varies throughout the day so All Caribbean insulated storage tanks are required. territories For existing use large many amounts solar panels of electricity are required. buildings. Batteries Solar panels sunlight Solar that into driers convert Direct electricity. – used to dry Very Wind into required to store energy. of electricity. effective at drying crops. crops. 2 conversion sunlight are Kinetic energy converted of into wind Efficient electrical method converting wind of Large into capital cost. Affects Cuba environment. Jamaica energy using wind turbines. electricity. Wind is seasonal and variable. Barbados Batteries 3 Hydroelectric Gravitational energy of potential water stored Efficient, in method reliable of Huge through turbines required to capital store energy. cost. Dominica producing Affects dams flow are ecology. Guyana electricity. (Amaila falls) Problems to 4 Geothermal produce Thermal the energy Earth is inside used Small to land area Very site-specific steam to and expensive. Guadelope required. Harmful produce with flooding. electricity. gases may come up from St Lucia generate the ground. Dominica electricity. 5 Biofuels All Caribbean territories Biogas ᔢ Produced breaking by bacteria down Gas plant can be cooking used for and Greenhouse Agricultural and animal waste. – Gasohol Mixture Biodiesel ᔢ of way of getting rid land crops for fuel is used instead to plant of food for methane. of ᔢ produced. Main One constituent gases heating. gasoline and waste Used material. consumption. as a fuel in some as a fuel in diesel alcohol. cars. Made by chemically reacting Used vegetable oil with an alcohol. engines. Some of the feedstock biodiesel is also used for used for food. Work The work moved in done the by a force direction of is the the product of the force and the distance force. Key points W = Fs (Figure 6.1.1) W = Fs cos θ (Figure 6.1.2) F ᔢ Energy to do is the capacity or ability work. θ The SI unit of work is the joule (J). ᔢ F 1 joule is the work done by a The principle energy of 1 N when it moves through of 1 m in the direction neither s energy of can be created nor destroyed, = W Fs = but Fs cos θ can be converted from one force. form Figure 6.1.1 1 J = hand. done to another. Figure 6.1.2 1 N m ᔢ When the conservation that of W the states a s distance of force someone lifts If the object by the upward muscles in the an is object, held force arm work stationary of get the tired is in hand even done its by the final because though upward position, it no is force no work stationary. work is of the is being However , being The work product distance of done of by a force the force moved in and the is the the direction the force. done. 43 6.2 Energy and Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this power Kinetic section, you A cricket ball to: distinguish potential between kinetic ball strikes break ᔢ energy the glass An energy object of 1 the formula for through window comes it from the will the air possesses break kinetic the glass. energy kinetic The energy. energy possessed by If used the the to ball. mass m moving with a velocity v has a kinetic energy of 2 = mv K derive travelling glass and E ᔢ a 2 kinetic energy Deriving the ᔢ derive equation for the kinetic energy of a body the formula for Consider gravitational potential force ᔢ define ᔢ appreciate F acts distance power the an object of mass m, travelling with a velocity of v. A constant energy concept Work of s. on the The done by object object the and brings decelerates force F is W = it at a to rest rate of while a travelling (Figure through a 6.2.1). Fs efficiency. Using Newton’s ∴ Definition W Considering Initial The kinetic energy energy possessed of by a body virtue of is second the = law = ma) mas motion velocity (F of = v = u the object: Final velocity = 0 Acceleration = – a the 2 its 2 v + 2as motion. 2 2 0 = v – = 2as 2as 2 v 1 F 2 ∴ as = v 2 v 1 2 Work The s done loss by in the kinetic force F energy is of W = the m ( v ) 2 object is equal to the work done by the force. 1 2 Figure 6.2.1 Deriving the formula for Therefore, the kinetic energy of the object is E = mv K 2 kinetic energy Potential energy Definition Potential The potential energy of a body energy possessed by it by its state or be classified as follows: Gravitation potential energy – The energy of a body by virtue of its virtue position of can is ᔢ the energy in a gravitational field. position. ᔢ Electrical due ᔢ to Elastic its potential position potential deformed. an energy (Example Deriving the potential energy in – a – The electric – The energy stretched equation for the energy of a energy possessed by a charged body field. possessed spring has change in by a elastic body when potential energy.) gravitational body h Consider an vertically upwards of h. the In object order object to must of mass with a maintain be equal Upward W = mg Figure 6.2.2 44 Downward ∴ force m at a constant a to the above velocity constant force (Weight) height v velocity, weight = F W = mg F = mg of the the and the ground. travels upward object It moves through force (Figure a distance acting 6.2.2). on Chapter Work The work energy of done done the by by the force force = is F × equal d to = 6 Work, energy and power mgh the gain in gravitational potential object. Equation ∴ E = mgh P P o Efficiency (η) = × 100% P Power and efficiency Power defined P – useful – input power output/W o power The is is the work distance as watt done rate at which work is being done. The SI unit of P power/W (W). by moved the a in force the is defined direction of as the the product force. W = of F the × force and the d Equation W Power is defined as the rate at which work is being done. P = W t P = t F Therefore, we can write P × d = d . But recall that v = t ∴ The P efficiency output to the Machines and a not 100% Friction greasing input. is It defined is parts as the expressed efficient. between moving – power/W W – energy/J t – time/s Fv machine power are machines. of = t P There moving reduces as are parts ratio a of useful power percentage. energy generate friction the and losses present unwanted increases the Equation in heat. Oiling efficiency P of = Fv machines. P – power/W F – force/N v – velocity/m s Example A cyclist –1 pedalling along a horizontal road provides a power of 210 W and –1 reaches bicycle a steady is speed of 6.2 m s . The combined mass of the cyclist and 112 kg. 1 v a b = 6.2 m s F Calculate: i the kinetic ii the total The cyclist energy resistive stops of the force cyclist acting pedalling and and on (549 + 33.9) N bicycle the allows = forward the motion. bicycle to (112 come to × 9.81 × sin 30°) N rest. 33.9 N Assuming distance c The that the travelled cyclist resistive by decides the to force cyclist go up a remains before slope. constant, coming The to angle calculate the 30° rest. of the weight slope is 30° = (112 × 9.81) N to Figure 6.2.3 –1 the horizontal. the slope, bicycle. the In order cyclist Calculate maintain pedals this 1 to harder i E = constant and supplies speed more of 6.2 m s power to up the power . 1 2 a a 2 mv = Key points 3 (112)(6.2) = 2.15 × 10 J K 2 ii P = 2 ᔢ Fv P F = = = v b Loss in its energy kinetic energy energy of possessed a body by is virtue of 33.9 N 6.2 kinetic The the 210 = work = 33.9 done by resistive motion. force ᔢ The gravitational potential 3 2.15 × 10 × d energy of a body is the energy 3 2.15 d × 10 possessed = = Component of the weight of the Frictional force = 112 × = 33.9 N cyclist 9.81 × and bicycle sin 30° = down the slope the cyclist must supply its is: 549 N power to provide a Power which ᔢ Therefore, of position. ᔢ mg sin θ virtue 63.5 m 33.9 c by force is defined work Efficiency is is as the being defined rate at done. as the ratio of of the useful power output to the –1 549 + 33.9 = 582.9 N up the incline to maintain a speed of 6.2 m s power input. 3 ∴ P = Fv = 582.9 × 6.2 = 3.61 × 10 W (Figure 6.2.3) 45 Revision Answers found to on questions the that require questions calculation can 2 d be Calculate of accompanying CD. e 1 A small toy of mass 50 g attached to a string the roof of the horizontally inside of and the string a car. The car a a steady Sketch toy of position a and the at diagram indicate an to the Sketch acting c on the force–time by ball on graph the to player’s show the force hand. [2] show the forces direction a Explain b Distinguish what c State d Use is meant of the acting on between by the mass term and ‘impulse’. [1] weight. [2] the Newton’s third law of motion. [2] acceleration Newton’s laws to explain how a rocket is able [2] the the Calculate [2] 25° to the vertical. car. Calculate acceleration attached to the toy takes angle of to b horizontal accelerates 5 up maximum hangs exerted from the the ball. magnitude of the toy. the [3] acceleration of leave the Earth’s surface. [3] resultant force the toy. 6 [2] a Define b State linear the momentum. law of [1] conservation of linear momentum. 2 a State Newton’s first and second laws of [3] motion. –1 c An object of mass 4 kg travelling at 5 m s strikes [4] –1 another b Using Newton’s laws of motion, explain how is able to hover above the ground. opposite a Define b State c An linear momentum. object of unit of mass linear 0.6 kg momentum. is 2 kg travelling at 1 m s direction. The objects stick in together move off with a velocity v. Calculate v. [3] [2] 7 the SI mass [4] and 3 of a the helicopter object travelling [1] with The north poles together. When a in opposite of two bar released, directions. magnets the are magnets Explain how the held move off principle –1 velocity of Calculate of the 2.5 m s the of kinetic energy and the why a direction is required for and not the other. A cricketer State throws shows to this [3] a ball of two how mass the force on physical elastic quantities that are conserved in collision. [2] A skydiver has a mass of 80 kg. He jumps from an 0. 15 kg. The figure aircraft below applied [2] 9 4 is one an quantity momentum [3] 8 Explain of situation. momentum object. conservation the ball from and free falls. He reaches a terminal velocity the –1 of cricketer’s hand varies rest thrown and is with time. The horizontally to ball 80 m s before opening his parachute. Calculate: starts from another a the weight b the air of the skydiver [1] player. resistance F acting on the skydiver when force / N travelling at terminal velocity [1] 2 20 c the magnitude d the acceleration of k of if F = the kv . [2] skydiver when his velocity –1 15 is 10 42 m s [3] . a Explain what b Explain why is meant by terminal velocity. [2] 10 a viscous oil a small metal eventually sphere falling reaches a through terminal 5 velocity. c An [3] object has a mass of 1.9 kg. When the t /s 0 0. 1 0.2 0.3 object falls 0.4 in air, the air resistance F is given by 2 F = kv , where k = 0.028 N s v is 2 a Estimate b What under c is area change the Calculate it 46 the in graph the released. under physical the graph. quantity [2] does the velocity velocity of the object and –2 m . Calculate: area represent? horizontal the i the weight ii the terminal of the iii the acceleration object [2] [1] of the ball when [2] velocity of of the the object object when [3] it is falling –1 with a velocity of 5 m s . [3] Revision questions 11 A cuboid and 1 × a with mass of 3 –3 10 kg m dimensions 3.8 kg so that 30 cm is floating its × in 25 cm water largest faces × of are 15 cm 15 density A uniform rests horizontal. B Calculate: are the b the fraction upthrust of on of the the the cuboid cuboid that is beneath a the water. State two acting a body to be weight worker a (Side of end weight of to the and B. The each closer diagram on 90 N and 0.2 m from end. Sketch [2] conditions for one of supports A located from [3] b a plank two construction a surface 12 on length the 800 N support plank 2.00 m supports A of to 2 and plank. A stands 0.45 m B) show the forces it. Calculate [2] the force acting on the plank at support the force acting on the plank at support in B. equilibrium. c b Three [3] [2] co-planar force A, B and C act on a Calculate body A. that is in 16 i [2] equilibrium. Explain how a vector triangle can be used State two conditions necessary for a body to be in to equilibrium. represent ii Explain the forces A, how the B triangle and C. illustrates that the 17 forces A, B and C are in equilibrium. Three forces A toy of mass 0.75 kg hangs from two strings below. on Find an the object O as shown resultant of these forces in the and as its shown act [1] figure c [2] [3] direction with respect to the horizontal. below. 38 N T 1 30° 28° 45° T 2 O 34° 40° 20 N 22 N W 18 The toy is in equilibrium. Draw a vector A car of mass 500 kg is travelling along a horizontal triangle –1 to determine the magnitudes of T and T 1 13 Explain what is meant by the centre of . road with then descends gravity of through a of a between couple. the moment of a force and a hill a vertical frictional force down torque of 10 m s . The car [4] [2] Distinguish constant velocity 2 body. 14 a the of of length distance 200 N of acts 300 m while 20 m. A on the travelling constant car as it moves hill. Calculate: the a the initial b the total kinetic energy of the car [2] of the energy possessed by the car at the top hill c the work done d the velocity of by the frictional force the car at the bottom of the hill. 47 7 Circular 7 . 1 Motion motion in Learning outcomes On completion should ᔢ be able express of this circle Angular velocity section, Consider you to: angular a displacement an object object is made to object is initially attached travel at the in to a a string circular point A. As of length path it at a travels r (Figure constant in an 7.1.1). speed v. The The anticlockwise direction in an angle is swept out. When the object reaches the point B, an angle of radians θ ᔢ understand angular the concept is swept angle of of out. one The distance radian is travelled defined such along that s the = arc of the circle arc length is s. An r velocity s Therefore if the radius of the circle is r and the is s, then θ = r ᔢ understand the concepts centripetal force and of When centripetal the object circumference acceleration. Therefore, the returns of the arc to the length in one s ∴ point θ one the distance travelled will be the complete revolution s = 2πr 2πr = = = r Therefore, A, circle. 2π r revolution is equivalent to 2 π radians. v B π radians = 180° 1 radian = 57.3 ° O The θ angular velocity ω is the rate of change of angular displacement. θ r ω = t B s v The A time taken to complete on revolution is called the period T A θ t Figure 7.1.1 = Defining the radian ω The angular displacement Definition during one revolution is 2 π 2π ∴ T = ω The radian is defined as the angle s The subtended arc equal at in centre length of to a circle the by radius linear of the object at any point in the circle is given by v = t of Since the velocity an the angular velocity is ω, the angle swept out in time t is ωt circle. s But, ωt = r s Therefore, Definition v = ωtr = = t Angular velocity ω, is defined Centripetal as the rate of change rω t of acceleration angular –1 displacement. The SI unit is rad s An object moving accelerating. speed is in a However , accelerating. straight an line object Consider at a constant moving an in object a speed circular travelling at is not path a at a constant constant speed v Equation in a circular point v = on path the as shown circular path in Figure remains 7.1.2. The unchanged. speed The of the object direction of at the any object rω is continuously changing. Since velocity is a vector quantity, the velocity –1 v – linear r – radius/m ω – angular at velocity/m s the point A, v is different from the velocity at the point A change in velocity B, v . The B is found using vector subtraction. –1 velocity/rad s Change in velocity Δv = v – B V ector 48 subtraction can be v A thought of as a vector addition as follows: Chapter Δv = v – v B In order to perform the = v A + (– v B addition, 7 Circular motion ) A the vector v is first drawn. The vector B –v is then drawn. The starting point for this vector is the ending point of A vector v B –v v A B O v B Δv Δθ B Δθ v A A Figure 7.1.2 Uniform circular motion Δv = v – v B = v A + (– v B ) A Equation Acceleration is the rate of change of velocity. 2 Δv a a = ω r = Δt –2 If Δt is small, Δθ is small and Δv = = = – acceleration/m s ω – angular r – radius/m –1 vΔθ a a vΔθ velocity/rad s vω Δt 2 But v This = rω ∴ acceleration a = (rω)ω is always = ω r directed towards the centre of the circle. Equation 2 mv F Centripetal force = r It in has a already circular been path established with that constant the speed acceleration is directed of an towards object the travelling centre F – centripetal force/N m – mass/kg v – velocity/m s r – radius/m –1 of the circle. required force. to produce This According According force to to this must Newton’s acceleration. also Newton’s act second law F of force the = law motion, is centre called of the a force the ma ∴ F Key points = r 2 a = ω centripetal circle. mv = r Since is 2 v a This towards 2 But second 2 r, the centripetal force can be written as F = mω r ᔢ Angular change velocity of is angular the rate of displacement. Example ᔢ An object of mass 1.2 kg is travelling in a circular path of radius An object travelling in a circular 0.8 m, path at a constant speed is –1 with a constant speed of 0.5 m s . Calculate: accelerating. a the angular b the time c the centripetal acceleration d the centripetal force velocity of the object ᔢ taken for the object acting to of on complete the the one revolution direction changing ᔢ The object directed v ω = = r = = = the ω accelerating the and centre is of circle. An r unbalanced force centripetal force 10.1 s to = is towards is called the required 0.625 2 a is velocity 2π = ω c its 0.625 rad s ᔢ T object 0.8 2π b the hence 0.5 –1 a of and changing. object object. The 2 = (0.625) (0.8) produce a centripetal –2 = 0.313 m s acceleration. d F = ma = 1.2 × 0.313 = 0.375 N 49 is 7 .2 Examples Learning outcomes On completion should ᔢ be able analyse of this of An object section, you to: circular If motion in a circular horizontal a stone tension the motion attached to a 1 string being whirled in a path is in attached the circular string to a string provides and the whirled in centripetal a circular force path, necessary the to maintain motion. circle ᔢ analyse motion in a vertical circle Horizontal ᔢ analyse the motion of a circle conical Consider an object of mass m, attached to a string of length r being pendulum. whirled As v in a horizontal mentioned force needed earlier , for the circle the with tension object to a T move constant in in the a speed string circular v as in provides path. Figure the The 7.2.1. centripetal acceleration a of O the object is directed towards the centre of the circle. According to T Newton’s second law F = ma T = 2 mv ∴ W = mg r Figure 7.2.1 An object moving in a If the string breaks, the tension T will not be present. As a result, the horizontal circle centripetal Newton’s circle), force first in the acting law, the direction on the object of the object will fly will off no in longer a instantaneous exist. straight velocity line at According (tangent the time to to the when the Exam tip string from Make the sure that diagrams you and breaks. the centre when an vertical the method tension object is of object the does not move off in a direction radially away circle. understand used to Vertical calculate The in the whirled in a Consider whirled circle. circle string, the an in object a at determined. tension is object of vertical different The at a mass circle m, attached with positions tension is maximum at at a the a to constant and how the minimum bottom a of string speed v. of tension at the the length Figure top in the of r being 7.2.2 the shows string circle. is The circle. mg T a O O a a O T T W = mg F = ma F = ma F = ma 2 2 mv 2 T mv W = mg mv ∴ = T T + mg – mg = = r r r 2 mv 2 mv ∴ ∴ T = – T = + mg r r Figure 7.2.2 An object moving in a vertical circle Example An object of mass 0.80 kg is attached to a string and spun in a vertical –1 circle 50 of radius 0.90 m with a constant speed of 9 m s . Calculate: mg Chapter 7 Circular motion P a the minimum b the maximum a Minimum circular tension in tension tension the in string the occurs θ string. when the mass is at the highest point in the path. 2 2 mv Minimum tension T 0.80(9) = – mg T = – r (0.80)(9.81) 0.90 v = Q 64.2 N m O b Maximum circular tension occurs when the mass is at the point in the r path. 2 2 mv Maximum tension T 0.80(9) = + mg = + r = A lowest conical (0.80)(9.81) 0.90 W = mg 79.8 N Figure 7.2.3 A conical pendulum pendulum T cos θ T Consider The an point P horizontal the object object is fixed circle is of of mass to a attached support radius constant, m r the and shown string to the in a string mass Figure makes an is PQ made 7.2.3. angle of length to When of θ to l. rotate the the in a velocity θ of vertical. m T sin θ Figure Since force of 7.2.4 the mass acting the shows is forces moving toward tension, the the T sin θ F in acting a centre circular of provides = on the the the object. path, circle there O. centripetal The must be a centripetal horizontal component force. W = mg ma Figure 7.2.4 Analysing the forces acting 2 mv ∴ T sin θ on the object = (1) r The mass does not move in a vertical direction. 60° T ∴ T cos θ Equation (1) = divided mg by (2) (2) F 2 T sin θ mv = ÷ mg r T cos θ 2 v tan θ (0.06 × 9.81) N = rg Figure 7.2.5 Example A to small a mass rigid of 60 g support. is The attached mass is to a made string. to One travel in end a of the string horizontal is circle fixed Key points of ᔢ radius 0.18 m. The string makes an angle of 60° to the vertical. The For a mass attached to a string the mass tension in the string provides the takes 0.65 s to complete one revolution. Calculate: centripetal force required to keep a the angular b the centripetal acceleration c the centripetal force velocity of the mass an object moving in a circular path. of the mass ᔢ acting on the The tension acting on being whirled d the a T tension in the string. with ᔢ 2π a mass mass The a in constant tension a horizontal speed acting on is a circle constant. mass 2π –1 = 0.65s, ω = = T = 9.67 rad s being 2 a = ω c F = ma = 0.06 × d T cos 60° = 0.06 ×9.81 = (9.67) a vertical a constant speed (0.18) = 16.8 m s ᔢ 16.8 = When analysing a conical 1.01 N pendulum it is necessary to resolve the tension 0.06 T circle varies. –2 b r in 0.65 with 2 whirled ×9.81 = and = 1.18 N (Figure horizontal into its vertical components. 7.2.5) cos 60° 51 7 .3 Examples Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this of circular Vehicles section, you In order the to: roads ᔢ analyse the motion of a around a analyse the a car to and the road are road being go a around provide designed, care a bend bend the is (arc of a necessary taken to circle), the centripetal ensure that friction force. cars do between When while going around bends. Instead of making not curved skid roads off flat, bend they ᔢ around 2 vehicle the going for tyres going motion motion of an are banked. Figure 7.3.1 shows a vehicle on a banked road. aircraft R banking. R cos θ R sin θ θ W = mg Figure 7.3.1 Using A vehicle travelling along a banked road Newton’s second law F = ma 2 mv ∴ R sin θ = (1) r Assuming the vehicle R cos θ Equation (1) does = divided not move in a vertical direction. mg by (2) Equation (2) 2 R sin θ mv = ÷ mg r R cos θ 2 v tan θ = rg An aircraft An aircraft the weight wings at flying W an component make the banking of horizontally the angle of the aircraft θ aircraft. to lift, the experiences In order vertical. L sin θ for a lift the As the aircraft provides the necessary turn. L L cos θ θ L sin θ W = mg Figure 7.3.2 52 An aircraft banking force aircraft L to which turn, banks, the balances it tilts its horizontal centripetal force to Chapter Using Newton’s second law F = 7 Circular motion ma 2 mv ∴ L sin θ = (3) r Assuming the aircraft L cos θ Equation (3) = does not move in a vertical direction. mg divided (4) by Equation (4) 2 L sin θ mv = ÷ mg r L cos θ 2 v tan θ = rg Example 4 An in aircraft a of mass horizontal 3.5 × direction 10 of kg flies radius r. with It is its wings travelling tilted at a in order constant to fly speed of –1 200 m s Calculate: a the vertical b the lift c the horizontal d the acceleration e the value component force of of L L component of the of L aircraft towards the centre of the circle r L 40° r O W Figure 7.3.3 a V ertical component L = weight of aircraft W = mg 3.5 4 = × 10 5 × 9.81 = 3.43 × 10 N Key points 5 b L cos 40° = L = 3.43 × 10 5 3.43 × 10 ᔢ 5 = 4.48 × 10 The friction between the tyres N cos 40° and c Horizontal component of L = L cos (90 – the road provides 40)° centripetal force 5 = 4.48 × 10 the required to keep 5 × cos 50°= 2.88 × 10 N a car moving in a circular path. 5 F 2.88 × 10 –2 d a = = = 8.23 m s ᔢ The horizontal component 4 m 3.5 × 10 of an aircraft’s lift, while 2 v e a banking, = provides the necessary r centripetal force 2 (200) travel 3 = = a it 2 v r required for = 4.86 × 10 m (Figure along an arc. 7.3.3) 8.23 53 to 8 Gravitation 8. 1 Gravitational field Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this Gravitational field section, you A gravitational placed to: inside field this and field exists field, it around lines bodies experiences a that force. have mass. This force If is an object attractive is in nature. ᔢ understand the concept of a Figure gravitational field as ᔢ define gravitational field ᔢ state ᔢ describe an determine to law of gravitation experiment the illustrates Earth. If an the object gravitational P of mass m, field is around placed spherical inside the object such gravitational strength field Newton’s 8.1.1 the to The acceleration due gravity. of the towards Earth, the gravitational lines. The field. The spaced The it centre out the direction of the field of the field spacing closer experiences of around the the The are, Earth lines lines lines force. the field field a direction of this force is Earth. are, the is gives the field idea stronger weaker gravitational represented an is of by the the field. the field. the direction using field strength of The the of the more force on a Definition test A a gravitational field body where force when a is mass placed a region mass placed in the field. around experiences a Newton’s law of gravitation in the field. All an bodies that attractive force on keeps the the Consider have force Earth Moon two mass on the exert according in orbit bodies a Moon. to on the masses each Moon Newton’s around having force The third law. of m and m 1 by a distance r. Newton stated that The an Earth equal This and force exerts opposite is what Earth. m M other . exerts there respectively and separated 2 exists a force of attraction between P these two product square bodies. of of the Newton’s Figure 8.1.1 the The magnitude masses distance law can be of the of the bodies. between the expressed It is two as force is also directly inversely bodies (Figure proportional proportional to to the the 8.1.2). follows. Diagram showing the gravitational field around the Earth Definition Equation Definition Gm Newton’s law of gravitation states m 1 F = 2 – 2 that the force of attraction between The direction of a r gravitational field any two bodies is directly proportional is the direction of the force on a G – placed in constant –11 to the product of their masses and mass gravitational test (6.67 × 10 2 N m –2 kg ) the field. inversely proportional to the square of m – mass of one body/kg – mass of other – distance 1 the distance between them. m body/kg 2 m 1 r m between the centres 2 F F of mass of the two bodies/m r Figure 8.1.2 Newton’s law of gravitation The constant of proportionality G is called the gravitational –11 has been experimentally determined as 6.67 × 10 2 N m constant. It –2 kg . The minus Did you know? sign to If there is no negative sign, it in stated that the force is that indicates Newton’s that third the law A, is exerting a force F on force is applies. another attractive. equal 54 equation attractive. This It means is important that if one should body be the remember and opposite force on body A. body B, then body B will exert an Chapter Gravitational field The gravitational field 8 Gravitation strength strength is the force acting per unit mass. This Definition means mass that the placed in gravitational the field. field On the strength Earth’s is the surface force the exerted on gravitational a 1 kg field The gravitational field strength is the –1 strength is g = 9.81 N kg . Gravitational field strength is a vector quantity . force acting per unit mass. GMm In Figure 8.1.1, the force exerted on object P is F = – , where r is 2 r the distance between the centre of mass of M and m Equation The gravitational field strength at P due to the mass M is g F g The force exerted on P in terms of the gravitational field strength is F = GMm mg = = mg m g – gravitational field – 2 –1 r strength/N kg GM ∴ g = F – force/N m – mass/kg – 2 r From the this point distance The is it can dependent from its centre be on of seen the an the object object. is released The that mass the of gravitational the object field creating strength the field at and mass. acceleration due to When on equation, P it gravity falls gravitational to the force ground. produces The an force of gravity acceleration acts which electromagnet is –2 equal to 9.81 m s . This magnitude can be determined experimentally as metal follows. the An time t iron bearing taken is is made to fall through a known distance h ball and recorded. light gate light gate 1 2 s = ut + at 2 s = h, u = 0 a = g h 1 1 2 h = (0)t + 2 gt = gt 2 2 2h ∴ g = 2 t timer T wo light distance gates are between set up them as is shown in measured. Figure The 8.1.3 metal and ball is the held vertical in place using Figure 8.1.3 Measuring the acceleration due to gravity (free fall method) an electromagnet. begins starts. stops. falling. When The As the due h to the ball ball height acceleration When the passes and electromagnet passes through the gravity through the measured is the switched first second time t light light are off, gate, used the gate, to metal the the ball timer timer calculate the Did you know g g varies around the Earth. The Earth Key points is at ᔢ A gravitational field is the region around a body where a mass not the a perfect sphere. It is squashed poles. experiences a force. ᔢ The direction mass ᔢ placed Newton’s two law bodies is proportional ᔢ of in a gravitational field is the direction of the force on a test the field. of gravitation proportional to the Gravitational field square states the force to the product of the distance strength is the force of of attraction their masses between per unit between and inversely them. mass. –2 ᔢ The acceleration measuring the due time to gravity taken for a is 9.81 m s mass to and travel can be through determined a known by vertical distance. 55 8.2 Gravitational Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this potential Gravitational section, When you an object gravitational to: floor ᔢ define gravitational ᔢ understand the term equipotential of a done of h, against gravitational discuss the motion state the applications given to in a energy. a higher gravitational If an one, object while field, of it mass possesses m travelling is moved through a from one vertical mass force gains of potential gravitational gravity. energy. The The potential work gain in done is energy. equal gravitational to Work the is gain potential in energy by ΔE = mgΔh P was assumed that the gravitational potential g remains constant as the of mass geostationary the the satellites It ᔢ present of is geostationary is potential distance ᔢ satellites potential potential building and is being moved vertically upwards. For distances close to the Earth’s satellites. surface, away this from remains M longer can the be assumed Earth’s constant applies. and Recall to surface, the be true. the equation that the However , gravitational for as gravitational gravitational we field field move strength potential strength due further no longer energy to a no mass M 1 kg varies with distance r as follows: ∞ GM force of g = – 2 E gravity is P r increasing Consider Figure 8.2.1 a 1 kg mass moving away from the Earth’s surface to some Moving a 1 kg mass to a point where the gravitational field strength due to the Earth is negligible. point far away from the Earth Assume Earth, gains that work is point done gravitational maximum M this is infinity. against the potential gravitational As force energy. potential the of At mass moves gravity. The infinity, away mass from the therefore the mass would some point P have its energy. ∞ 1 kg P Suppose Figure r the work done same The φ = 0 in a 1 kg 8.2.1. mass The direction. gravitational moving unit is moved movement from of Therefore, potential mass (1 kg) the infinity mass negative at the from to and work point infinity P to is the is force being defined that of done as point. as shown gravity on the act the work in in mass. done Gravitational GM φ = — potential is a scalar quantity. The gravitational potential at infinity is r defined Figure 8.2.2 as being equal to zero. W e have already indicated that at infinity, Defining gravitational the gravitational potential energy is at a maximum. Therefore, at any point potential closer to the Therefore, The Definition Earth, the gravitational gravitational gravitational potentials potential φ, at a potential have energy negative distance r will values from a be less (Figure point than zero. 8.2.2). mass M is given GM by: φ = – r The gravitational potential φ, at a Figure point is the work done in mass from infinity shows the variation of gravitational potential with distance moving from unit 8.2.3 to that the Earth. point. gravitational 1 potential / J kg Equation GM φ = – r distance/m –1 φ – gravitational potential/J kg 0 G – gravitational constant –11 (6.67 × 10 2 N m M – mass/kg r – distance from –2 kg the ) centre of mass/m Figure 8.2.3 56 Variation of gravitational potential with distance from the centre of the Earth Chapter Field A lines and gravitational point is There are the are the field same. potential is is A of line called orbit the the a force using acting gravitational drawn an Geostationary Satellites represented within called through equipotential field on a field point where points line lines. The mass the having (Figures direction placed of at that gravitational the same 8.2.4 and field at a point. potentials gravitational 8.2.5). satellites Earth geostationary in distinct satellites . paths. They There orbit the are particular Earth above satellites the equator . equipotential 4 They have above (1 the day), all the a period Earth’s it time. satellites of to These have 24 hours surface. appears be Since orbit the stationary satellites many and at satellite above orbits a has the from distance a to 3.6 period same west of point east. of on × 10 field 24 hours the ᔢ weather ᔢ television lines km equator Figure 8.2.4 lines Diagram showing field lines around a spherical body Geostationary uses. field Geostationary Gravitation equipotentials direction points 8 satellites are used lines in: monitoring ᔢ telephone communication equipotential transmission. lines Global positioning satellites (GPS) are not geostationary. They have a 4 period of 12 hours. They orbit at a height of approximately 2.02 × 10 km. surface Global positioning satellites are Figure 8.2.5 ᔢ for time ᔢ in cellular ᔢ to determine synchronisation telephony precise of the Earth used: location on ᔢ to track ᔢ to guide the vehicles Diagram showing field lines close to the surface of the Earth missiles Earth. Example A satellite of mass 2500 kg is placed in a geostationary orbit at a distance 7 of 4.23 × 10 m from the centre of the Earth. Calculate: i the ii the speed iii the acceleration iv the force v the mass i The angular velocity of the period the of a the satellite of exerted of of the by satellite in its orbit satellite the Earth on the satellite Earth. geostationary satellite 2π = Key points 24 hours 2π –5 Angular velocity ω = = T ii = 24 × 7.27 × 10 –1 rad s ᔢ 3600 The gravitational point Speed of satellite v = the work done in at a moving rω 7 = is potential 4.23 × 10 5 × 7.27 × 10 3 = 3.08 × 10 unit –1 mass from infinity to that m s point. 2 iii Acceleration of satellite a = –ω r ᔢ –5 = (7.27 × 10 2 ) 7 × 4.23 × 10 An equipotential Force exerted by the Earth on the satellite F = is a line 0.224 m s drawn iv line –2 = through points having the ma same = 2500 = 560 N × gravitational potential. 0.224 ᔢ A geostationary period of satellite 24 hours and has a appears GMm v Using F = – be 2 at the same point above the r Earth 2 7 Fr 560 × (4.23 all the time. 2 × 10 × 2500 ) 24 Mass of Earth = = = 6.00 × 10 kg –11 Gm 6.67 × 10 57 to Revision Answers found to on questions the that require questions calculation can be 7 accompanying CD. 3 An object circular of mass path of 0.85 kg radius is travelling 0.5 m, with a in a horizontal constant speed –1 of 1 Explain what is a energy b the meant 1.2 m s by: a the angular b the time 2 a principal of conservation of energy the object [2] taken for the object to complete revolution [2] [2] what is meant by the terms ‘work’ c the centripetal acceleration d the centripetal force of the object [2] object. [2] and ‘power’. b of [3] work. Explain velocity [1] one c . Calculate: acting of the [2] At an amusement park in Trinidad, a ride consists of 8 Calculate the force revolving a carriage being pulled up a ramp by a steel cable. period The carriage and the passengers have a combined in of a required horizontal to circle keep of a mass radius of 0.6 m 1.2 kg with 0.8 seconds. a [3] mass of 480 kg. Initially, the carriage is being pulled 9 –1 such that it is travelling at 8 m s An object of mass 200 g is attached to a string towards the and spun in a vertical circle of radius 0.50 m with a ramp which is inclined at 30° to the horizontal. The –1 constant speed of 6 m s . Calculate: carriage is brought to rest after travelling for some a the minimum tension b the maximum in the string [3] time up the slope. During the process, the carriage travels a vertical distance of 3.0 m. tension in the string. [3] Calculate: 10 i the initial kinetic energy of the carriage A small of the passengers the gain the the iii in gravitational carriage and the work done string of 80 g is fixed is to attached a rigid to a string. One support. The mass end is [3] made ii mass and the potential energy passengers against the to travel in a horizontal circle of radius 0.60 m. of The string The mass makes an angle of 40° to the vertical. [2] resistive force takes 0. 15 s to complete one revolution. F Calculate: acting on the carriage as it moves up the ramp. a the angular velocity of b the centripetal c the centripetal force d the tension a A the mass [2] [1] iv 3 the Explain your in magnitude what answer is to gravitational mass the m is of meant derive F. by an the Earth’s concept of expression for potential energy raised vertically when through a A force F is an object distance h of 11 near mass of whirled [4] on a string body that is moving with v in the direction the mass [2] the mass [2] of the force. in the string. [2] 0.50 kg in will Derive a is attached horizontal break the when circle the to of a string radius tension and 1. 10 m. The exceeds maximum frequency of 50 N. rotation. Describe the motion of the mass if the string an breaks. expression F 5 and a relating power P dissipated by the force v. Define radian. 12 a State b The Newton’s Earth Convert can law be of gravitation. considered to be [2] a uniform [1] sphere b [3] to [2] the [5] a b velocity of on increase surface. acting acting work. Use the Calculate 4 acceleration [2] the following to of radius R. R is assumed to be radians 6 i c 30° ii Convert the following 140° to 6.4 × the Earth. 3. 14 radians ii m. A geostationary satellite is orbiting degrees i i 10 [2] 1.57 radians Explain what is meant by a geostationary [2] orbit. 6 a Explain what b Describe is meant qualitatively by angular velocity. how it is that a [2] body which ii Show is [3] that given by the radius of a the expression geostationary orbit 2 is travelling in a circular path with uniform speed 3 r has acceleration. gR = , 2 3] ω 2 c Derive the equation for circular motion a = ω r, where where a is the centripetal acceleration, ω is at angular velocity 58 and r is the radius of the g is the acceleration due to gravity the circle. [5] the Earth’s surface and ω is the angular Revision questions velocity of the satellite about the centre of 16 3 The Earth may be assumed to be a sphere of mass 24 the Earth. [3] 6.0 × 10 kg. The Moon may also be considered a 22 Determine the radius of a geostationary orbit. [3] sphere of mass 7 .35 × 10 centre of 3.84 10 the Earth to kg. The the distance from centre of the Moon the is 8 13 a Explain what is meant × gravitational ii equipotential. potential why gravitational potentials are A at speed in a circular orbit around the a Earth. Calculate on the the gravitational force exerted by the Moon. ii Calculate iii Sketch the acceleration of the Moon. [3] communications 385 km travels always negative. 14 Moon [1] Earth Explain the [1] i b that by: constant i m. Assume above the satellite is Earth. The located mass of at a the height of satellite is a diagram showing the direction of this acceleration. iv Explain why this acceleration does not increase 3 4.2 × 10 kg. The 6370 km. The radius Earth is of the Earth assumed to is be assumed a point to be mass the speed of the Moon. of v Determine the gravitational field strength of the 24 6.0 ×10 kg. Calculate: Earth 15 a the force b the centripetal c the speed A global acting of on that satellite the orbit the [2] (GPS) Earth Moon. [2] satellite. system the [2] acceleration positioning satellites the at in uses circular a number orbits at of a 4 distance of Calculate 2.22 the × 10 angular km above speed of the one Earth’s such surface. satellite. 24 Mass of Earth = 5.99 × 10 kg 3 Radius of Earth = 6.38 × 10 km [3] 59 Module Answers to the selected structured 1 Practice multiple-choice questions questions can and be found exam to on questions 8 the Which of the following is not true about inelastic collisions? accompanying CD. a Momentum is b Total c Kinetic energy is conserved d Kinetic energy is not energy conserved is conserved Multiple-choice questions 1 Which of the following a ampere, degree b coulomb, kelvin c kilogram, kelvin d metre, pairs of units are SI base units? celsius 9 A compact starts A student degree Celsius wishes to measure the density of He has cube of material X. He measures the Mass average of Length cube of = one length ± 16.5 side of = one side of the the any point is the percentage the the density is time, b 3% b 10 A satellite in has units unit for outer the the player edge distance axis of of as and the the rotation. The linear velocity of X is b. ratio a/b c is 4 d ¼ a W before height h = launch. 5R above It is the then Earth’s when the R is the radius of the Earth. What is the student acting on the satellite when it is material X? 2% c specific the weight at 9% d the Earth? 5% W The SI of 2 a orbit W a 3 the ½ a CD cube. orbiting a at is a. The inside 0. 1 cm error of is disc centre gravitational force determines placed point Y the of Y in ½ surface. What on is from velocity placed ± rotate. A is mass 0.5 g 4.2 (CD) material a and disc point X point Y At X. to disc. A linear 2 conserved heat capacity in terms of base W b W c 5 d 6 25 36 is: 2 a kg m c m –2 s –1 2 K b m d m –2 s –1 K Structured questions 2 2 s –1 –2 K –2 –1 s K 11 (Refer 4 What to is a Distinguish b Explain between precision and accuracy. [2] 15. 1.) the number of atoms present in 0.090 kg of what random carbon-12? is error meant and by give a an systematic example of and each a type error. 22 a 4.5 × 10 c 4.5 × 10 of [4] 21 b 4.5 × 10 d 4.5 × 10 23 c A student is given five marbles and asked to 24 determine make the the density of marbles. The the material student used decides to to line the 1 μg 5 What is the ratio ? marbles up in a straight line against the edge of 1 kg a –2 a –12 10 b –9 10 c metre d A small object is projected horizontally from a wall –1 of height velocity 7 m of with the a speed object just of 30 m s before . What striking –1 a 32.2 m s c 11.8 m s notes the beginning and ending 10 point 6 rule. She –3 10 is the the ground? –1 b 30.0 m s d 34.2 m s –1 measure are X Y –1 along the the ruler. She mass of then the five uses a balance marbles. Her to results as follows: = = 12.5 20.0 Mass ± 0. 1 cm ± of five 0. 1 cm marbles = 20.5 ± 0.5 g Calculate: 7 A uniform plank of length l is supported by two i the diameter of one marble, including the T 1 straps as shown below. What is the ratio absolute ? uncertainty [2] T ii 2 the mass absolute T 2 iii the 60 b marble, including the uncertainty density marbles, l /4 ½ one [2] T 1 a of 3l /4 2 c ¼ d 4 of the material including the used to uncertainty. make the [3] Module 12 A cyclist total is training mass of the in a hilly cyclist region and his is Practice exam questions Calculate: in Jamaica. The bicycle 1 85 kg. i the time taken for the cannon ball to hit the –1 Initially on a on to he level is travelling dirt road. another vertical level distance of at He a constant then road travels while speed down travelling of a 12 m s surface slope ii through the a iii b kinetic the level the loss energy of the cyclist and his bicycle on road in 15 a [2] potential energy while body a vertical distance of to the speed bottom Given of of the the that cyclist and 5.0 m his at the how [3] cyclist was by the the be in cannon ball just before sea. [3] that must be satisfied for a equilibrium. P, Q and R [2] act on an object O. The [2] bicycle slope. the travelled [2] of conditions Three forces object O c the two [2] distance travelling b through State sea ball the velocity hitting the the horizontal cannon 5.0 m. Calculate: a of providing a a is in equilibrium. vector triangle is Explain drawn to using a sketch represent these forces. power c How [3] does the triangle show that the object O is –1 of 320 W calculate when the he was total travelling at resistive force 12 m s acting , on in a [2] Explain what is meant by the terms ‘work’ 16 a State b The Newton’s mass and and ‘energy’. 5.98 × car of of radius 10 gravitation. of the Earth [2] are assumed to 6 kg and 6.40 × 10 m respectively. [2] Determine A law 24 be b [1] the cyclist. 13 equilibrium? mass 900 kg is travelling at a constant strength g a value for at the the Earth’s gravitational field surface. [3] –1 speed of 18 m s down a sloped road. The angle c of the road to the horizontal is 12°. The A geostationary driver another vehicle in front of her. She brakes to bring the car to a complete of 3000 N opposes the a distance of × 10 m from above the the centre of the Earth and is equator. stop. A i constant force at applies orbiting the is 7 4.23 notices satellite motion Explain what is meant by a geostationary of satellite. the ii i Sketch a diagram to show forces acting on Calculate when it Calculate car down is the the at rest on the component slope. of the Calculate the weight of slope. brakes v are Calculate from the normal reaction acting on the deceleration of the car when the where where Calculate the loss travelled the the of satellite Calculate the speed Calculate the acceleration by brakes the car are Explain State is located. [1] of the satellite. [3] of [2] the satellite. law Distinguish inelastic car is meant of by linear conservation momentum. of [2] linear [3] between an elastic collision and an collision. [2] applied stops. kinetic what the momentum. a Explain how is it that an object travelling [2] in vi the iv b c [2] distance point point where iii a the 18 to point the applied. the at [2] [2] Calculate strength the car. iv gravitational field [2] 17 iii the the the car ii [1] car. energy of the a circular path with uniform speed has car. acceleration. State the direction of the force [2] producing vii Calculate the work done by the this acceleration. [4] 3000 N force. 2 [1] b Derive where 14 a Distinguish between scalar and vector the a is equation for the circular centripetal motion acceleration, a ω = is ω r, the quantities. angular velocity and r is the radius of the circle. [2] [4] b Give c A an example of each. [2] c cannon in Tobago horizontally cannon ball on the is fired is positioned edge of a cliff horizontally such that 20 m with it lies high. A a velocity A mass rotated of in minimum 0.85 kg is a vertical tension in attached circle the of to a string radius string is and 1.50 m. The 2.5 N. of i Determine ii Determine the speed of rotation. [3] –1 45 m s . maximum tension in the string. [3] 61 9 Oscillations 9. 1 Free oscillations Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this Examples of free oscillations section, you Examples of free oscillations are shown in Figures 9.1.1–3. to: glider spring ᔢ describe examples of free oscillations ᔢ understand the term simple harmonic motion air ᔢ state the conditions Figure 9.1.1 simple ᔢ harmonic illustrate motion simple track necessary for motion A glider oscillating back and Figure 9.1.2 forth on an air track using two springs A small marble oscillating in a dish harmonic Simple graphically. Simple of a harmonic har monic mass directed is towards following sign (–) the motion proportional The to motion the fixed equation indicates direction that of is to periodic the motion displacement in which from a the fixed acceleration point and point. is used the the a (SHM) to define direction of SHM. the Note that acceleration is the negative always opposite displacement. spring Definition Equation 2 oscillation SHM is a periodic motion in which: a = –ω x mass of mass –2 1 Figure 9.1.3 the acceleration is proportional to the a – acceleration/m s ω – angular frequency/rad s x – displacement/m A mass oscillating on a spring –1 displacement from 2 directed towards a fixed the fixed point and point. 2 acceleration /m s Figure 9.1.4 shows displacement displacement /m Consider or O. fixed The the a position). points 9.1.5. respectively. Graph showing the A can be seen At the an particle equilibrium Figure Figure 9.1.4 for relationship object M It initially begins and B point The that to oscillate P O. the A and a velocity are at in of with of and M the point SHM maximum snapshot displacement v the acceleration and SHM. starting represent position between undergoing the (equilibrium about the point displacement motion acceleration from opposite its O is of from illustrated M equilibrium are v in and position a is x. It directions. relationship between acceleration and displacement The conditions ᔢ A mass that ᔢ A fixed ᔢ A restoring it is necessary for SHM are as follows: oscillates. point at which the mass is in equilibrium. a force which returns the mass to its equilibrium position if M displaced. v x Displacement, velocity A Figure 9.1.5 62 O P Simple harmonic motion B Consider one side the motion gently and of a then and simple acceleration pendulum. released, gravity When pulls on the it. bob This is displaced force causes to it Chapter to return and left causes and SHM can process of the to at the O time point → oscillation is position. be t A. A T. 0. One → The → time So (Figure bob the 9.1.6). pendulum oscillation O This again. the passes bob this oscillates Oscillations point to the position. graphically = However , repeated equilibrium illustrated O follows one equilibrium the be at reaches as its right initially it to 9 is B is the → called is motion O. the The pendulum displaced The of time period of to the the bob right is until pendulum taken to bob complete oscillation. B Figure 9.1.7 motion If the of a (Graph simple amplitude displacement from is A, the of displacement–time The graph is x is graph sinusoidal in for A the shape. 0 Equation distance Figure 9.1.6 position) displacement time a the (maximum the of illustrates pendulum. equilibrium then function I) = as x = The motion of a simple pendulum A sin ωt a x – displacement/m A – amplitude/m A sin ωt displacement /m –1 T o determine point on graph at a the that time t velocity gradient point Therefore, At the at any displacement–time at = of must time T/4, the be t – angular frequency/rad s – time/s Graph I time /s tangent determined. = the ω t 0, the gradient gradient is zero. is a At maximum time t = and T/2, is the velocity /m s positive. gradient is 1 a Graph II maximum t = T, the and negative. gradient is a At time t maximum = 3T/4, and the gradient is zero. At time positive. time /s The velocity–time graph (Figure Equation 9.1.7 Graph II) can mathematically in be the expressed acceleration /m s 2 equation v = v Graph III cos ωt 0 opposite. –1 v – velocity/m s – maximum ω – angular frequency/rad s t – time/s time /s Similarly, the velocity–time –1 v velocity/m s 0 graph can be used acceleration–time to obtain graph the for –1 Figure 9.1.7 the Graphs showing the variation of displacement, velocity and acceleration motion of the pendulum. The with time acceleration–time by finding (Figure the 9.1.7 graph gradient Graph is at found various points on the velocity–time graph 1 III). velocity v /m s Equation The equation gives mathematical the expression for the 2 v velocity of an object = ±ω (x √ undergoing 2 – x displacement ) x –1 SHM related to displacement x /m 0 0 v – velocity/m s ω – angular frequency/rad s x 0 –1 (Figure 9.1.8). x – maximum – displacement/m displacement/m 0 x Figure 9.1.8 Graph of velocity against displacement Key points ᔢ ᔢ Free oscillations to SHM periodic is a a include attached motion displacement from The conditions for ᔢ The displacement–time ᔢ The velocity–time SHM in a fixed ᔢ undergoing the motion of a simple pendulum and a mass spring. SHM are an also and the and acceleration directed oscillating graph for graphs are which point the an mass object is proportional towards and a the fixed the restoring force. undergoing acceleration–time to point. SHM is graphs for sinusoidal. an object sinusoidal. 63 9.2 Amplitude, Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this period Displacement section, you Displacement equilibrium to: graph ᔢ understand the terms for frequency, a and express period frequency and simple amplitude distance Figure moved 9.2.1 pendulum. in a stated shows The part dashed direction of line a from the displacement–time point P represents the position represents of the the equilibrium pendulum at a angular instant in time. The distance x represents the displacement. phase difference The ᔢ the position. The particular frequency is and amplitude, position. period, and frequency in terms maximum amplitude. of The displacement SI unit for from the equilibrium displacement and is called amplitude is the the metre. angular frequency. P a x Definitions Displacement in a stated equilibrium Amplitude is the distance direction from moved the position. is the Figure 9.2.1 Diagram illustrating displacement and amplitude maximum displacement from the equilibrium Period, frequency and angular frequency position. Suppose T is the a simple time Figure 9.2.2 period T is pendulum taken for illustrates one a is displaced oscillation. and The left SI displacement–time to unit graph oscillate. is the and The second shows period (s). how the determined. Definitions displacement/m The period is the time taken for one r oscillation. The frequency oscillations is per the unit number of time. r 0 time/s Equation 1 f = Figure 9.2.2 Determining T from a displacement–time graph T f – frequency/Hz T – period/s Frequency hertz 1/T (Hz). f is If the one oscillations Angular number of oscillation are frequency oscillations is produced (angular produced in 1 per in unit a time. time T, The then SI it unit follows is the that second. velocity) ω is defined as the rate of change of –1 angular displacement Angular frequency (see and 7.1, Motion frequency Equation are in a circle ). related by The the SI unit following is rad s equations. Equation 2π ω = 2πf ω = T –1 ω – angular frequency/rad s –1 f 64 – ω – angular frequency/rad s T – period/s frequency/Hz Chapter Linking Simple simple harmonic Consider a turntable. beam t = of 0, The The B. shadow The is moves Distance of parallel of a produces at O. from At O a to = r sin (ωt) peg moves this t, back the and movement (Figures disc of are closely radius angular of circular the disc r, peg motion related. attached velocity on rotates a Oscillations ω. to A screen. through a horizontal an At time angle θ. P . OP of a shadow time ωt the to and motion constant = motion beam attached at motion circular θ amplitude harmonic and rotates light shadow shadow peg disc parallel the motion vertical The harmonic 9 9.2.3 is and forth r. The between shadow the points moves A with and simple 9.2.4). light parallel beam of light A wooden shadow peg P r θ 0 ω B turntable turntable Figure 9.2.3 screen Experiment showing the relationship between SHM Figure 9.2.4 and circular motion (side view) Experiment to show the relationship between SHM and circular motion (top view) Example The graph in Figure 9.2.5 shows how the acceleration of an 2 a /m s object undergoing simple harmonic motion varies with time. Determine: 45 a the period b the frequency of oscillation t /ms 0 c the angular d the amplitude frequency, x of ω the oscillation. 45 0 a Period b frequency T = 50 ms 1 f 1 = Figure 9.2.5 = = 20 Hz –3 T 50 × 10 –1 c angular d a frequency ω = 2πf = 2π(20) = 126 rad s 2 = –ω x Maximum acceleration a occurs at maximum displacement (amplitude) 45 –3 x = – = – = 2 0 – 2.83 × 10 m 2 ω (126) Key points ᔢ Displacement equilibrium is the distance ᔢ Amplitude is the maximum ᔢ The is the time ᔢ The frequency ᔢ Circular period moved in a stated direction from the position. is motion the and displacement from taken for number simple of one the equilibrium position. oscillation. oscillations harmonic per motion unit are time. closely related. 65 9.3 A simple pendulum and a mass–spring system Learning outcomes On completion should ᔢ be derive of a able the of this A section, The mass pendulum m is displaced to the right through an arc x (Figure 9.3.1). to: equation for simple you simple the Restoring force = For angles mg sin θ period x small (in radians) sin θ ≈ θ ≈ pendulum l x ᔢ derive of a the mass equation for on a the period Therefore, Using ᔢ describe the kinetic and the interchange potential simple force = mg ( ) l Newton’s second law F = ma between energy F Acceleration during restoring spring harmonic towards O mgx = gx = motion. ÷ m m = l l gx Acceleration in the direction of x, a = – l 2 Comparing with the equation for simple harmonic motion a = –ω x gx θ 2 = ω x l 2π l But ω = T 2 g 2 2π ∴ = l ( 4π = ) T 2 T 2 x 4π l 2 T = g mg sin θ l T = 2π mg Figure 9.3.1 √ g A simple pendulum A mass Consider obeys attached to a spring Hooke’s applied and e is small by k(e mass = the mass is oscillations + x). The – = pulled m in a + second k is = to the produced it. Assume spring (Figure that constant, the F spring is the force 9.3.2). ke vertical x) attached where downwards resultant k(e Newton’s ke, spring extension mg ke Using F the ∴ When with law a a plane. The downward ke – law ke – distance F = ma – kx = ma a = – e tension force kx x = and T released, in the it spring makes is given is – kx kx ∴ (downwards) in the direction m 2 Comparing with the equation for simple harmonic x k 2 = ω m 2π But ω = T mg 2 k Figure 9.3.2 66 A mass-spring system m 2 2π = ( T 4π ) = 2 T motion a = –ω x of x Chapter 9 Oscillations energy /J 2 4π m 2 T = k total energy m T = 2π k e Rewriting in terms of e and g: T = 2π since √ mg = ke = 2π g 2e The period of oscillation for two similar springs in series is T T √ g time /s e/2 The period of oscillation for two similar springs in parallel is T = potential energy 2π g kinetic Figure 9.3.3 Energy When a in simple system is oscillating interchange between total of not is energy damped. displaced harmonic the motion. energy (velocity = at At a 0). Figure at and equilibrium 9.3.3 a When maximum the When is the bob is maximum. the bob at its its kinetic variation of energy energy kinetic that is is the is with at this also a at a energy /J an The system When the is total energy bob simple its point position, at energy, there system. displacement, energy equilibrium potential the oscillates maximum kinetic the of pendulum. system its The motion, energy provided simple the passes therefore the a its is zero velocity maximum. –A A displacement /m minimum. potential energy and potential total energy with time for the motion of a simple energy of a system oscillating with simple energy pendulum. kinetic The Relationships between energy and time harmonic kinetic constant, of released, position, shows and motion and motion simple remains the side with potential system one potential is the Consider to harmonic harmonic motion energy can Figure 9.3.4 be represented graphically as a function of energy displacement. At Relationship between maximum energy and displacement displacement, energy is at maximum a the potential minimum. and the energy At zero potential is at a maximum displacement energy is at a the and the kinetic minimum kinetic energy (Figure is at E a / mJ K 9.3.4). 3.00 Example A spring end of a is through a harmonic from hung spring. the from The small a fixed mass distance motion. y Figure equilibrium is point. pulled and 9.3.5 position is A mass released. shows of of 150 g downwards the the The energy hung its mass variation kinetic is from undergoes with of from the equilibrium free position simple displacement the x /cm x mass. – 1.2 1.2 Figure 9.3.5 Using the figure: a Determine b Determine the angular c Determine the frequency the distance y through which the mass was initially displaced. Key points frequency. of oscillation. ᔢ To derive period in a y = an of equation for oscillation simple harmonic a the system motion, the 1.2 cm restoring force b of Maximum kinetic energy = energy = determined. The acceleration the mass compared the defining of 1 2 kinetic be 3.00 mJ 1 Maximum must first 2 mv = 2 mω 2 (a 2 – x ) is then with 2 equation for simple 1 –3 × 150 × 10 2 × ω –2 {(1.2 × 10 2 ) 2 – 0 } –3 = 3.00 × 10 harmonic motion. There constant 2 –3 2 × 3.00 × ᔢ 10 is a interchange –1 ω = = √ 150 –3 × 10 –2 × (1.2 × 10 16.7 rad s 2 between ) potential energy for ω c Frequency of oscillation f = system kinetic oscillating 16.7 = 2π a and = 2.66 Hz with simple harmonic motion. 2π 67 9.4 Resonance Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this Damped oscillations section, you When a oscillate to: simple with gradually ᔢ describe practical examples describe forced ᔢ displaced over time at its equilibrium practical examples of oscillations understand the concept resistance pendulum. causes That is and position. decreases pendulum is said energy to amplitude the Since say, in to be work an be to and released, amplitude pendulum the of it begins the eventually pendulum transferred is done exponential damped to oscillation is comes oscillating to in against from the air The the air , oscillating resistance. oscillation The of the 9.4.1). displacement/m situations is is higher, larger air resisitance; where energy resonance away manner . (Figure Velocity identify The of resonance ᔢ slightly motion. oscillations air ᔢ decreases is harmonic of rest damped pendulum simple useful and when lost rapidly, amplitude decreases it rapidly should be avoided. time/s displacement/m I Velocity Light damping air is lower, smaller resistance; energy lost more slowly, exponential amplitude decay of decreases less the rapidly time/s amplitude Note: Figure 9.4.1 Figure 9.4.2 the period of oscillation remains constant Graph showing damped oscillations Lightly damped oscillations Initially, This into is the in pendulum the kinetic form energy of as has its maximum potential the energy. pendulum energy This bob when energy begins is it was displaced. converted moving back to the displacement/m equilibrium II Critical damping dependent The on the of velocity resistance amplitude decreases the Figure 9.4.3 Critically damped oscillations motion decreases There displacement/m III an of but are the now bob the lightly ᔢ critically ᔢ heavily is therefore more of degrees is the It to which (e.g. oscillations a start energy initial lost This at the car at As the a rapid some slower be The air the amplitude even the The passes, and the that of rate. time rate why noted is oscillations. oscillations. a though oscillations constant. can pendulum a of amplitude system (e.g. resistance explains remains a air rapidly. should damped, oscillation the the lose be slowly. manner . oscillations damped will of at reduces than Energy pendulum damped greatest smaller decrease period be will exponential the magnitude therefore smaller . different ᔢ the will pendulum would in it oscillation of is Since velocity, oscillating amplitude time/s position. be damped. oscillating suspension in They are: air) system) Heavy damping For a damped system eventually that oscillations. is decreases lightly to damped zero as the the amplitude system comes of to the rest oscillation (Figure 9.4.2). time/s For a system oscillation For Figure 9.4.4 68 Heavily damped oscillations a system (Figure that (Figure that 9.4.4). is critically damped, the system comes to rest after 9.4.3). is heavily damped, the system fails to oscillate one Chapter 9 Oscillations Resonance Systems that frequency. f of the oscillate This with particular system. In the simple harmonic frequency case of a is motion known simple as do the pendulum so at natural of length a particular frequency l, the natural 0 frequency is given by g 1 f = 0 √ 2π In the the case of natural mass m frequency l attached is given to 1 f periodic force the amplitude the periodic the referred Figure as the to 9.4.5 equal the the is the at a spring constant k, m a system increases to as √ to the such force. that significantly natural resonance. periodic forces when frequency At The it of resonance, periodic it the the is oscillate, frequency system. energy force to is of This transferred sometimes driver . illustrates frequency to is known by as oscillations equal is system applied vibration force phenomenon to of is having k 2π a spring, = 0 If a by of a how the the periodic maximum natural amplitude force when frequency of of an changes. the the oscillating The frequency system amplitude of the of varies the periodic force is system. A 0 f driver 0 0 frequency f /Hz Figure 9.4.5 A simple Resonance laboratory phenomenon pendulums. are fixed varying of A A driver paper and OB, the string cones Q, at AOB B. The R attached driver S set The to pendulum, up OB. as Each set OD them. has The all shown up a to is a mass P , in Q, R Figure of will and S pendulum larger have to is the as 9.4.6. have pendulum are to several attached pendulums The demonstrate referred consists driver the oscillating. builds up pendulum pendulums Since begin be arrangement arrangement pendulum oscillating. and is to can The The attached pendulum. begins P , experiment resonance. and lengths oscillation. the to at of The ends pendulums a it Barton’s different and small is called inverted displaced slightly attached to having length amplitude than a the of period the rest string similar of them. O S R Q D driver pendulum Figure 9.4.6 P Investigating resonance 69 Chapter 9 Oscillations Experiment to A mass is attached investigate the between two springs effect of damping as fixed shown in Figure 9.4.7. support ruler spring equilibrium mass position spring signal oscillator generator Figure 9.4.7 A ruler is placed measured. oscillator slightly. rule. The A Experiment to demonstrate resonance The is connected The The adjacent to amplitude period frequency to equilibrium of f the a of the mass position signal the 1 g 2π l is that first oscillation is then displacements noted generator . oscillation = so is is The on the mass measured determined determined. a be An displaced from using The is can ruler . the stop signal metre watch. generator 0 is then signal. mass turned This to oscillate. amplitude signal Figure f 0 The on. of same signal causes The is shows the of is oscillator to the measured the experiment generator frequency oscillation generator 9.4.8 The signal be the mass using results can of of is a to produce move signal the The ray a sinusoidal spring generator recorded. cathode the used set is and forces varied frequency and of the the the oscilloscope. experiment. to show the effect of damping on f 0 0 the Figure 9.4.8 Results of experiment resonance Figure The card shows A small card is attached to the mass the damps the is the motion repeated effect of and of the the damping mass by resonance on the increasing curve resonant is are important resonant to note. frequency is The also peak of the curve. curve is There flatter lower . spring A peak is no damping flatter equilibrium damping position card spring signal oscillator generator 0 f 0 lower resonant frequency when damped 70 the plotted. ruler oscillations shown in drag. The Figure are 9.4.10 two things support that Figure 9.4.9 as 9.4.9. experiment fixed curve. Use of a card to damp the Figure 9.4.10 Effect of damping on the resonant curve and wider and Chapter Unwanted In cities, tall common, by buildings large to seconds. to buildings. 2010, an in Haiti. In reduce Situations Microwave Even though examples is the of the As the of The at a temperature force of the the resonance resonance body. are hydrogen Electric T uning is The Large earthquakes waves amounts buildings 7.0 buildings energy are destroyed caused are produced of are are major designed with useful The patient emit produce radio an of the thermal region this food many W ater microwave exploit are appliance resonance. the inside and there household cookers to energy fact. oscillate. spreads it. (MRI) non–invasive structures body placed in molecules a disastrous, use lies increases is the be common make warming nuclei is to can A Microwave internal human transmitted to where occur . magnitude that imaging imaging view the ovens water thereby Hydrogen nuclei processed there are in are used a person frequency medical the signals occurring amounts basis magnetic cause diagnostic processes huge as large and and for field. are the imaging Radio to in hydrogen this resonance which of frequency occur . detected The and image. circuits circuits resonance. capacitors two In present. pulses food, to useful. water Magnetic used is region. the technique. resonance earthquakes. frequency throughout nuclei of countries, resonance Microwave oscillate microwaves human of can areas occurs, resonance effects The technique resonance effects In oscillate. earthquake resonance electromagnetic Magnetic to with Oscillations cookers microwave. the destruction wealthy where where molecules of naturally. buildings In destruction dampers forces associated oscillate amounts earthquakes transferred in problems 9 in These and electrical types of inductors. components at the devices circuits An such have electric circuit’s as radios, reactive current resonant make use elements will oscillate of such as between the frequency. Key points ᔢ Air resistance ᔢ The ᔢ Oscillations ᔢ Resonance amplitude frequency ᔢ Damping ᔢ There the and friction are of can oscillations be occurs of the affects lightly, when a can be oscillations decreases critically or the frequency oscillating where to when the damped. damped. heavily of be damped. driver is equal to the natural system. resonant frequency situations effects cause resonance curve. can be useful and situations where catastrophic. 71 10 Refraction 10. 1 Refraction Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this Refraction section, you Consider side to: of water ᔢ state the laws of refraction a large the container container section to (Figure of water . create 10.1.1). a A deep A piece water straight of wood section bar is is placed and then a used on one shallow to produce of straight wavefronts travelling from the deep water to the shallow water light (Figure ᔢ understand the term 10.1.2). boundary refractive direction index at understand the terms ᔢ and discuss The angle, as practical internal wavefronts of a of change the change in wave deep direction. speed also water–shallow of the changes. water This wave The change and is in called as the wave travels from deep water to frequency shallow water . applications behaves when a ray densities. as shown the water shallow as of light a wave light angle Figure where of and travels Consider in surface The a ray of 10.1.3. the ray incidence i as such between light The the be travelling the refracted. media nor mal strikes is can two is of from a medium line boundary angle Refraction different drawn the 1 at between between occurs optical to medium right the normal angles two and 2 to media. the water incident Figure 10.1.1 the reflection. Light deep the result strike total internal reflection the total a wavelength constant Refraction of of wavefronts critical remains angle the some occurs refraction. ᔢ If A container of water and the ray. The angle refracted of refraction r is the angle between the normal ray. sin i The ratio is a constant, and is called the refractive index sin r deep water The refractive index of medium 2 with respect to medium 1 is n 1 2 sin i Therefore, n 1 = . This is known as Snell’s law 2 sin r c 1 It can also be shown that n 1 = , where c 2 is the speed of light in 1 c 2 medium 1 and c is the speed of light in medium 2. 2 If the ray of light was travelling from medium 2 to medium 1, the Note: refractive index of medium 1 with respect to medium 2 is n 2 speed and wavelength 1 decreases 1 frequency is unchanged Therefore, n 2 direction of wavefronts = 1 n change 1 2 c v The Figure 10.1.2 absolute refractive index, n, of a material is defined as n = , Refraction of water waves c m where c is the speed of light in a vacuum and v the c is the speed of light in m material. normal Suppose n c 2 and 1 the n absolute refractive index of medium 1 and medium 2 were respectively. 2 c v For r medium medium 1, n 2 = Equation (1) Equation (2) 1 c 1 medium c 1 i v For medium 2, n = 2 c 2 n c 1 c 1 Equation (2) ÷ Equation (1) 72 c v ÷ c 2 Figure 10.1.3 c v = n 2 c v = c 1 c 1 × c 2 1 = c v c 2 Chapter Snell’s law can be rewritten Refraction n sin i Therefore, 10 1 as 1 = or n sin i = n 1 sin r sin r 2 n 2 Laws of 1 The refraction incident ray, the refracted ray and the normal at the point of i incidence lie in the same plane. sin i 2 The ratio is constant, where i is the angle of incidence and r is sin r i < the When a angle a ray medium normal When of of (e.g. a of ray light travels higher air of C refraction. to from optical a medium density, the of lower refracted optical ray density, bends to towards 2 the glass). light travels from a medium of higher optical density, to a C medium normal of lower (e.g. optical glass to density, the refracted ray bends away from the air). i = Critical angle and total internal C reflection 3 Consider a incidence 90°. ray of called There are light the travelling critical three from angle, scenarios to glass C, for angle of incidence < C. The ray 2 The angle of incidence = C. The angle along the surface of the is There the (Figure The refracted air . which consider 1 is to angle an of angle of refraction is 10.1.4). refracted of is out refraction of is the i glass. 90° and the ray glass. i > 3 The n angle sin 90° of incidence = n 1 sin C, > but C. The sin 90° ray is reflected back inside the C glass. Figure 10.1.4 =1 2 n 1 g Therefore, sin C = = n n a g a cladding In scenario 3, the ray of light is said to be totally internally reflected. The θ angle of incidence and the angle of reflection are 3 equal. θ 4 core θ θ 2 Conditions for total inter nal 5 θ 6 reflection θ 1 cladding 1 Light must dense 2 The be travelling medium angle on (e.g. from glass incidence internal surrounded density fibre at critical occurs. Fibre than one a The is material glass. end. angle optic reflection by A ray The for the light cables is used of be in light, of fibre guided used dense to an optically less cables, The the a fibre in critical laser , is the and until the very cladding inside boundary extensively the angle. Figure 10.1.5 glass Key points A fibre optic cable reflection typically incidence along than optic cladding. glass-cladding are greater internal called angle optically air). must Applications of total T otal to an it a is of into greater internal reaches fibres lower projected fibre total field thin has the optical the than glass ᔢ reflection other a end. communications Refraction direction the result the is of of the a a change wave that change in in occurs speed as of wave. to sin i ᔢ transmit data in the form of light pulses (Figure The is ratio a constant, and 10.1.5). sin r Expensive Cheaper engagement rings made rings from contain glass diamond sparkle much crystals less, which because is ‘sparkle’. glass refractive of 2.42. index The respectively. from the many total 1.50, critical Each flat angle internal of are while angles ray surfaces reflections critical of of for light inside reflections, glass that the perceived diamond diamond by our that more a larger diamond diamond diamond means hence and enters has before eyes there as is are refractive 41.8° reflects finally ‘sparkle’. a ‘sparkle’ greater than in and index. The critical angle, of incidence for C, is of refraction which the the angle angle 24° is 90°. times emerging. The refractive index many The smaller chance the has ᔢ a called for many ᔢ Total when internal the greater reflection angle than of the occurs incidence critical is angle. glass. 73 Revision Answers found to on questions the that require questions calculation can be 7 4 a accompanying CD. mass b 1 Explain what is meant Calculate A of the 120 g simple is in potential raised pendulum energy through consists of when a 1. 1 mm. a [2] light by: inextensible a oscillations [1] b free [1] c simple The oscillations harmonic gain motion. variation horizontal [2] string of and the a bob of potential displacement of mass of energy the bob 120 g. with is x, the shown below. 4 potential 2 Describe 3 The an example of a free oscillation. energy / 10 J [2] 15 centre with of simple a cone of harmonic a loudspeaker motion is oscillating of frequency 1200 Hz 10 and amplitude 0.07 mm. Calculate a the angular frequency b the maximum of the oscillations [2] 5 acceleration of the centre of the cone. [2] x /mm Sketch a graph displacement the to x of show the the variation acceleration with of the 30 centre A cone. 10 20 30 [3] pendulum bob oscillates with simple bob Its displacement varies with of the pendulum is displaced sideways harmonic until motion. 10 of The 4 20 time as its centre of mass is raised through a vertical shown distance of 1. 1 mm and then released. below. c displacement /m Copy the figure variation, as and the i the total ii the kinetic sketch pendulum graphs to show oscillates, of x the with: energy [2] energy. [2] 0. 18 d Determine the amplitude of oscillation of the pendulum. t /s [2] 0 8 0. 18 a Explain what b A of a piece meant Plasticine® spring. The is is spring is is able to vibrate in begins to vibrate and forced to by the term attached attached a vertical the to ‘resonance’. to a one end support plane. The mass-spring [2] of that support system is Determine: a the amplitude b the period c the frequency of of the the oscillation oscillate. [1] oscillation i Explain ii Sketch what is meant by forced oscillations. [1] [2] d the angular frequency [1] e the acceleration [1] f 5 [1] i when the displacement is zero ii when the displacement is at the Derive maximum velocity an expression for of the the a of iii [1] maximum pendulum period tude of bob. oscillation [2] pendulum. the to mass show the variation with frequency of of ampli- vibration Plasticine the same axes show the ® [3] is now flattened oscillations as in effect b (ii) of to be sketch so that it damped. On another the graph damping. to [3] a c simple graph support. causes [2] of of the The a State one situation in which resonance is useful. [6] [1] d 6 Derive an expression for the period of oscillation State one hazard. two 74 identical springs in parallel. situation in which resonance can be a of [6] [1] Revision questions 9 a State the laws of refraction. [2] 8 b The speed of of light light in in air glass is is 3.00 1.99 × 10 ×10 Discuss 11 The one application of total m s . The refractive index of glass for incident on a face of a red light is 1.510. Red . Consider light ray reflection. [2] –1 m s 8 a internal –1 8 speed 10 4 prism as travelling at 3.00 × 10 –1 m s is incident at an shown angle of 32° on an air–glass boundary. Calculate: below. a the angle b the speed of c the critical of refraction for red light in red light glass 60° angle for the air–glass interface. 30° i Calculate used ii to the make Calculate the refractive the index of the glass prism. critical [2] angle for a glass/air interface. iii Sketch the ray a [2] diagram inside to the show prism what and as happens it leaves to the prism. iv Calculate [3] the emerges from angle the of refraction prism. when the ray [4] 75 11 Waves 11. 1 Waves Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this Describing section, you When to: point ᔢ understand a stone moving that a wave away of a is wave dropped from impact P . on into The the a lake ripples surface at or of a point waves the lake. P , circular transmit The ripples energy point Q is are away a seen from short the distance transmits away from P . A side profile from the point P to Q is shown in Figure 11.1.1. energy It ᔢ define the terms is the amplitude, period, frequency when applied to a understand the terms P phase and Q. The is of the either energy the stone of the surface of move is which wave transfers actually energy travelling from from along the line PQ oscillate about a fixed P point. is to transmitted A propagate. or will be make up it this is an type of wave. The is In that can order wave example wave There one waves waves . considered. into the wave Mechanical longitudinal dropped by mechanical are be to a in at right a the ways substance classified transverse oscillate a describe produced of various requires as wave, lake wave. angles a when The propagation way to free produce end up of a and the to the wave. transverse down with wave your is to fix hand one until end of waves a are rope and produced. the the wave from the side will produce a picture similar to the wave lake. energy Figure at water particles lake in of of the Viewing flow that wave was that Another Q P stone the water wave direction point that any particles waves. which particles travel understand without transverse transverse of to Q, water classifying through phase difference direction to wave. It ᔢ point and to speed important displacement, the The 11.1.2 dashed illustrates line the represents main the characteristics rope in its of the undisturbed wave. or rest position. The dropped up Figure 11.1.1 A Profile of a wave and down motion progressive energy along wave with of is it. the one hand that The generates moves wave in in a Figure a transverse particular 11.1.2 is progressive direction, made up of wave. carrying a series of crest crests λ point P The and P troughs. on the The wave wavelength λ distance from of a the wave x, rest is represents position. the the The distance displacement SI unit between is two the of the metre. successive crests a x or two The successive amplitude from the Suppose a period rest a of a the time. The The SI movement The SI progressive position. that of troughs. point a is wave unit of P unit is the is the single oscillates metre. the maximum displacement metre. particle about (point the rest P) or is observed over equilibrium trough position Figure 11.1.2 of the rope. Figure 11.1.3 shows how the displacement of the Snapshot of a wave particle varies with time. The particle varies sinusoidally graph with shows that the displacement of the time. displacement /m One complete cycle or oscillation is made up of one crest and one trough. The T time the The T 0 taken wave for and number one is cycle shown of or by oscillation T in oscillations Figure per unit is the time the The frequency frequency of and the wave period of and a is T wave are a the SI period unit point = Variation of displacement T – period/s; f – in related f 76 of measured 1 of P with time The on is a of the oscillation of second. wave is known time/s as Figure 11.1.3 called 11.1.3. frequency/Hz hertz by the (Hz). following equation. Chapter The speed case refers of a wave is the distance travelled per unit time. Speed in 11 Waves this Exam tip and the to the rate wavelength at can which be energy used to is being determine transferred. the velocity The of a frequency wave. The When derivation is shown reading period from Time taken During this for one time the wavelength or below. oscillation the wave = would T on travel a distance = the a graph check the label x-axis. λ distance speed = time 1 v = λ × T displacement /m λ direction of the wave = T T Q P 1 But R = f ∴ v = fλ distance along λ –1 v – speed/m s Phase ; and f – frequency/Hz; λ – the wavelength/m phase difference Figure 11.1.4 All the Not particles all the particular some For are the other . The wave measure Phase be of relationships P and the with the are the vibrate wave particles about move may be their mean together . moving At positions. at Q on the same while Key points the point particle fraction Q. of sometimes transverse time. R The the P is and are moving phase of oscillation measured wave Q in in said Figure to be downward a particular that has degrees or been 11.1.4 in ᔢ Waves are in phase with each other have zero phase and is point on ᔢ Mechanical material a to completed. radians. difference. transmit completely out of phase have a phase difference of π two waves P and Q shown in Figure two exists waves between are the not two in phase waves. with The each phase Mechanical by the waves or can either be longitudinal. or180°. Displacement of a point on a 11.1.5 other . A phase difference φ is the distance from equilibrium difference between them the position. is ᔢ determined which travel. wave The a that ᔢ Consider require through Particles Particles radians waves medium transverse are energy. phase ᔢ that The phase of a point on a wave any upwards, downwards. at particle phase wave up some moving particles out a make time, upwards therefore is of mechanical that in may moving each a particles example, with in instant particles both wave/m The wavelength of a wave is the following: distance between two successive y points Phase difference φ = × in phase. 2π λ ᔢ The graph in Figure 11.1.6 shows two waves P and Q that completely The amplitude maximum of phase. The phase difference between them is π radians or wave is the the 180°. ᔢ The period position. of a wave is the time displacement /m taken for P Q P a displacement from equilibrium displacement /m of out ᔢ Q one oscillation. The frequency of the oscillations per wave rate number of a wave is second. y ᔢ distance λ distance speed which the wave/m the The a energy is is being the at transferred. wave/m ᔢ The on phase a wave fraction Figure 11.1.5 of along along Phase difference between Figure 11.1.6 of of is a a the particular measure point of oscillation the that Waves that are out of phase has been completed. two waves 77 11.2 Transverse Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this and longitudinal Transverse section, Mechanical you particles to: ᔢ understand between a the and In a appreciate that a transmits to progressive the energy from that the wave is amplitude ᔢ explain ᔢ understand be waves wave. based T wo longitudinal on types the of movement mechanical of the waves are slinky spring waves. differentiate and In order the between to other the produce end is a two types transverse moved up and of waves, wave , down a one end repeatedly. of the In slinky this the particles oscillate at right angles to the direction of type travel of one wave. intensity of Light is an example of a transverse wave. order the term that polarised to produce a longitudinal wave , one end of the slinky is fixed a and the other this type end is moved back and forth as shown in Figure 11.2.1. In proportional of wave, the particles oscillate in the same direction of travel of squared the can and classified the another understand to to used. wave, In ᔢ be up waves progressive the point be fixed of wave order can wave is ᔢ can make waves longitudinal difference transverse longitudinal waves that transverse and waves wave. Sound is an example of a longitudinal wave. polarisation transverse and waves a Transverse wave direction of travel of the wave direction of travel of the wave longitudinal cannot. b Longitudinal wave Figure 11.2.1 How a slinky spring can be used to illustrate transverse and longitudinal waves A transverse case of When of a in a a is easily longitudinal longitudinal series which region wave of illustrated wave, wave the particles where the are particles visualising is compressions using travelling and can towards moving sinusoidal be through rarefactions . moving are it a each away In the difficult. a A curve. medium, it compression other . from each A consists is a region rarefaction is a other . Definitions A longitudinal However, In a transverse wave, the particles medium vibrate at right the direction of energy troughs a in the longitudinal medium wave, vibrate the in particles the same of energy each a sinusoidal wave produced other variation At and molecules low a and illustrated rarefactions wavefor m. by pressure. of a as a transverse cor respond Figure loudspeaker. pressure compression, this are transfer. a 78 on the loudspeaker. air direction sometimes to wave. peaks 11.2.2 The illustrates sinusoidal a wave transfer. illustrates In is angles longitudinal to wave compressions in and the the the cor responds moving away to of air the air molecules molecules are a high pressure. from each other and in front moving At a this of the towards rarefaction, the cor responds to Chapter loudspeaker T C T C T C T C 11 Waves T direction the of travel longitudinal of wave pressure distance the Figure 11.2.2 Visualising a longitudinal wave Progressive A progressive and transfers wave transverse is example a wave is is and of longitudinal direction, waves energy Both an along wave a a wave from energy is to produced wave. to waves progressive transmitted its is location longitudinal traverse progressive related that one As in can be wave. the a result of progressive Sound wave that as vibrations another . is moves same an in a direction. waves. Light example of particular The intensity of a amplitude. 2 I The of intensity the more the is wave. low, the wave a is is a with a a smaller by small be by a the the a of ear by the to human feel as energy. the T ake a amplitude low as for a example, volume with decibel the waves high vibrations transmits the waves When sound ear the When progressive human of amplitude amplitude. longitudinal able square large loudspeaker . amount produces will to with longitudinal perceived you wave produced perceived speaker This proportional that produces transmit instances, is wave being This the amplitudes. A means speaker waves increased, some than waves amplitudes. These a This energy sound of ∝ small level. volume with decibel from the is larger level. In speaker . Example –2 A sound wave Calculate an the amplitude of amplitude intensity of of a 0.15 mm sound has wave an of intensity the same of 3.2 W m frequency, . which has 0.45 mm. 2 Recall that I ∝ I = A 2 ∴ kA –2 Initially, A = 0.15 mm and I = 3.2 W m –3 3.2 = k = k × (0.15 × 10 2 ) 3.2 8 = –3 (0.15 Now the changed frequency to of the sound × 10 wave 1.422 × 10 2 ) is the same, but the amplitude has 0.45 mm. 2 I = kA = (1.422 = 28.8 W m 8 × 10 ) –3 × (0.45 × 10 2 ) –2 79 Chapter oscillations several 11 Waves in Polarisation planes direction In of travel of wave transverse of propagation of oscillation illustrated plane at right direction the Figure 11.2.3 of angles travel to of In a in Figure An of easy a the be wave. in Figure oscillations In any an one are perpendicular unpolarised of an infinite to transverse number the direction wave, of the planes. plane This is 11.2.3. wave, the oscillations are restricted to one plane as shown way to and understand move the the free concept end up and of polarisation down with is your to fix hand one end until waves wave An unpolarised wave are produced. are said to side be to are The waves vertically side, said the to be produced polarised. waves are If produced horizontally in you a vertical move lie in a polarised. It plane. your hand These horizontal plane. is to possible waves horizontally These produce waves in in plane in the 11.2.4. rope waves one of can polarised from oscillations waves, different planes of polarisation by simply adjusting the angle at which only direction your of travel of wave hand Consider moves. a situation where the light from a filament lamp is viewed with ® the is naked placed appears eye. in to An front have oscillations of intensity, of the lamp reduced. the I, light will and The be then reason waves to observed. viewed, for one this plane. the is It When a sheet intensity that the of sheet therefore of Polaroid the light restricts prevents the most ® of plane at right angles the light rotated direction of travel in Figure 11.2.4 from reaching the eye. If the sheet of Polaroid a plane perpendicular to the direction of travel of light, is now the of intensity the waves to is unchanged (Figure 11.2.5). wave A polarised wave I light waves are not polarised Polaroid® sheet I intensity of light is light reduced Figure 11.2.5 are waves polarised The effect of a sheet of Polaroid® ® Suppose rotated and to plane rotated second through reduced one a the T ransverse direction in of 90°, a it have planes. propagation. longitudinal is first the is to not In a test waves. only used have these zero Since light are restricts the the the first is pass by transverse only sheet the oscillations oscillation to the polarised. between to the can one direction Therefore, transverse is through waves. to but now sheet, second to first, light 11.2.6). parallel be of the perpendicular the oscillations cannot of waves (Figure wave, distinguish front through exhibited which waves to pass transverse Polarisation waves Longitudinal a is to in intensity through. allow oscillations placed The waves pass reduced that now sheet. light will property Longitudinal Polaroid allowed propagation. polarisation 80 is of the intensity waves different plane. of is to When light through hence Polarisation be 90° zero. of sheet and Chapter 11 Waves ® There are many sunglasses Liquid to reduce cr ystal engineers glare displays often measure under examples use the of by the limiting found the in effect amount polarising of the digital of effect amount of watches polarisation stress distributed to of light. light are Polaroid entering polarised. per for m the eye. Str uctural experiments throughout a component test. I intensity Polaroid® sheet is Polaroid® reduced sheet to rotated zero through 90° Figure 11.2.6 T able 11.2.1 transverse Table 11.2.1 summarises wave and a the similarities longitudinal and differences between a wave. Comparing transverse and longitudinal waves Transverse Similarities Transfers direction the energy of reflection, Particles wave and that the Transfers of direction be Light, refraction, at of up right energy energy of the Particles wave transfer polarised and that the of direction of be refraction, interference make oscillate Cannot microwaves in propagation reflection, diffraction angles wave wave Shows interference make oscillate direction Can Examples in propagation the diffraction to Longitudinal wave Shows Differences wave in up the energy the same transfer polarised Sound Key points ᔢ In a the ᔢ In a transverse direction A ᔢ The of progressive direction ᔢ wave, as energy wave, energy progressive intensity wave of the a particles in the medium vibrate at right angles to transfer. the particles in the medium vibrate in the same transfer. transfers energy from progressive wave is one point proportional to to another. the amplitude squared. ᔢ In an unpolarised ᔢ In a ᔢ Transverse ᔢ Longitudinal plane wave, polarised waves wave, can waves the be oscillations the are oscillations in are various planes. restricted to one plane. polarised. cannot be polarised. 81 11.3 Superposition Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this The section, move two ᔢ state the principle two off steel The ᔢ draw the marbles term and wide gap to recall show narrow wavelength using towards to a very a a towards It point different point something amplitude is diffraction the formula projected directions. is P each easy on a to other , they visualise this collide if you and project table. P in with two space, waves. they pass When two through waves each are other . diffraction 4A. each ᔢ is towards However , diagrams are different situation directed understand particles in superposition of superposition ᔢ diffraction principle of When you to: and of one Assuming other , the of interesting the that waves the two amplitude of happens is A and waves the at the arrive resultant the point P . amplitude at the wave point at Suppose of the P the in the second phase point P is wave with 5 A. If determine the waves arrive the amplitude at the point P completely out of phase with each other , diffraction of the resultant wave at P is 3 A. This phenomenon can be grating. explained The at wave a 1 the of they algebraic Consider P source principle of superposition superimpose superposition states on that each when other and (Figure two the or 11.3.1). move resultant waves arrive displacement two sum of waves, the individual wave 1 and displacements wave 2 as shown of in each wave. Figure 11.3.2. Both 2 w waves two is source principle point, the 2 is e v a using are in waves phase with combine, produced. Notice by each other . applying that the (Phase the difference principle amplitude of the of is zero.) When superposition, resultant wave is these wave twice 3 as 1 large as wave 1 and wave 2. Figure 11.3.3 shows what happens when Figure 11.3.1 wave Definition 1 and or superposition more waves 2 arrive out of phase. displacement /m a Principle of wave arrive at a displacement /m wave wave 1 1 a – when two point, the time/s resultant displacement is the algebraic at that sum of the displacements of point individual time/s –a each wave. –a a wave 2 a wave 2 time/s –a time/s resultant wave –a 2a wave 3 resultant wave a wave 3 time/s time/s –a 2a Figure 11.3.2 Applying the principle of superposition (waves in phase) 82 Figure 11.3.3 Applying the principle of superposition (waves out of phase) Chapter 11 Waves Diffraction Diffraction edge of an observed is the object or through of spreading through a to the width the in the wavelength out gap, gap. of the It the a of gap. wavefronts, In order wavelength is important wave when of to for the when a wave significant wave note that diffraction occurs. the diffraction must there passes be is Definition be comparable no This to change Diffraction wavefronts be illustrated when sketching diffraction diagrams. the of a spreading wave when out of they pass information through should is Light has a gap or pass the edge of an a obstacle. very to small occur , For this This player generated to be can and experiment Sound They a CD The be a of be player light easily be light easily can be doesn’t in order for comparable is on not the heard bend diffraction to normally other in the have through another around a light in our much doorway. room corners of wavelength. observed hand, diffracted demonstrated are wavelength bar . As produced what performed Figure 11.3.4 (a) that should waves can straight shows is means gap but to not allow the seen. waves (c) This the diffraction seen. using plane (b) why be Diffraction (a), the wavelengths. explains tank, of experiences. necessarily CD width reason everyday larger wavelength. the before = is the and seen using in bar move from gaps a ripple vibrates towards above and tank. on the the edge λ a Plane surface gap. Figure ripple of waves the an tank of are the 11.3.4 when the object. wavelength after = λ wavelength after = λ wavelength after = λ Narrow gap diffraction wavelength Figure 11.3.4 (b) before = λ Wide gap diffraction wavelength before = λ object Figure 11.3.4 (c) If the gap is diffraction same the made will principle door doesn’t Diffraction at the edge of an object that allows allow much occur . waves applies light the smaller The to to pass a than will wavelength pass microwave through microwaves the not to so escape cooker . that from of through you The can inside the the metal view the wave, gap. the It no is grid this on food, but microwave. 83 Chapter 11 Waves Single When a occurs. slit diffraction single The slit is placed intensity in front distribution of is a parallel shown in beam Figure of light, diffraction 11.3.5. intensity I 0 θ 0 single slit Figure 11.3.5 (a) screen 0 Single slit diffraction distance Figure 11.3.5 (b) along screen Variation of intensity with distance along screen Diffraction A diffraction ruled on a e.g. interference the bright zeroth order grating piece wavelength The gratings of red fringes maximum zeroth order produces a or light) pattern order consists glass of are is = called 1). maximum. fringe a large and at dark maxima. (n The = 0). fringe Figure number When incident bright maximum (n of plastic. right The are fringe next pattern 11.3.6 equally angles fringes The of monochromatic to at the is how on centre called symmetrical illustrates a (a lines single grating, observed fringe is the spaced light a an screen. is the called first about diffraction the grating pattern. n = 2 n = 1 monochromatic n = 0 θ light screen n = 1 diffraction grating n = 2 Figure 11.3.6 Figure Producing a fringe pattern with a diffraction grating 11.3.7 shows the variation of intensity along the intensity n=3 Figure 11.3.7 84 n=2 n=1 n=0 n=1 n=2 n=3 Variation of intensity along the fringe pattern fringe pattern. Chapter The light coherent the path The At incident sources light slits waves is an wavelength of of in phase regions and is and of a ever y where obser ved, half bright fringes of path The are half diffraction obser ved, wavelengths. occurs. difference light inter ference is from waves occurs. grating Waves producing inter ference the wavelengths. the slit, number constr uctive are on at whole destr uctive incident as diffracts slits fringes number light At the phase deviation grating waves. dark odd out the from are where completely angular of difference regions the on 11 are The related to the follows: Equation d sin θ = nλ d – separation θ – angle of λ – wavelength n – nth slits between of in the grating/m zeroth order fringe and the nth order fringe light/m order fringe Example When plane at monochromatic diffraction angles 500 of lines 30° per light grating, to the of the normal millimetre. wavelength second to order the Calculate λ is grating. the incident diffraction The value of normally lines are diffraction on a Exam tip formed grating has When λ 1 × white diffraction –3 light passes grating, a through central a bright 10 –6 Separation of slits d = = 2 × 10 m fringe is observed. On either side of 500 the d sin θ = nλ )(sin 30°) = 2 λ = central spectra bright fringe, (red → violet) a are series of seen. –6 (2 × 10 × λ –6 (2 × 10 )(sin 30°) 2 –7 λ = 5 × 10 m Example Determine the highest order of diffracted beam that can be produced –6 when light a grating of with wavelength a spacing of 2 × 10 m is illuminated normally with 640 nm. d sin θ = nλ Key points Recall, sin θ ≤ 1 (i.e. the sine of an angle cannot exceed 1) nλ ∴ ᔢ ≤ Principle of superposition – when 1 d two or more waves arrive at a –9 n × (640 × 10 point, ) ∴ ≤ the resultant displacement 1 –6 2.5 × 10 –6 2.5 n × 10 that of the of each point –9 n has to be an ≤ × 10 3.91 ᔢ three corresponds on either to integer , 7 algebraic sum displacements wave. Diffraction the highest order possible is n = is principal maxima (the zero order the of a spreading wave when out maxima, plus the edge through of an a gap or pass of they 3. pass This the individual wavefronts Since is ≤ 640 n at the obstacle. side). 85 11.4 Interference Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this Young’s double section, Thomas you and to: on ᔢ explain what is meant Y oung produces a card performed an with slit experiment an interference two slits in experiment pattern. it. The that showed that Monochromatic slits are a fraction light light of a is was made millimetre a wave to in shine width by and are about one millimetre apart. A screen is set up about one metre or interference more ᔢ understand and ᔢ the terms coherence dark shows path difference explain Young’s and away double from fringes the the is slits (Figure observed variation of the on 11.4.1). the screen intensity of using the series of (Figure light equally 11.4.2). along the spaced Figure fringe bright 11.4.3 pattern. screen slit double experiment A principle slit of single slit superposition S A 1 ᔢ state to the conditions produce an interference necessary monochromatic interference light region observable source pattern. S B 2 Figure 11.4.1 Young’s double slit experiment (Top view) 0 intensity x bright fringe central bright fringe distance 0 Figure 11.4.2 x Fringe pattern produced on the screen Figure 11.4.3 Variation of intensity of light along the fringe pattern Coherent waves Coherent waves difference between have the same frequency and hence a constant phase Definition phase Two waves are said to be coherent is a constant phase are T o said each At Constructive produce interference the waves arrive coincide). The displacement two waves is in between Q. If P them and is Q zero. are P in and the waves. phase If P and difference Q are between completely them is out 180°. P of phase and Q are waves. double where light slit, the sources, a diffraction single takes experiment crests of waves slit place (light is as coincide, used. and the a As the light light waves passes overlap. wave) (Figure 11.4.4). These points constr uctive correspond to bright interference fringes on phase resultant greater than interference arrive screen. At interference either fringes out of occurs phase on points occurs the where (Figure screen. In crests and 11.4.5). both cases, troughs These the coincide, points waves are destr uctive correspond to dark superposed. when Path difference (crest Figure trough coincide). The displacement is 11.4.6 illustrates two slits, resultant S and 1 is a. The central zero. the 86 difference and waves. Destructive and coherent coherent the points the the phase P occurs occurs the be Explaining the Definitions of to other , coherent through (crests the waves them. still when other , two difference with between each Consider if Q there with them. point P . bright fringe is at O S . The distance between them 2 and the first bright fringe occurs at Chapter displacement /m wave 11 Waves 1 P a time/s x displacement /m wave 1 S a –a 1 θ θ time/s a wave 0 a 2 –a time/s S 2 λ a –a wave 2 D resultant wave time/s 2a wave Figure 11.4.6 3 Understanding path difference –a resultant a time/s wave wave S 3 P 1 time/s S 2a Figure 11.4.4 Constructive interference P 2 –a Figure 11.4.5 Destructive interference λ Suppose S and S 1 bright emit wave crests at the same time. The point P is a 2 fringe and distance therefore constructive interference must occur at this Figure 11.4.7 point. The distance S P is greater than S P . 2 from S has to travel Therefore, the wave crest interference 1 a longer distance to arrive at P when compared Condition for constructive to 2 the wave the two crest from S . In order for constructive interference to occur at P , 1 crests travelled by must the coincide. wave from S This is can equal only to happen exactly if one the extra distance wavelength λ. S P 1 This 2 extra distance is called the path difference (Figure 11.4.7). S P 2 For constructive zero or a whole interference number of to occur at P , the path difference must be wavelengths. λ/2 S P – S 2 P = nλ n = 0, 1, 2, … distance 1 Figure 11.4.8 So the path difference must be 0, λ, 2λ, Condition for destructive … interference Where For P is the first destructive dark fringe, interference to destructive occur , a interference crest and a must trough occur must at P . coincide. Key points This can only happen if the extra distance travelled by the wave from S 2 is equal to exactly ½λ (Figure 11.4.8). ᔢ For destructive odd number of interference to occur at P , the path difference must be an Young’s shows half-wavelengths. double that slit light experiment behaves as a wave. 1 S P – S 2 P ( = 1 n ) + ᔢ λ n = 0, 1, 2, The principle of superposition … 2 can 1 So the path difference must be 3 ⁄2 λ, ⁄2 λ, … There normal are interference to take conditions, conditions interference that the interference must be Constructive when place satisfied of light to is not produce easily ᔢ must be ᔢ The waves must meet at a the waves are arrive in occurs phase with interference waves each arrive out occurs of phase other. Coherent polarised, waves are waves that point. have If interference coherent. ᔢ ᔢ waves Destructive with waves the observed. observable patterns: The explain other. when ᔢ to experiment. each Under used 5 ⁄2 λ, ᔢ Conditions for be they must be in the same plane a constant phase difference of between them. polarisation. ᔢ ᔢ ᔢ The The waves must amplitudes be of of the the same waves Observable interference can observed must be only The waves must have the same be only when similar . certain ᔢ patterns type. conditions are met. frequency. 87 11.5 Interference Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this experiments Demonstrating section, A you straight travel to: each ᔢ describe experiments of interference waves, sound wood gaps. gaps This can as be used shown causes the in to a ripple tank produce Figure waves to plane 11.5.1. overlap wave fronts Diffraction in the that occurs region at beyond openings. As a result, an interference pattern is produced. There are of points water the of two in to the demonstrate piece towards interference waves on the surface of the water where it is stationary, and points where and it is disturbed. If we assume that the wavefronts represent crests, then microwaves. points of occurs. curved intersection This line CD The the vibrating waves At occurs. with experiment same of corresponds wavefronts. interference are would to This can of where at which constructive intersection crests corresponds to and the of the troughs points of interference line AB meet, with the destructive intersection of the to the wavefronts. also be (Figure coherent. points points points curved strip be The performed 11.5.2). using This interference two would pattern dippers ensure would attached that be the sources similar to that B produced in Figure 11.5.1. A X 0 C vertical vibrations D dipper dipper Figure 11.5.1 Demonstrating interference Figure 11.5.2 E D Using dippers to produce circular wavefronts in a ripple tank Demonstrating the In order to demonstrate interference of the interference of sound sound waves waves the following are required: ᔢ two ᔢ a The identical signal two generator . loudspeakers loudspeakers facing so A the that it line (large zero produces and moved the in in is a front of on O amplitude waves the of are frequency to an the out Y , line the XY . The in At loudness phase and At An O. will 500 Hz observer point will O, When reach destructive of apart a the is to 2 kHz. notice in and adjusted walks sound difference point The 1.0 m generator observer the a to range path at 0.5 signal the The occurs generator . about The oscilloscope). of signal oscilloscope. interference the a are 11.5.3). oscilloscope). towards on to they loudspeakers. along the that (Figure signal constructive sound connected so connected loudness from are adjusted direction amplitude (small 88 same XY variation is are microphone the loudspeakers is this along a heard case is microphone minimum minimum interference value loudness, occurs. Chapter 11 Waves Y loudspeaker P oscilloscope signal a O generator loudspeaker microphone X Figure 11.5.3 Demonstrating interference of sound waves Demonstrating the In order to demonstrate interference of the interference of microwaves microwaves the following are required: ᔢ a microwave ᔢ a metal ᔢ a microwave transmitter plate Microwaves with two slits detector . from the transmitter T are incident on the two slits S 1 and S which are equidistant from T . 2 of region which is is at O is moved from a are S plane of maximum. O towards to occurs. approximately A, another the In slits The path occurs the at as is coherent slits at sources in the decreases the out point of the superpose along 11.5.4). When demonstration, and moved difference O. are the (Figure intensity maximum microwaves this by detector the act 2 diffracted microwave the intensity, interference A interference increasing minimum waves it. to constructive before is The beyond parallel measured and and 1 microwaves. the S the The this to phase a AB, intensity case is microwave X. in line zero detector minimum At and distance a point of destructive between the slits 1–8 cm. metal with A plate two slits X S 1 O T S 2 microwave microwave transmitter detector B Figure 11.5.4 Demonstrating interference of microwaves Key points ᔢ An interference ᔢ Interference connected ᔢ Interference a metal of to sound the of sheet pattern of water waves same microwaves with two can signal slits waves be can be produced produced using two in a ripple tank. loudspeakers generator. can be and a produced by microwave using a microwave source, detector. 89 11.6 Measuring the wavelength of Learning outcomes light ax Derivation of the formula λ = D On completion of this section, you Consider should be able two coherent light sources is the midpoint of S and S 1 derive the formula for separation in Young’s the fringe double screen slit the experiment ᔢ describe measure light an experiment the and S 1 to: M ᔢ S to wavelength using Young’s of double is path A central difference The first The formula central slit D. bright difference S be P equal – S 2 P fringe to occurs derived fringe and is separated by a distance a. 2 distance between the slits and the 2 bright fringe can bright is .The at by the equal is zero. the point P considering first to located adjacent one at the Constructive (Figure the point wavelength In this case, occurs at O. 11.6.1). distance bright O. interference fringe. between The the path λ 1 experiment Consider ᔢ describe an experiment the triangle PMO. to x measure the wavelength of tan θ light = D using a diffraction grating. Consider the triangle S S 2 Q 1 λ sin θ = a P If D For >> a, small the angle angles θ θ is ≈ very sin θ small. ≈ tan θ x S λ 1 x ∴ = θ a θ a D O M ax ∴ Q λ = D S 2 λ The equation is only applicable when D > > a and that S and S 1 act as 2 D coherent (diagram not drawn to sources of scale) Measuring the Figure 11.6.1 light. wavelength of light using the Young’s Deriving the formula for wavelength double slit arrangement D light of wavelength S λ 1 a S 2 travelling microscope double slit with (diagram Figure 11.6.2 The double 1 and S . The to scale) a monochromatic arrangement. light width of of In this wavelength the slits is light λ, is source can experiment incident approximately a be determined parallel normally 0.5 mm beam on and a using of pair the of slits distance 2 between the microscope produced slits is is is used (Figure microscope 90 of slit monochromatic S drawn Measuring the wavelength of light using Young’s double slit experiment wavelength Y oung’s not scale approximately to measure 11.6.2). The approximately 1 mm. the distance 2 m. In distance In this between order experiment, between to the the slits measure a bright and the travelling fringes the travelling distance between Chapter the fringes accurately , the distances between several fringes are 11 Waves measured Equation and the average measurement. separation The taken. disadvantage This of minimises this method the is random the error intensity of in the the ax light λ decreases difficult the as to you move know away exactly monochromatic where light Measuring the from a source the central bright is bright fringe is calculated wavelength of fringe. located. as shown This The makes = it wavelength D of x – fringe λ – wavelength separation/m D – perpendicular (right). monochromatic between light double using a diffraction laser A laser means can is be used used that it as a because diffraction grating of diffraction grating is monochromatic it produces produces a the light/m distance screen and the between the slits/m grating a A of very known a thin light highly beam number of source for collimated of light lines per with this light little metre N experiment. source. used. the separation slits/m This spreading. is – A The Equation is projected on the set up on diffraction a spectrometer . grating such The that it light is at from right the laser angles to it d sin θ λ (Figure 11.6.3). spectrometer . The The angular deviation wavelength of the can light be is measured calculated accurately as shown using n (right). λ The experiment about 1.5 m zero - order using is a One from by the rule. be done diffraction light The and using grating. the angular a screen. The nth- order deviation The screen separation diffracted of the nth is between light order is light of is measuring that it the allows wavelength for a larger using the distance to – the measured diffracted wavelength of monochromatic light/m placed d – distance θ – angular n – light calculation. advantage diffracted also diffracted metre found can = the between slits/m deviation for the nth order nth order diffracted light second- order be measured accurately. One disadvantage diffracted light intensity of diffracted is the of measuring that light it is the difficult decreases as wavelength to pinpoint you move using its the actual away from second- order position, the because zero - order light. top view n = 2 spectrometer n = 1 angular deviation directly from n laser diffraction (known Figure 11.6.3 measured spectrometer = 0 grating spacing) Measuring the wavelength of monochromatic light using a diffraction grating Example Key points A laser produces monochromatic light which is incident at right angles 5 to a diffraction grating. The diffraction grating has 5.6 × 10 lines per ᔢ metre. A screen is located 1.50 m from the diffraction grating. The wavelength monochromatic spots are observed at 0.54 m on either side of the central bright the wavelength of the monochromatic determined slits d = can double slit 1 experiment. –6 between source experimentally light. using Young’s 1 Distance a light spot. be Calculate of Bright = = 1.79 × 10 m 5 N 5.6 × 10 ᔢ The wavelength of a 0.54 –1 Angle between zero - order and first- order light θ = tan ( ) = 19.8° monochromatic light source can 1.5 be determined experimentally –6 d sin θ λ = 1.79 × 10 × = n sin 19.8° = 606 nm using a diffraction grating. 1 91 11.7 Stationary Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this waves Stationary section, Stationary you two to: understand what is meant by describe experiments stationary transverse to produce transverse transverse travelling waves produce ᔢ compare progressive stationary waves same speed can progressive progressive from a right in form wave wave, to stationary A waves. stationary In kept taut produces 2 reflected leaving left. wave are formed type, of opposite stationary travelling of same These by equal the superposition amplitude directions. waves. from speed, two (dashed The can means Both and of frequency Figure longitudinal 11.7.1 left to right. shows frequency progressive Another and waves amplitude superpose is to line). the they of the the a which superpose string of passes small pulley Figure on length string waves oscillator See one several reach wave. velocity produced The of progressive as be experiment, oscillator . by stationary wave wave this mechanical a over weights. travel and with a causing string is it to right. right reflected to waves oscillate pulley mechanical left from to attached frictionless The from travel the by long and a is oscillator The left. to and waves The are waves produce a 11.7.2. incident wave and the reflected wave along the string 1 is Figure 11.7.1 same waves) the and rapidly. wave the of wave a ᔢ with (standing waves a and stationary waves progressive travelling ᔢ waves given by: Producing a stationary wave Equation T v string = pulley √ m –1 v – velocity T – tension m – mass of in wave/m s the string/N –1 oscillator per unit length of the string/kg m weight Figure 11.7.2 Producing a stationary wave on a string Suppose Only a stretched specific illustrates string modes the three of is fixed vibrations simplest at its are modes end and possible of then on vibrations the made to string. (i.e. first, vibrate. Figure second 11.7.3 and A third λ harmonics). frequency at The which it first harmonic vibrates is is called called the the fundamental fundamental and frequency . the The 2 higher first frequencies are called overtones. harmonic The fundamental frequency, (fundamental) f , of a vibrating, stretched string is given by: o Equation A A 1 f T = 0 N 2l N √ m N f – fundamental frequency/Hz 0 second (first harmonic l – length T – tension of m – mass string/m overtone) in the string/N –1 A A per unit length/kg m A N N There N third are points harmonic (second at rest. These is zero. At 92 points points a are stationary called wave midway nodes. where between The particles nodes displacement are on a stationary at permanently these wave points the overtone) displacement Figure 11.7.3 along N points are is twice called the amplitude antinodes (Figure of either 11.7.4). progressive wave. These Chapter The wavelength of the wave is given 11 Waves by: A A A Equation λ = 2d N λ – wavelength d – distance Figure From node shows diagram two the it adjacent position can be nodes/m of seen the that Figure 11.7.4 string all the at various particles points between in time. positions of at various adjacent are in phase with each other . All the particles between N and Nodes and antinodes string string string 2 moving moving in phase with each other . All the particles between N and N 2 also in phase with each other . However , the particles are 3 between N out of phase with the particles between N and N 2 between N and N 1 N and N 2 are moving downwards, . All the N 2 particles 3 while the particles between N N 2 are upwards upwards and 1 are antinode N 1 are points in time nodes A wave/m between 11.7.5 this of N 2 N 3 N 4 5 1 moving upwards. distance 3 along Consider within the one phase cycle of of the the particles wave is at in a a progressive different phase wave. from Each each point the string Therefore, Points A points and D A, are B, C and moving D are at upwards, a different while phase points B in and their C are cycle. A Points E and are F in are phase in with phase each with other . each They other . are They both are moving The The one (Figure amplitude wave. It varies speed end lined of both a of the from and fine a B moving progressive wave E 11.7.6). sound open with downwards upwards. A downwards moving downwards moving Figure 11.7.5 and C string moving downwards. Points string other . stationary zero can the at be a to A closed depends a measured other powder . wave node using as on the maximum a shown loudspeaker , at long in position the cylindrical Figure connected to tube 11.7.7. a along the C F antinode. signal D with The tube Figure 11.7.6 A progressive wave is generator , loudspeaker is placed at adjusted the so tube nodes. open that create The wavelength speed the of the a the The powder stationary distance of end. the wave eventually wave. between sound can frequency the waves be The the settles. powder nodes and of is since The to generator sounds settles used the signal at long is waves tube inside displacement determine frequency is the known, the heaps of powder signal determined. generator Comparing stationary and progressive Figure 11.7.7 waves Producing a stationary sound wave Progressive wave Standing wave Key points Transfers point to energy from one another. Even though transfer the wave energy from has one energy, point to it does not another. ᔢ All up the the particles wave that have make the same amplitude. The particles different zero that make up amplitudes. The (nodes) to a the wave amplitude maximum have Stationary waves) ranges from superposition (antinodes). waves equal All the particles that make There are particles that make up the wave of the the wave are in motion. are stationary phase difference exists particles neighbouring of the by two same the progressive type, of with and frequency the same speed in (antinodes). Between two nodes the neighbouring particles phase difference is zero. (A and directions. between ᔢ between of amplitude opposite A (standing that travelling up waves are formed A node is permanently is a point on a wave that B) at rest. wave. The phase difference between particles A and C ᔢ is π An antinode is the point midway radians. between nodes. 93 11.8 Sound waves Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this Sound section, Sound you describe practical waves in applications discuss the in to liver . application musical understand of that reflected widely in industry. frequency pregnant women, sound and In the waves) internal field is of used organs medicine, to produce such as the images kidney is also used in physiotherapy. same principle used components to determine used in if there are hairline fractures in industries. instruments sound and is sound waves use refracted. are way to is to earth. In Sound The from use determine the the depths submarines waves such as and frequency the fundamental If note the distances location waves lowest determine The sound countries determining harmonic bats determined. Geologists L how transmitted wave first sonar of objects. It operates in a can similar be used high Ultrasound Submarines ᔢ industry of mechanical waves in industry The ᔢ are (very foetuses and sound waves ultrasound to: of ᔢ waves to oil and that a this of objects. time be the taken Sound for the waves reflected calculated. structure technique is of the crucial underlying in gas. instruments vibrating This the then determine musical frequency. and can T rinidad of location string note is or called pipe the can produce is called fundamental (fundamental) a is n times the fundamental, it is called the nth har monic λ L = 2 When a string together A second musical of a the note guitar is plucked, fundamental is notes note. characterised by of These high notes loudness, frequencies are pitch called and are produced overtones timbre . Loudness harmonic of (first with a note depends on the amplitude of sound. Pitch of a note is dependent overtone) on L = the frequency the relative sound. strengths Percussion third of Timbre or quality of a note is dependent on λ of the instrument overtones – steel produced with the note. pan harmonic (second The steel by stick pan is a percussion instrument. It produces sound when struck overtone) a with a piece of rubber attached to its end. When a particular note 3 λ L is = struck, stationary waves are set up on that particular section of the steel 2 pan. Figure 11.8.1 Only certain modes of vibration are possible. The largest amplitude of Stationary waves in an vibration is that of the fundamental frequency. Overtones are also present open-ended tube and give the Stringed characteristic instrument ‘steel – pan’ sound. guitar tuning fork antinode end-correction, c A guitar has transverse resonant tube the ends. certain several waves strings travel Stationary modes of attached along waves the are vibrations to it. string produced are allowed. When and are (refer The a string reflected to Figure string is plucked, on reaching 11.7.3). vibrates Only with the L fundamental frequency as well as the overtones. node Wind A flute across water instrument is one produces and is end, of a the hollow air inside longitudinal wave at the tube. wave far superpose the tube ends The a are begins (pressure end. and Both wave) incident stationary open. to When vibrate. which wave is The travels longitudinal air is vibration along wave produced. blown the and As in tube the the case A resonance tube of 94 a reflected reflected Figure 11.8.2 made – flute the steel pan and guitar , only certain modes of vibrations are allowed. Chapter 11 Waves Resonance tubes A resonance Figure the tube 11.8.2 can shows experiment. A be used the to determine arrangement tuning fork of of the the known speed of apparatus frequency is sound. used to placed perform over the λ air column. The air above the tube vibrates. A longitudinal wave is L L = 4 transmitted the water . Depending vibrations to the down The on are the two the tube waves length possible. frequency of of If the and is reflected superpose the the air and column, fundamental tuning when fork, it produce only the surface stationary certain mode resonance hits a of modes vibration of wave. of corresponds occurs. first At resonance, the sound heard inside the tube is enhanced (a loud harmonic sound (fundamental) is heard). Resonance of the air to the different surface the column of the modes tube. to will occur slowly water . resonance calculations is of An An cater at specific increased. vibrations antinode occur this (Figure of when lengths possible. will end-correction for lengths These A node just c is length correspond will above length the will exist the at open the end sometimes of used in 11.8.3). 3 λ L = 4 Example A a small short loudspeaker distance allowed to increases is run at emitting length = emitting above slowly specific sound 21 cm. a long out of lengths at It a the of next State b Calculate the wavelength c Calculate the speed a Resonance phenomenon is air occurs of taking at of place in of taking the of frequency containing the the water . intensity tube. 400 Hz, length When the = of the the effect is is positioned When sound water is heard loudspeaker first noticed at 64 cm. third harmonic (first overtone) place. the sound sound in constant tube tube, frequency a the sound glass the waves waves in in the the air air column. column. tube. 5 λ L = 4 λ b When resonance first occurs, = 21, ∴ λ = = 64, ∴ λ = 4 × 21 = 84 cm = 85.3 cm 4 3λ When resonance occurs again, 4 × 4 84 c Average wavelength + 64 3 85.3 = = 84.7 cm fifth harmonic 2 (second –2 Speed of sound = f × λ = 400 × 84.7 × overtone) –1 10 = 339 m s Figure 11.8.3 Modes of vibration in a resonance tube Reflection Sound waves concert Sound halls can so material be that absorbing Refraction a and refraction of reflected the when medium in echoes. amount materials occurs as are the of to be to of a waves Acoustical reflection used speed order sound line of the wave engineers sound design is limited. walls. changes. transmitted. waves The Sound speed of waves require sound Key points waves ᔢ in air depends through sunny upper on layers day, the layers of the air temperature of ground are cooler different heats than up of the air . A temperatures the the lower lower sound will layers layers. of be wave refracted. the When Sound waves On atmosphere. someone applications a The ᔢ Sound waves are refracted upwards away from the ground. At the temperature of the lower layers of the atmosphere is waves the upper downwards layers. towards When the someone shouts, sound waves are produced by instruments. Sound waves can be reflected lower and than many industry. night ᔢ time, in shouts, various sound have travelling are refracted. refracted ground. 95 11.9 Electromagnetic Learning outcomes On completion should ᔢ be state able the of this Properties of section, you to: properties waves An electromagnetic electromagnetic at wave magnetic field right graphical representation consists angles of to of each such a an waves oscillating other . Figure electric 11.9.1 field and shows a wave. of electromagnetic waves list magnitude direction of travel of electric field ᔢ of the the orders of wavelengths electromagnetic of electromagnetic wave the spectrum. magnetic field Figure 11.9.1 Properties An electromagnetic wave of electromagnetic waves: 8 ᔢ They travel ᔢ They consist to each at the of They are ᔢ They can travel ᔢ They can be oscillating transverse in a wavelengths. waves Radio shortest electromagnetic Table 11.9.1 (3 electric × 10 and –1 m s ) in magnetic a vacuum. fields at right angles vacuum. diffracted, electromagnetic the light waves. refracted, Electromagnetic have of other . ᔢ The speed can waves and polarised. spectrum be arranged have wavelength. spectr um reflected the They (T able based largest form on the magnitude wavelength, part of what while is of their gamma referred to rays as the 11.9.1). The electromagnetic spectrum Electromagnetic wave Frequency/Hz Wavelength/m –1 Radio waves Lowest frequency >10 –2 Microwaves 10 –4 to 10 –6 Infrared ~10 –7 Visible 7 × –7 10 to 4 × 10 (ROYBGIV) (Red Violet) –8 Ultraviolet ~10 Exam tip –9 X-rays It is expected that you are 10 –11 to 10 able –12 Gamma to recall the the magnitude wavelength of each of waves listed in 10 –16 to 10 the visible part of the electromagnetic spectrum, red light has the the longest wavelength table. wavelength. 96 Highest frequency the In electromagnetic rays of (640 nm) and violet light (470 nm) has the shortest Chapter Table 11.9.2 Type of Radio 11 Waves Sources of em waves and their uses electromagnetic wave waves Source ᔢ Microwaves Infrared Use Transmitters ᔢ Klystron ᔢ Microwave ᔢ All hot tubes ovens objects ᔢ Telecommunications ᔢ Navigation ᔢ Telecommunications ᔢ Heating ᔢ Radar ᔢ Enables systems of food pictures to be taken in the dark. ᔢ Used in fibre optic cables – telecommunications Visible Ultraviolet X-rays ᔢ Hot ᔢ The objects ᔢ Incandescent ᔢ Mercury ᔢ Electric ᔢ X-ray ᔢ Remote control for ᔢ To be ᔢ To kill ᔢ Produces Vitamin ᔢ Medical ᔢ Cancer ᔢ Used able and fluorescent objects. vapour arcs lamps lamp (sparks) tubes bacteria in imaging ᔢ Cosmic ᔢ Nuclear radiation ᔢ Radioactive power plants D – in the skin Radiography treatment industry welded fractures rays see Sun of Gamma to your TV joints in to check and the detect quality ‘hair line’ metals. ᔢ To determine ᔢ Cancer ᔢ Sterilisation the structure of crystals treatment of surgical instruments elements Key points ᔢ Electromagnetic right ᔢ angles The waves each Electromagnetic vacuum, ᔢ to waves transverse, in order of have can electromagnetic arranged consist of oscillating electric and magnetic fields at other. be similar properties diffracted, spectrum increasing can consists of be a (e.g. same speed in a polarised) list of electromagnetic waves wavelengths. 97 Revision Answers found to on questions the that require questions calculation can 5 8 be Determine that accompanying CD. can the be highest produced order when of a diffracted grating beams with a spacing –6 of 1 Explain, using appropriate, clearly the labelled meaning of diagrams where the following amplitude phase In order d the e coherent be particle in difference a wave a Explain when between two waves i [2] waves what is applied meant to i wavelength ii frequency iii speed that 3 a by the following these is three State one c State two conditions a an [1] Describe a deduce an Using wave. between [3] transverse and 12 a the of Describe and example of each similarities describe type between with phenomenon of wave. the two types the that aid of applies a to diagram, one experiment of principle this an why is meant by plane polarisation of Draw waves cannot be An wave how a the [4] ripple to demonstrate tank. [4] waves are produced in the [2] diagram on letter C, to the show water. where Label the interference Label two two is meant the passing diagram wide of is by the term diffraction. width of affects to the the illustrate gap through points pattern with blue what light from at light grating is D, where occurs. [4] diffraction both a of narrow pattern red is a right seen at a and produced on Coherent a passes through a reason, the screen a double-slit effect on the spacing of the fringes observed when, blue light is changes used as the are made: red source instead light. [2] b The distance between c The width each the slits is decreased. [2] wave. of slit in the double-slit gap monochromatic angles to a is gradually increased. [3] One of by the to angles. Use explain principle the slits is covered by an opaque card. [1] light diffraction emerging from certain superposition meant is light [3] projected of letter [2] Young’s double this slit experiment can be used to the measure principle interference the which gap.) Bright diffraction with independently, the following 14 grating. constructive points interference coherent appearance d the wavelength of monochromatic light. the a Describe Young’s b State double slit experiment. [6] effect. [2] how of superposition. the [2] c 7 a arrangement. State with plane- [2] how is beam Explain explain tank. arrangement 6 the [5] superposition, experiment interference when [1] sound what Describe source of coherent of A demonstrate experiment. Explain destructive a c to microwaves. [3] what Explain a [3] in occurs. transverse polarised. and the of waves. a observe [2] only. Explain (Use to [2] Explain a [4] longitudinal 13 b interference. necessary interference the a by: equation for waves. 5 sources [2] produced light two coherent. light. interference c b be [2] b a must ii of ripple 4 meant interference b waves waves from waves: definitions, of Distinguish wave of waves [1] speed State the terms waves. d of [3] interference what results the light 400 nm. coherence State b Using with [2] 11 b normally [1] 10 2 illuminated [1] a phase is observed, Explain of m [1] may c 10 wavelength displacement b × terms: 9 a 2.0 what these measurements measurements are are taken used and to explain calculate wavelength. State [4] approximate values for: When monochromatic light of wavelength λ is incident i the width ii the distance of each between slit the two [1] iii the distance between the double normally on a plane diffraction grating, the second slits [1] order diffraction lines are formed at angles of 28° to the slit and the normal to the grating. The diffraction grating has 600 screen. lines per millimetre. Calculate the value of λ. 98 [4] [1] Revision questions d Explain the roles interference in played the by diffraction production of the and 18 observed fringes. One The [4] taut of 15 A laser produces monochromatic red light end by the 620 nm which is incident at right a diffraction grating. The diffraction long means of oscillator string over a is is attached a frictionless weight of adjusted to an oscillator. pulley and is kept 3.50 N. The frequency is produced. Three so that a antinodes stationary are present on angles the to a passes of wave wavelength of string 5 wave. The distance between the two adjacent grating antinodes is 16.2 cm and the frequency is 118 Hz. 5 has 5.5 × 10 lines per metre. A screen is located Calculate 1.50 m from observed the at the diffraction different distance points between second-order grating. the diffracted on the central Bright spots screen. Calculate bright spot and 19 the light. Distinguish between progressive wave a the by amplitude a wave reference of vibration of and a to: particles in the particles difference in each three they between the energy A string fixed of length points. It is 80 cm along is plucked each stretched at to form a its stationary of the sensations to string. sound and state wave. and wave. A the single sound of constant containing water. When water run a short distance slowly out of the tube, the heard increases = at specific loudspeaker 400 Hz, the 19.7 cm. It next occurs is a long allowed intensity of the lengths of is effect above emitting is first at air in sound noticed length = a at the centre of the two Calculate the 59. 1 cm. air the wavelength of the sound waves column. [3] Calculate the speed of the sound waves in the is meant by a what is meant by an iii why nodes stationary wave a State are formed at the c State the wavelength The frequency Calculate the of of the vibration of the speed of the wave. of the b [2] ends string Explain in c. what is mean t by wave. the sp eed three features regions of is State a typical i red [1] ii ultraviolet [1] iii infrared iv X-rays. 340 Hz. the of waves which are electromagnetic common spectrum. [3] wavelength of: light [1] radiation [1] radiation [1] [1] [2] 22 d all [2] antinode string. b [3] string. to what air antinode 21 ii in string Explain: i at at [2] between centre emitting positioned column. is formed [3] [6] glass tube b vibrates length is a 17 unit on. loudspeaker a frequency of [3] transferred subjective depend the tube. When the neighbouring wave small length c per frequency sound [2] phase A to each wave b mass [4] stationary making State what 20 16 the are calc ulat ed [2] Arrange the following wavelength and infrared : X-rays, waves. in increasing microwaves, magnitude ultraviolet of waves [4] 99 12 The 12. 1 The physics physics Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this of you to: The explain how the ear responds 12.1.1 outer end incoming sound understand the the terms diagram collects the waves and auditory of the directs canal is human sound the ear . waves tympanic into the auditory membrane (ear canal. drum). At The of cause three the tiny tympanic bones membrane called the to vibrate. hammer , the The anvil middle and the ear stirrup. significance When of a wave consists ᔢ shows ear of ear to sound an hearing human Figure the ᔢ of The section, hearing sensitivity the tympanic membrane vibrates, the bones in the middle ear and vibrate as well. The three bones act like a lever system. They reduce the frequency response amplitude ᔢ state the magnitude threshold of of time, the hearing The state the intensity at is use the is produced pressure connected nor mal on on to the the oval back conditions, tympanic the of membrane. window the is throat pressure on At the same increased. via the both eustachian sides of the which membrane is the same. When someone ascends in an aircraft, experienced pressure ᔢ ear Under tympanic discomfort vibration vibrational middle tube. ᔢ the of equation for difference exists on either side of the tympanic membrane intensity resulting in the ear “popping”. level The ᔢ understand the terms noise and loudness inner attached that run signals is filled auditory its stiffness. vibrates ear to entire When which length. the causing oval the are with nerve. Inside These hairs It contains the vary vibrates, to via in are length, liquid The the cochlea, there the resonate. transmitted the cochlea hairs window tiny then liquid. the produce nerve to is tiny thickness inside hairs auditory which many hairs and inner ear electrical the brain, anvil where they are then interpreted. stirrup hammer Frequency auditory canal response and intensity auditory nerve The tympanic cochlea membrane eustachian outer human This tube range ear is the upper the human is able called limit of to the detect frequencies frequency 20 kHz in the range of the ear . response decreases. In the frequency 20 Hz As a range to 20 kHz. person 60 Hz gets to older , 1 kHz, inner ear ear can detect changes of 2 Hz to 3 Hz. At frequencies above ear 1 kHz, it is difficult for the human ear to detect small changes in frequencies. middle ear P Intensity Figure 12.1.1 is the sound power per unit area ( I = A at ) a stated frequency. The human ear The smallest sound intensity that can be detected by the human ear is –12 the threshold frequency Figure ear . of The The shows person. human hearing. 3 kHz. 12.1.2 certain the of ear . The variation Above the of of curve Intensities sensitivity threshold threshold the of the of below the is of 1.0 with cannot the be ability to × 10 W m at a frequency . hearing intensities curve ear is varies threshold represents human hearing hearing called –2 with that frequency can detected detect be by the of detected the a by human smallest ΔI Equation fractional change ΔI of intensity I. Sensitivity depends on the ratio . I Sensitivity Intensity is the power per unit increases with frequency to a maximum and then decreases with area increasing frequency . The maximum sensitivity is at 1–3 kHz. P I = at a stated frequency. The human ear can detect a wide range of intensities. The minimum A –12 intensity that can be detected is 1.0 × 10 –2 W m at a frequency of 3 kHz. –2 I – intensity/W m –2 The P – upper limit of the range is 100 W m in the frequency range 1 kHz 6 kHz. The upper limit is called the threshold of pain . Persons exposed 2 A – to power/W area/m 100 –2 intensities of 100 W m can experience pain and temporary deafness. to Chapter The logarithmic response of the 12 The physics of hearing sound ear intensity intensity level /dB 2 Equal changes in intensity are not perceived as equal changes in loudness. /W m 120 Loudness level the is may the be subjective used following as a response measure equation. of Changes of a person loudness. in to a given Intensity loudness depend intensity . level on is the 1.0 Intensity defined fractional 2 100 10 80 10 60 10 40 10 20 10 0 10 using 4 6 change 8 ΔI in intensity ( ) . I Loudness is a logarithmic response to intensity . 10 12 Example 2 1 A person and an with normal intensity level hearing at the is ear exposed of to 20 dB. a sound Calculate of frequency the intensity 10 at the of 4 10 5 10 10 f /Hz 3 kHz this Figure 12.1.2 sound 3 10 ear . Variation of threshold of hearing with frequency I Intensity level = ( 10 log ) 10 I 0 Equation I 20 = ( 10 log –12 10 1 × 10 ) I Intensity level = 10 log 10 I log 10 ( –12 1 × 10 ) = ( ) I 2 0 Intensity I level is measured in dB (decibels) = 100 –12 1 × 10 I – intensity of sound incident on –2 –10 I = 1 × ear/W m –2 W m 10 I – threshold of hearing 0 –12 (1.0 Loudness Intensity level threshold of Loudness is depends T o a on define a standard. being the as is the defined at The as the standard then of the source 2 W m ) of a of person frequency a to the of be test of to a the frequency is adjusted evaluated. found loudness intensity sound and the 3 kHz. source being is the of loudness, standard source the of response and unit 1 kHz terms frequency individual consistent source, in a subjective the 10 noise hearing loud 1 kHz test and × given of when source is 1 kHz until Suppose 90 dB intensity and sound. it the it is is chosen perceived intensity is as loud as as level as of the 90 phons. Key points Example ᔢ The intensity of sound measured at a distance 2 loudspeaker is measured as 1.2 × 10 of 0.8 m from . Given that the sound varies ear is able to detect in the range 20 Hz to intensity 20 kHz. 1 of human frequencies –2 W m The a as , where d is the distance measured from the 2 d ᔢ loudspeaker , calculate the intensity of the sound at a distance of The threshold of hearing is the 3.0 m. minimum detected intensity by the that can be ear. 1 I ∝ 2 ᔢ d ear k I The sensitivity is the of ability the to human detect the = 2 smallest fractional d intensity change ΔI of I. k 2 1.2 × 10 = 2 (0.8) k = ᔢ Loudness response 76.8 is the subjective of a person to a has a logarithmic given intensity. Therefore the intensity at a distance of 3.0 is given by: ᔢ k 76.8 –2 I = = ear response to sound. =8.53 W m 2 d The 2 (3.0) 101 13 The 13. 1 Lenses physics Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this of sight Lenses section, you A converging When to: a refraction ᔢ differentiate between diverging understand length and the terms the focal f principal axis relate focal lens in recall length to power of ᔢ draw optical the The diagrams are the or lens pole centre of beam is (Figure P of the optical length of light point to show at the the middle surface focused of through than a a at the edges. converging point lens, known 13.1.1). The point P is known as as the the the lens centre of the lens. is of The known the horizontal as lens P the and line drawn principal the focal axis . point through The F is distance known lens. F , actually an image pass will through be seen. the The point F . image If a screen produced in is placed this case is produced in a a and a magnifying real diverging or concave lens is thinner at the centre than at the edges. simple a parallel beam of light strikes the surface of a diverging rays spread out as leave lens, glass. refraction rays occurs appear point conver image how When camera the thicker strikes lens formula A images of the focal rays the called ray is light a dioptres the F centre between at ᔢ and lens of lenses as ᔢ beam occurs point optical ᔢ convex converging focal and or parallel F , an to and have image the diverged will not from be the seen, point because they F . If the a the screen rays do lens. is not The placed at actually the pass ng through the point F . The image in this case is called a virtual image . The (convex) distance between the optical centre the diverging of the lens and the point F is called len principal axis the focal The point power of of a lens is defined lens. Equation by parallel F P the beam equation here. 1 of light P The unit dioptre. for Its power symbol of is a lens is = the f D. f Figure 13.1.1 A converging (convex) lens A more shorter diverging principal powerful focal lens length will have (Figure a P – power f – focal of a lens/dioptres length of lens/m 13.1.3). axis Converging lenses have positive values. (concave) Diverging lenses have negative values. len For example: parallel ᔢ A converging lens of focal length 0.4 m will have a power of F beam 1 P of li ht + = +2.5 D. 0.4 ᔢ A f diverging lens of focal length – 0.3 m will have a power of 1 – = – 3.33 D. 0.3 Figure 13.1.2 A diverging (concave) lens F F f Figure 13.1.3 102 f less converging less powerful lens Relating power and focal length of a lens more converging more powerful lens Chapter The 13 The physics object between T o sight lens formula u An of is placed the in object determine the front and (to the optical position of left) centre the of of image a converging the lens several is lens. the rays The object are v distance distance u. constructed. image object Rules ᔢ A for constructing ray of light point of the ray parallel diagrams: to the principal axis passes through the focal f lens. Figure 13.1.4 ᔢ A ray Using of these the lens. the image The light rules, Note lens passing and an that the through image the optical formula can image is centre (shown right) the be optical centre constructed inverted of the can and lens be is is used of on the the real. the for lens is undeviated. right-hand The image side distance distance converging and of between v diverging Equation lenses. A sign convention is used (real is positive). 1 Quantity Positive sign (+) (Real) Negative sign (–) (Virtual) 1 = f 1 Object distance, 2 Image 3 Focal distance, length, u Object v f is in front of lens Object is Image is at the back of lens Image Converging Diverging (convex) ᔢ The focal length of a converging ᔢ The focal length of a diverging lens lens lens is is is at the back of in front of v lens lens (concave) 1 + u f – focal u – object length v – image of the lens/m distance/m distance/m lens positive. camera negative. object ᔢ Real object ᔢ Virtual and real image distances are positive. lens object and virtual image distances are film negative. Example An object 20 cm. is placed Calculate 12 cm the in front position of of the a converging image and lens state of its focal length nature. Figure 13.1.5 u =+12 cm (real object) 1 f 1 = = +20 cm (converging lens) 1 + f u 1 v 1 1 = + 20 12 1 v 1 1 = 1 – v = 20 – 12 30 image v Since the image = object – 30 cm distance is negative, it is virtual and is in front of the Figure 13.1.6 converging A A lens simple simple move (same side of the lens as the and is Key points shown forth from in Figure the 13.1.5. photograph The film. lens This of the camera allows for can ᔢ A converging objects at different distances to be focused on the film. The parallel is real, diminished and A called diverging of magnifying an upright object and magnifying is placed enlarged glass a a beam single the focal point. parallel lens rays spreads so that a beam they glass appear When through inverted. ᔢ A rays image point produced lens focuses light of from A magnifying glass object). camera camera back A simple camera between image is the focal produced. point This is and the the lens, principle a by virtual, which a a to single have point diverged from called the focal point. works. 103 13.2 The eye Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this The section, you Figure eye to: human 13.2.1 must vitreous ᔢ explain how the at explain different and the humour) terms depth of field the various defects of and human before eye. media reaching The rays (cornea, the retina. of light aqueous Each entering humour , medium has the lens, methods Light first strikes the air-cornea boundary. a different Most of used to occurs = at indices 1.38). the this The pupil boundary (refractive light then towards the because index of travels lens. of the air = 1.0, through The large main difference the refractive the aqueous function of between index of humour , the lens is then to the fine eye index. refractive cornea depth of focus describe the several distances through ᔢ through eye forms bending ᔢ illustrates pass refractive images eye tune the focusing of light so that an image is formed on the retina. correct The retina consists of nerve endings that generate electrical impulses that them. are sent The of to lens the is muscles lens is brain via suspended called long and the the by optic ligaments ciliary thin. nerve. which muscles. When the are When muscles attached the to muscles contract, the a circular are lens ring relaxed, becomes the short retina and fat (more powerful or shorter focal length). cornea Accommodation lens so as to The closest is focus the ability images of the formed eye from to change objects at the focal different length of the distances. lens pupil image vitreous aqueous The on far point the to retina point of the is the eye at 25 cm normal which for a eye the eye normal is taken can eye to still and be at is produce called a the focused near point. infinity. humour humour Depth of field optic O O O Figure 13.2.1 and depth of focus nerve 2 1 The human eye I I I 1 depth 2 of field depth Figure 13.2.2 Consider of field Depth of field and depth of focus an of of focus object the eye O is being the viewed distance at some moved by distance the from object eye. The (between O depth and 1 O ), while the image remains in focus (Figure 13.2.2). 2 For a given slightly parallel accommodation, nearer (O ) and the slightly eye is able further (O 2 light variation rays the in depth The depth see from clearly some an object fixed point. This 1 distance of to ) through which the eye can still see clearly is called focus. of field and the depth of focus are affected by the size of the iris. image Figure 13.2.3 Short-sightedness Short-sightedness parallel The light are rays occurs (less diverging lens image person blurred. is when sightedness 104 the powerful). diverging lens sightedness, Figure 13.2.4 able The to (myopia) only image lens focus forms is not in able objects front to Short-sightedness is the used far to correct point is close of relax also the in to the retina. order occurs if short-sightedness. closer than infinity closer than 25 cm (Figures 13.2.3 and 13.2.4). Distant become eyeball In and Correction for short- be to the eye. objects Short-sightedness the the long is too case near of and thin long. A short- point may Chapter Long-sightedness 13 The physics of sight (hypermetropia) near The person close to is the eye sightedness is not also able long sight. near point to are the In case greater is of objects The the short eyeball the focus because become if is only blurred. occurs to occurs able image ciliary and too fat that forms A 25 cm (Figures from powerful). the far 13.2.5 the the become converging long-sightedness, than far behind muscles (more short. are eye. retina. weak Objects Long- and the 250 mm is used to point is infinity image lens Long-sightedness lens and point Figure 13.2.5 Long-sightedness correct and the 13.2.6). near point Astigmatism image The person has difficulty focusing light rays from objects in different Figure 13.2.6 planes at the same time. The problem is caused because the surface Correction for long- of sightedness the cornea adjusted is uneven. such cornea-lens that Astigmatism its system axis is is is corrected perpendicular cylindrical (Figure to using the a axis cylindrical in which lens, the eye 13.2.7). Cataracts Persons light with enters removed. cataract the eye. Surgeons converging lenses have In can are lenses order to implant used to which correct a new correct have this lens the become defect, inside opaque. the the lens eyes of or V ery the little eye glasses is with defect. Figure 13.2.7 Example Correction lens for astigmatism A person retina has a distance near is point 1.7 cm. of 30 cm and Calculate a the far point power of 90 cm. a the eye b the corrective lens needed to view an object at a c the corrective lens needed to view an object at infinity. This The when person person is is p also 1 = = f b Long p object + correction 1 f Power u of + 1 + 1 lens near the point point far of 30 cm. distance is point of greater is less 25 cm. than than 25 cm. infinity. = 62.2 D = 62.8 D 1 + 0.25 corrective near 0.017 = v the because 0.30 sight the cornea– 1 = v at because 1 1 = viewed long-sighted 1 u = is short-sighted 1 a an The of: Key points 0.017 = 62.8 – 62.2 = +0.6 D (Converging lens) ᔢ Alternatively, since the image at 30 cm is on the same side of the Accommodation of as the object, it is virtual. Therefore, the image distance is the eye to focus p = 1 = f 1 + u 1 Short sight = v – 0.25 = 0.30 Depth of field by an is the distance object, =58.8 D while the image remains in focus. 0.017 1 = 1 = f Power different 1 = f p at correction 1 = objects distances. 0.67 D moved p ability 1 ᔢ c the images negative. formed from 1 is lens 1 + u of 1 1 = v corrective ᔢ + 0.90 lens = = 58.8 – 59.9 Common defects of the eye 59.9 D 0.017 include = short-sightedness, sightedness, –1.1 D astigmatism long- and cataracts. Alternatively , the image distance is negative, because the image is virtual. ᔢ 1 p = 1 = 1 + 1 = There = u v ∞ various techniques –1.1 D used f are 1 – to correct these defects. 0.90 105 Revision Answers found to on questions the that require questions calculation can be 6 6 accompanying CD. A lens 20 cm a 1 a Explain what is meant by loudness and b c what state Describe is meant by the threshold of how the [3] sensitivity across the of the range of ear Explain of the the focal length of is lens to is meant sound by the waves of it +2.5 D. An lens. of the object is placed Determine: lens and state what type [2] average position A diverging is optical ‘frequency an the object to nature [2] what response’ 7 audible frequencies. a in front of and nature of the image has a focal length produced. [3] hearing its value. loudness varies 2 power [4] Explain and a intensity level. b has 8 person. State lens placed centre of the three simple at of a distance the image of of 20 cm. An 30 cm from lens. Calculate the the position and produced. properties of the [3] image produced by a camera. [3] [3] 9 b Describe and explain how this frequency Draw glass varies with age. A person listening has to produces an eardrum music 0. 14 μW ray diagram to explain how a magnifying works. [3] [3] 10 2 3 a response using of of area 53 mm headphones, sound power to Explain what is meant by: . When the the a accommodation b depth of the eye [2] headphone eardrum. of focus. [2] Calculate: 11 a the intensity of the sound incident on The range 3.8 m. eardrum In the intensity level at the eardrum. a Describe how the ear responds to an wave. Sketch a The to show the variation of power of the intensity of sound is the threshold old boy. Indicate, of no r ma l using range Indicate, at the ear h earing in a State two of values on the x-axis, State the a the aid of a the following i focal ii principal iii focal State two pairs of spectacles. Calculate lens in each pair of spectacle. [3] the lens required to correct an eye type of lens calculate being used the focal to correct length in the cm. [2] b State the c Calculate eye defect being corrected. [1] a value on in the y-axis, the 13 [1] which the 70-year-old diagram, graph may man. near point and far point of the [3] explain a Explain what b Draw diagram be a is meant to by show short-sightedness. how this eye defect [2] is corrected. [3] [2] what is a Explain b State what is meant by astigmatism. [2] meant the type of lens used to correct this eye terms: axis point. the the eye. [2] length [3] lens formula expression for 106 the and defect. b to for 14 by 1. 1 m the hearing. ways different for With is optometrist 15-yea r- of frequencies. using threshold a an [3] audible 5 with of unaided iii gentleman his vision, +1.5 D. defect ii elderly with a i an [4] graph frequency him power defect b of correct incoming 12 sound to [3] the 4 order [2] provides b of vision the the and power write of a down lens. an [3] [1] Revision questions 15 a Explain what is meant by the following b terms: An are i accommodation elderly person situated ii depth of field [2] iii depth of focus. [2] him A student clearly complains unless they see clearly 1.2 m and objects 9 m from which the [2] eyes. Calculate b can between 6 that are she more cannot than see objects 60 cm from her to see the objects i located ii very at the power which near distant from of lens required for are: point the the of the eye [3] eye. [3] eyes. 17 i State the student’s eye defect. a Explain sound ii State the iii Calculate near point of a normal power of the person. lens the her defect. used Draw ray diagram a A conversation [3] to show how a point object placed two at point enters the rays Draw another the to taking place between × 10 intensity of the W m Explain lens fixes her is meant by the threshold a Explain the eye what and is meant state how by show how and Calculate state the is value. intensity level [2] of the the problem. the following they of [3] are [3] [3] c 16 is . what conversation. correcting two sound normal eye. diagram incoming of ii v an –2 hearing near is average –6 i light from to to 6.2 iv responds [4] students. The correct ear wave. [1] b the how [1] defects of Explain why response to the ear is intensity. said to have a logarithmic [3] corrected. i astigmatism [3] ii cataract. [2] 107 Module Answers to the selected structured 2 Practice multiple-choice questions questions can and be found exam to on questions 7 the Light of wavelength 640 nm falls on a pair of slits, forming fringes 2.80 mm apart on the screen. What is accompanying CD. the new fringe spacing if the wavelength were 400 nm? a 2.28 mm b 1.75 mm c 4.48 mm d 2.80 mm Multiple-choice questions 1 A mass m is attached to a vertical helical spring having 8 a spring constant k. The mass is displaced slightly A ray of light happens undergoes simple harmonic motion with amplitude maximum velocity v of the mass is given m a v = b v = = √ A particle d The by P = the frequency, speed and wavelength Frequency speed wavelength a increases increases decreases b decreases increases increases c unchanged increases increases d unchanged increases decreases m v = a is undergoing x in simple mm of the 0.58cos(0. 12π)t. What is harmonic particle motion. is given the frequency 9 of What one is is the ratio 6.0 dB of louder the intensity than the of two sounds if other? oscillation? 6 a a 0.06 Hz b 0.58 Hz c 0. 12 Hz d A sound wave of amplitude 0.25 mm has 0.40 b 4.0 c 60 d 10 0.22 Hz 10 3 of by: m displacement x to light? k a k 2 air. What a m v into k a k c water a. the The travels from and A person has a far point which is 9.5 cm from his and eyes. What is the power of the corrective lens needed –2 intensity sound of 3.5 W m wave amplitude of of the . What is the intensity same frequency which 0.43 W m c 7 .0 W m has a stationary to view a –1. 1 D an object at infinity? an 14 W m d 1.75 W m b +1. 1 D c –2.9 D d +2.9 D Structured questions –2 11 A him –2 b –2 4 for 0.50 mm? –2 a of wave is produced when two a Explain what is meant by simple harmonic similar motion. progressive waves of frequency 400 Hz b in opposite directions [2] travelling superimpose. The Show that two adjacent nodes is period of oscillation T of a mass m distance attached between the 1.2 m. The speed to a spring, having a spring constant k is of m the progressive waves is: given –1 a 480 m s c 960 m s by T = 2π b 900 m s d 167 m s c –1 . √ –1 A small particle P [6] k undergoes simple harmonic –1 motion. The displacement x of P in metres is given –3 5 A diffraction grating Monochromatic right the is angles second to has light the order of N lines per wavelength grating. The maxima is by metre. λ is angular θ. Which incident deviation of at of the following x = 1.4 × (5π) t., where What ii Determine the iii Sketch the velocity–time the acceleration of iv the sin i true? is 10 angular frequency period of t is of in seconds. P ? [2] oscillation. graph for [2] the motion P. [3] Sketch time graph for the λ a sin θ = 2Nλ b sin θ = 2 motion of P. [3] N v λ c sin θ = Ultraviolet d ultraviolet rays sin θ = have a differ from microwaves, in that cannot c have a 108 have a 1 the displacement 2 the velocity 3 the acceleration State be of P [2] of P [2] of P. [2] a the conditions stationary necessary for the formation wave. [2] polarised higher Explain what is meant by a node and an antinode wavelength on d determine: lower frequency b a 1.0 s rays: of b = 2Nλ 12 a t 1 N 2 6 When higher frequency. a stationary wave. [2] Module c A stationary wave string. There between is formed are four the four nodes nodes is on a stretched present. The 1.40 m. The b distance speed In the experiment 2 Practice you exam described, questions state a typical value for: of i the width ii the distance of the between slits. the slits [1] iii the distance between the slits –1 the i waves State on the the string is wavelength 220 m s of the . waves on the string. ii A Calculate laser the the frequency produces light the first is light incident order the of vibration. [2] Explain the of wavelength role normally maximum is on a diffraction produced at grating, 17 a 14°. State between the lines on the number of positions of the grating b [3] maximum the a parallel normally the on grating directions. and b has on the this order a is third of maxima Explain wavelength of beam red diffraction consisting normally 51°, a interference Light observable fringes. [4] conditions necessary patterns in to obtain the Young’s double an [3] expression the to show wavelength λ of the relationship the light source, the separation a, the distance between the slits [3] and When and experiment. Derive slit a diffraction light intensity. 14 by producing observable fringe slit spacing in played 640 nm. When between b screen. [1] c Calculate: a the [2] interference 13 [1] and the in of of incident light in by these is coincides produced produced with by the light of [4] by of d light and the spacing between the [6] Young’s fringes separation of screen the light were formed and is light and 0.50 mm. The slits is using two slits with distance 1.2 m. The 12 mm. Calculate a between distance the the between wavelength used. of [2] Describe the effect, if any, on the separation and maximum brightness of the fringes when the second the D x. ten fringes shorter angle screen monochromatic incident diffraction maximum c particular diffraction grating. The a fringes leaving maxima. wavelengths 470 nm. At maximum played producing diffraction wavelength is the intensity role two order light grating, the following changes are made in the experiment in c. other i The distance between the slit and the screen wavelength. Calculate is i the spacing between the lines on the grating [2] ii the number of lines per metre on the grating [1] iii the other iv the highest wavelength observed order with present maximum 470 nm in the that light can the ii [2] The spectrum of be [2] waves is a number of The State electromagnetic of waves common to c State waves. the following light, X-rays, a typical red ii X-rays in increasing magnitude of microwaves, infrared light 18 a Explain b Describe diagrams wavelength for light microwaves. wavelength a an wavelength red and of monochromatic calculate double experiment of a light. State explain and the and the screen of the light incident on the is the increased, slits and keeping the the screen distance and the light constant. [3] an meant by experiment of to is water the to waves illustrate term diffraction. demonstrate in both a ripple narrow the tank. gap [2] Draw and wide [6] Explain how diffraction is affected by the width gap. of the lamp what how [2] [1] using Young’s Describe slits diffraction. light can Explain to slit measure red of the sound waves diffraction of is more light. [3] the are measurements of than monochromatic measurements wavelength diffraction observed experiment. producing these why be easily measured is [1] d The the source separation [1] the 16 light slit [2] slit what diffraction [4] c iii between the the [3] gap i of [2] all wavelength: visible and regions. three features Arrange separation divided source b slit constant. keeping intensity between a source the constant. double into keeping wavelength distance wavelength. electromagnetic The light increased, iii 15 increased, light. taken are used to [5] 109 14 Temperature 14. 1 Temperature Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this understand section, you T emperature two to: the temperature scales Temperature bodies other , ᔢ and concept is A the and thermal measure B, of energy of the different flows degree of hotness temperatures, between them. If are the in of a body. contact When with temperature of each body A is of higher than the temperature of body B, thermal energy flows from A to B temperature (Figure ᔢ define a thermometric property are at 14.1.1). the ther mal ᔢ state examples of same Thermal energy temperature. equilibrium with At each will continue this stage, other . to both There is flow until bodies zero are net both said flow of bodies to be in thermal thermometric energy between the bodies. However , thermal energy is continuously properties moving ᔢ explain is ᔢ how a temperature back and forth between the what flow is meant thermodynamic two bodies. scale defined explain the of thermal energy by scale of A B temperature. T T 1 2 T >T 1 Figure 14.1.1 Thermal energy flows as a result of a temperature difference Defining In order to property property a temperature define and is volume The length temperature. mercury capillary ᔢ mercury it the a scale, to be in a capillary the volume therefore of of A varies of a ther mometric thermometric continuously thermometric with properties. tube capillary temperature its concepts that examples the up the understood. material are in moves decreases, tube of mercury As and need following of of scale temperature points property The The increases a fixed some temperature. ᔢ 1 tube the capillary will vary mercury tube. decreases. If The with increases, the its volume temperature length of mercury of the in the decreases. The electrical resistance of a coil of The electrical resistance of a metal wire increases with increasing temperature. ᔢ The pressure of gas contained in a fixed container (volume kept constant) If some varies air increases. ᔢ The is with As e.m.f. placed inside temperature. the a As container , the temperature generated when the pressure temperature decreases, two the dissimilar inside increases, pressure pieces of the the container pressure decreases. metals are connected When two generated, which 110 the metals which two such is as copper dependent metals are on and the connected. iron are connected, temperature of the an e.m.f. junction is at Chapter A thermometric property 14 Temperature should: Definition ᔢ vary smoothly ᔢ be ᔢ respond over the range of temperatures changes in temperature being measured A sensitive to small thermometric property rapidly to changing of a Once a thermometric A fixed reproduced. points ᔢ as The ice For property is a example, is selected, standard the that a degree Celsius fixed of scale points hotness is defined need that by to can varies temperature. be easily using with two be fixed follows. lower at point material is temperatures. continuously defined. property fixed standard point (ice point) atmospheric is the pressure. temperature This of pure temperature is melting defined as 0 °C. ᔢ The upper above pure fixed temperature The chosen point boiling is (steam water defined as thermometric conditions stated on as above. at point) the temperature atmospheric two X, is points measured (0, X ) under and (100, 0 a graph linear fixed shown relationship points. intervals. The In relationship and Figure to 14.1.2. therefore range order is in is of steam pressure. This 100 °C. property The is standard a divided determine straight up an The into line unknown X two ) are plotted 100 Celsius one the is scale drawn hundred assumes between equally temperature θ, a the two spaced the following used. Equation X – X θ θ 0 = × X – 100 °C X 100 0 θ – unknown X – value – value of temperature thermometric θ property X of at temperature θ thermometric 100 property X – value of at 100 °C thermometric 0 property at 0 °C thermometric property X 100 X θ X 0 0 θ 100 temperature/°C Figure 14.1.2 Defining a temperature scale 111 Chapter 14 Temperature Thermometers thermometer uses thermometers ice at are standard reading. are This used a would they fixed may all thermometric are give used to measure different relationship temperature may not order to avoid called the of ther modynamic temperatures are thermodynamic ᔢ Absolute zero ᔢ The triple which The scale water the the or the melting the well. reason same same However , for way thermometric of a this if glass is that between property the and thermometers. defined particular the different pure give as of temperature The vary the was any kelvin which of is the that (K). The is totally substance. absolute lowest energy water and thermodynamic of in internal point ice, all point If of would type scale. fixed This scale this scale, On points used in is the are: (0 K), the for scale measured scale temperature, a properties not between linear confusion, the steam readings. may property. them the The independent of at points. In all Each temperature true properties be the point), be temperatures. thermometric measure (ice also of the to pressure thermometers water , measure particular used different all to of (273.16 K). water vapour temperature T This are is temperature substances in is is the at At this minimum. temperature thermal given possible. a at equilibrium. by: Equation P T T = × 273. 16 K p tr T – thermodynamic temperature/K P – pressure of an ideal gas at a T temperature p – pressure of T/Pa the same volume of tr an of ideal Although pressure The SI gas at the triple point water/Pa the scale variation unit of is of theoretical, an ideal temperature is gas the it at is identical constant kelvin (K). to the scale based on the volume. An interval of 1 kelvin is 1 defined as measured Another being on the ⁄273.16 the temperature thermodynamic commonly following of used unit, scale the of of degree the triple point of water temperature. Celsius ( °C) is defined by equation. Equation θ θ = – T – 273. 15 temperature in degrees in kelvin/K Celsius/ °C T It – temperature follows that temperature 112 a temperature change of 1 °C. change of as 1 K is exactly equal to a the Chapter 14 Temperature Example A resistance resistance thermometer is found thermometer resistance used i to is is to placed found measure Calculate be to the the is placed 3825 Ω. in be a liquid 976 Ω. unknown value of the in At of A pure water 100 °C, its unknown at unknown and is temperature constant-volume temperature 0 °C resistance and it gas is and The the thermometer found temperature its 185 Ω. using to be the is 65 °C. resistance thermometer . ii State iii Suggest your a answer reason resistance R and – θ for kelvin. the difference constant-volume between gas the readings on the thermometer . R θ i in 0 = × R – 100 °C R 100 0 976 – 3825 185 – 3825 = × 100 – 2849 = × 100 – 3640 θ ii = In θ T 78.3 °C order = T – θ = 78.3 The convert + degrees Celsius to kelvin we use: 273.15 + 273.15 351.45 K difference properties in reading respond temperature the property assumption is due differently between thermometric This from 273.15 = = iii to may and fixed varies not be to the fact that uniquely points. linearly true for The to different the changes assumption between different thermometric the two is in that fixed the points. thermometric properties. Key points ᔢ Temperature is ᔢ A thermometric property ᔢ A thermometric property Thermometric change gas ᔢ A and in are ᔢ There are the The triple a is scale can the one can hotness that be used include wire, be defining fixed – the to the two defined by points on the temperature. volume pressure of a liquid, a fixed metals a of are suitable the volume of connected. thermometric scale (ice thermodynamic point scale and steam (absolute point). zero and water). scale is called thermometric one in in choosing two fixed of temperature. points. the Celsius any with dissimilar on of body. measure change when a change points point of varies two fixed on change of of generated thermodynamic depend A e.m.f. and There ᔢ properties temperature ᔢ measure resistance the property ᔢ a an absolute property degree Celsius is and exactly is scale because it does not theoretical. equal to a change of one kelvin. 113 14.2 Thermometers Learning outcomes On completion should ᔢ be able describe of a a of this Types of thermometers section, you Liquid-in-glass thermometer to: the principal features liquid-in-glass, thermistor, a a resistance, thermocouple narrow and a constant-volume bore gas thermometer ᔢ state the advantages disadvantages of and various types of thermometers ᔢ select an appropriate thermometer mercury to measure temperature. large bulb (thin-walled Figure 14.2.1 In a liquid mercury. it to rise A liquid-in-glass thermometer glass-in When up transparent it Mercury while is it is a up freezes measure very respond or at low large quickly and is will be a 234 K, which rapidly affect lower easy that than it is good means the the it that it This Mercury stick of is the to using it is used glass. the glass mercury be used to thermometers that It they also order to have cannot means measured. In These because heat. means value. with causes through cannot being used not advantage temperatures. actual is seen does of filled 14.2.1). mercury. easily that is mercury Glass Mercury-in-glass capacities. bulb the (Figure conductor temperature than glass of use. Another changing the to means bore. very heat walled volume more This the in thermometer temperatures. to will therefore down thin and means glass. thermal thermometer the expand This a change of not wet metal Mercury relatively bore does not the inexpensive opaque. does moving that fine are and is thermometer , heated, the thermometers because glass) The make that the reading this circuit for thermometer sensitive, the bore is made very thin. The drawback to this measuring is that it limits the range of the thermometer of a given length. resisitance Resistance thermometers In a platinum-resistance insulating material like thermometer , mica (Figure a platinum 14.2.2). It wire relies is on coiled the fact on an that oil the is platinum coil resistance used means that melting range. 114 is a a high large makes 2046 K. Wheatstone wire change the in with is means used temperature. coefficient resistance thermometer This bridge varies temperature that to for very the of a small sensitive. the change This change in Platinum thermometer measure Platinum resistance. has in a has very a large resistance A platinum-resistance of thermometer of platinum has This point A the it there temperature. Figure 14.2.2 of because the platinum. Since a Wheatstone bridge is used, very slight changes in Chapter resistance type of can be measured thermometer means that it is is slow very that to it accurately. has respond a to The relatively rapidly biggest large drawback heat changing capacity. of 14 Temperature this This temperatures. Thermistors A ther mistor The device temperature. which respond of A type accurate small. that its have of the to the that being is less periodic also measured. stable than over a temperature. that they means The a calibration. temperatures with coefficient, means It resistor . varies increasing This temperatures. it sensitive thermistor with capacities. needs measure thermally temperature decreases heat is and a of negative changing thermometer used a temperatures thermometer when with resistance has small rapidly on device The resistance very to effect resistance non-linear thermistor quickly little this a very means Thermistors have is is can that they disadvantage platinum- This long makes period of it less time. Thermocouples A ther mocouple effect. an When e.m.f. value the of is makes two produced the e.m.f. temperature use different and of the metals an electric generated difference ther moelectric are is joined current dependent between the effect together flows on the in as the metals junctions J the e.m.f. with temperature of J is almost the being and Seebeck Figure circuit. J 1 of or in . 14.2.3, The used The and variation 2 always parabolic, when 2 kept J is at 0 °C. placed In in order to melting measure ice, which J is 1 an unknown provides the temperature, reference one junction temperature, 1 while the other junction J is placed in contact with the object of 2 unknown therefore respond Figure temperature. have quickly 14.2.4 the and that for being is a very the the changing variation neutral small The in e.m.f. is in region. two This e.m.f. less temperature are very small means junctions. that they They can temperatures. of change this there have capacities. thermocouple e.m.f.). given heat rapidly The above maximum change to small shows thermocouple. below very Thermocouples with in the (temperature e.m.f. Also, temperature sensitive it as a can possible result be that of seen values for for region a produces temperature from the a just the graph, temperature measured. G e.m.f. / mV thermocouple is not in sensitive this region J 1 parabolic curve J 2 θ θ ice water neutral Figure 14.2.4 Figure 14.2.3 A thermocouple temperature Variation of e.m.f. with temperature for a thermocouple 115 Chapter 14 Thermometers Constant-volume In this type measured holds a of gas remains the mercury tube. the of a left the is always the is of at The of the then the gas tube = of fixed is expands + of to in the that contact fixed of gas bulb of adjusted up the so that measuring the that volume is glass volume When so gas The is with the adjusted the tube marker . pushes is mass 14.2.5). movable volume and fixed ensure the tube a (Figure to brought returns p pressure order movable measured p In height bulb the the manometer gas. the glass height hand gas of constant, measured. The mercury volume temperature, being thermometer , using fixed gas thermometers substance the movable the mark. mercury The on pressure using ρhg θ where p is the pressure of the gas at a temperature θ, p is atmospheric θ –1 pressure, the g is density the of Earth’s mercury gravitational and h is the field height strength of the (9.81 N kg mercury in ), the ρ is U-tube. h fixed volume mark gas Table 14.2.1 Figure 14.2.5 A constant-volume gas thermometer T able compares 14.2.1 the various Range/K thermometer Mercury-in-glass have been discussed. Resistance Thermometric Advantages Disadvantages property 234–710 thermometer Volume a fine 25–1750 thermometer of Electrical of a mercury column resistance platinum coil in ᔢ Easy ᔢ Limited ᔢ Portable to use ᔢ Fragile ᔢ Accurate ᔢ Slow ᔢ Wide ᔢ Can range Thermocouple 80–1400 e.m.f. across junction of dissimilar Constant-volume thermometer 3–1750 Pressure mass of two metals of a fixed gas constant the at volume range response suitable for measure temperature 116 that Comparison of different types of thermometers Type of gas thermometers small differences range changing ᔢ Not a ᔢ Not as temperatures) direct ᔢ Wide ᔢ Small resistance ᔢ Fast volume ᔢ Can take and send response ᔢ Wide ᔢ Accurate remote to range a reading accurate or Bulky Slow ᔢ Fragile a constant- readings ᔢ as thermometer computer ᔢ (not rapidly response Chapter In order to measure thermometer the would of use depend ᔢ the ease ᔢ the range ᔢ the response time ᔢ the accuracy of of of the temperature the of a substance, the choice 14 Temperature of on: thermometer thermometer of the the thermometer thermometer . Example Select a suitable choice of thermometer to measure the following temperatures. a The temperature b The boiling c A small d A rapidly a For a heat point change very small capacity the its A in small very will have of the resistance to lower of ethanol. (90 K). ethanol, be the since used. thermometer reason temperature The it a The most has of the suitable small for with this is ethanol a and thermometer junctions and very that small the will not would therefore has be a capacity. platinum-resistance Boiling of temperature. temperature. heat quantity temperature. quantity will small oxygen body thermocouple, very b true a of changing thermometer give of oxygen thermometer occurs thermometers at are a would constant very be suitable in temperature. accurate and can this case. Platinum- measure steady temperatures. c A mercury-in-glass temperature d The have best thermometer around heat would be suitable in this case. Body 37 °C. thermometer small changing is would capacities be and the thermocouple. therefore respond Thermocouples quickly to rapidly temperatures. Key points ᔢ There are advantages and disadvantages to using the following thermometers: – liquid-in-glass – resistance – thermistor – thermocouple – constant-volume gas thermometer. 117 15 Thermal properties 15. 1 Internal energy Learning outcomes On completion should ᔢ be define able the of this you to: term relate body a rise to an in are heated in Bunsen energy and temperature increase in of a internal from a is and terms more other . supplied increases. the made vibrate If each random define specific heat up of flame. about many The their particles. particles mean to Their the The energy is positions. supplied, potential iron, the inter nal distribution Internal of the the energy kinetic energy and of the kinetic energy In a in motion. The the gas there U is motion Definition the sum of the of the kinetic of the particles of a random and system a piece iron Their of gain iron being thermal particles kinetic increases. potential piece and of move energy So as energy iron potential further is of the energy apart thermal the particles sum of energy of the the particles. = E + E also sum causes forces of that are The internal molecules that the the that the random present. The molecules molecules exist potential P to between energy kinetic as and molecules possess move the further The potential constantly energy. apart molecules). well. are kinetic (against Therefore, internal energies energy of the the of the gas molecules present. energy energy of is a system supplied to is a determined system, the by the state particles of the within it system. begin is vibrating more rapidly. potential energy energy the The kinetic energy of the particles increases. The distribution potential that many means possess Whenever energy are This attractive molecules the the heat capacity specific heat capacity internal Consider inside K The capacity internal energy energy ᔢ matter energy Substances increases. ᔢ and Internal section, of make of the particles also increases. Consequently, the internal energies up of system increases. the In an ideal gas, the force of attraction between the molecules is system. negligible. energies There of are the two ᔢ supply ᔢ compress Suppose the of kinetic result of the the they energy Heat gas a of off amount on of the material When a up is greater the and gas of gas Some with the to the a make the a kinetic gas: gas molecules greater up the using speed. gas a The the the is the The increases. temperature piston, energy that be up average gas moving kinetic result strike The the can make increases. of piston, strike average heat increase are gas Energy that the of all the internal increase. substance, materials particles temperature The increases. specific the of container . The molecules speed. required of that metal When off and a compressed the temperature itself. rapidly. bounce energy the it). container . particles on it) inside the mass energy the vibrate dependent gas. gas they energy the internal (heating on only of cylinder capacity the up is heating to with energy make work internal make the gas (do by all a that quantity begin the that internal increase the increases. and depends the to gas inside bounce particles The that gas to container energy gas is the the is ways the container walls If to the molecules energy there supplied 118 Therefore, the capacity the temperature required easier to of a temperature heat up than substance rise others. and Chapter The amount of energy needed to raise the temperature of 1 kg of 15 Thermal properties of matter a Definition substance by 1 °C (or 1 K) is called the specific heat capacity ( c) of the substance. The The amount of energy E required to produce a temperature change of Δθ specific substance, heat c, is capacity the of amount a of heat H in a substance of mass m kg is given energy by required temperature E = c is the specific heat substance capacity of the –1 unit of specific heat capacity is c = = = mΔθ –1 The unit can also be expressed as J kg by one kilogram of a degree. J H SI one the substance. E The increase mcΔθ H where of to J kg –1 K Equation kg K –1 °C . This is so because a change E = mcΔθ H in 1 °C is exactly equal to a change in 1 K. E – amount m – mass/kg of c – specific energy absorbed H The larger that is the specific required to heat increase capacity its of the substance, temperature. The the specific more heat energy capacity –1 –1 of aluminium and copper are –1 880 J kg –1 K and 380 J kg heat 2 kg of aluminium and copper are heated to produce The amount E = change of of = 2 absorbed × 880 × by the 10 = aluminium is given of energy absorbed by the copper is given = mcΔθ = 2 × 380 × 10 = The °C simple calculation energy that is shows that required to heat capacity of a substance, 7 600 J C, more the or by H of temperature/K 17 600 J The E the °C in Definition amount This or J kg change by H The – 10 °C. energy mcΔθ –1 a Δθ temperature –1 K respectively. –1 Suppose capacity/J kg –1 K the higher raise the the specific temperature heat of capacity, one kilogram is the required of a amount to of heat increase substance by the one energy temperature degree. substance. same released 10 °C. equation when The a can be used substance amount of to cools. energy determine Suppose released is the 2 kg of amount of energy aluminium cools by Equation 17 600 J. E Another useful substance is quantity the energy is heat capacity required to raise (C) . the The heat capacity temperature of a of a = CΔθ H substance E – amount C – heat Δθ – change of energy absorbed H by one –1 degree. –1 The The unit of heat amount of capacity energy E is the –1 J K or required to capacity/JK in –1 or J °C temperature/K or °C J °C produce a temperature change of Δθ H in a substance is given by E = CΔθ H Equation Key points C = mc –1 ᔢ The the internal kinetic energy and of a system potential is energies the of sum the of the random particles that distribution make up the C – heat capacity/J K m – mass/kg c – specific of system. –1 ᔢ The the ᔢ The gas ᔢ The to internal energy molecules internal or doing specific raise the of an of a ideal gas is dependent The ᔢ The the SI unit energy work heat on gas the can gas capacity temperature heat of the kinetic energy heat capacity/J kg –1 K of only. of of be increased (compressing a substance 1 kg of a is by the the substance specific capacity temperature of of a heat a capacity substance substance is by is the J kg the supplying energy to the gas). amount by –1 ᔢ on 1 °C of or energy required 1 K. –1 K amount of energy required to raise 1 °C. 119 15.2 Electrical heat completion should be able of this describe section, you Specific by to: experiments capacities specific of heat using an with liquids the and of substances method electrical or by methods can a of be experimentally method of mixtures. determining the determined This specific section heat capacity solids. heat substances by Specific electrical capacities electrical to of determine specific Electrical methods for measuring specific heat capacities deals ᔢ measuring capacities Learning outcomes On methods for heat capacity of a liquid methods. The is apparatus shown in calorimeter initial used Figure (the to measure 15.2.1. vessel temperature of in A the which the specific known the liquid θ mass heat is heat of capacity liquid m is measurements measured using of liquid placed are the in a made). The thermometer . 1 An for electric a current length recorded. heating of time During of is the then t. the liquid. The made flow ammeter heating The to period final through and the the voltmeter stirrer temperature θ heating reading is used to is recorded. I element and provide V are uniform 2 voltmeter stirrer thermometer variable ammeter resistor insulation calorimeter heating element liquid Figure 15.2.1 An electrical method to determine the specific heat capacity of a liq uid Experimental Mass of Initial results liquid = m kg temperature of liquid = θ °C 1 Final temperature of liquid = θ °C 2 Ammeter reading V oltmeter Time reading heating Electrical Energy = I amps = V volts element energy was supplied absorbed by the switched to liquid liquid = on = = IVt mc(θ – θ 1 where If it is liquid 120 c is the assumed can be specific that found no by heat heat using capacity losses the of occur , t seconds the the following: ) 2 liquid. specific heat capacity of the Chapter Electrical energy supplied by heating IVt = element mc(θ – θ 1 = energy absorbed by of is 15 Thermal properties of matter liquid ) 2 IVt ∴ c = m(θ – θ 1 Specific The apparatus similar the A in heat to solid. the used one The second to is of in A the solid placed hole. in small the thermometer to the thermometer and a measure used mass thermometer the capacity of ensure the solid the specific previous m is one hole that heat and of there The capacity experiment. determined amount solid. ) 2 a oil is using heating is placed good initial T wo an a are electronic element inside thermal solid holes is the of in balance. placed hole contact temperature drilled the with between solid θ 1 is measured flow using through voltmeter the the thermometer . heating reading I and element V are An for a electric length recorded. The current of time final t. is then The made to ammeter temperature θ is and recorded 2 (Figure 15.2.2). voltmeter thermometer variable ammeter resistor insulation electric heater solid Figure 15.2.2 An electrical method to determine the specific heat capacity of a solid Experimental Mass of Initial results solid = m kg temperature of solid = θ °C 1 Final temperature of solid = θ °C 2 Ammeter reading V oltmeter Time reading heating Electrical Energy = I amps = V volts element energy absorbed was supplied by the switched to solid solid = on = = IVt mc(θ – θ 1 where If it is solid c is the assumed can Electrical be specific that found energy no by heat heat using supplied capacity losses the by t seconds of occur , ) 2 the the solid. specific heat capacity of the following: heating element IVt = = energy mc(θ absorbed – θ 1 by solid ) 2 IVt ∴ c = m(θ – 1 θ ) 2 121 Chapter 15 Thermal properties of matter A continuous flow capacity of In 1899 heat a The liquid tube of is specific heat liquid Callendar capacity method to determine the a and allowed containing Barnes liquid a by to a flow heating devised a method continuous from a element flow to constant-head as shown measure the specific method. in tank Figure through a glass 15.2.3. inflow outflow vacuum θ °C θ 1 + Figure 15.2.3 The glass heat a steady this tube is At glass experiment accurate insulated escape state. the heater Continuous flow method cannot leaving °C 2 and is from this a of a glass liquid. the remains jacket, The at temperature constant. measuring liquid which entering A steady glass is experiment platinum-resistance good T emperature stage, tube is by the of the suitable evacuated, is allowed liquid It is that reach entering thermometer thermometer . so to and for extremely temperatures. tube = θ °C 1 T emperature of liquid leaving glass tube = θ °C 2 Mass of water collected as it leaves the tube = m kg 1 Time taken Ammeter to collect reading liquid = I = t seconds amps 1 V oltmeter reading = V volts 1 Under steady element is state carried conditions, away I V 1 where h specific is the heat The rate that the at heat t which = m of to c(θ energy θ supplied by the heating liquid. ) + h (1) 2 surroundings in a time t and c is the liquid. liquid collected – 1 the the the flowing 1 lost the all the 1 capacity amount by is in a fl owing time t into is m the . glass The tube cur rent is altered and so voltage 2 are adjusted to bring the temperature θ back to its original value. The 2 temperature of of leaving the liquid the liquid the entering the glass constant-head tube tank. is This the temperature temperature θ is 1 constant. time t is Since again all the temperatures are the same, the heat h T emperature of liquid entering glass tube = θ °C 1 T emperature of liquid leaving glass tube = θ °C 2 Mass of water collected as it leaves the tube = m kg 2 Time 122 taken to collected liquid = t seconds lost in a Chapter Ammeter reading = I 15 Thermal properties of matter amps 2 V oltmeter reading = V volts 2 Under steady element is state carried ∴ I V 2 where h is the Subtracting (I V 2 conditions, away t = – V 1 the c(θ 2 heat I m 2 lost Equation 2 by )t to (1) = all – the – (I The inlet using ᔢ The in a m V – lost is main is not heating (2) – V 1 in a time t (2): θ 2 – m ) 1 )t 1 )(θ 1 the – θ 2 continuous outlet calculations. apparatus The the in )(θ I 2 ) 1 flow temperatures platinum-resistance heat the and the h Equation 2 ᔢ by = (m of + 1 2 advantages ) supplied liquid. surroundings from c(m energy 1 2 c The θ 2 1 the flowing method can be are: measured very accurately thermometer . experiment Therefore, is the not required heat since capacity of it is eliminated various parts of the required. disadvantage of this method is that a large volume of the liquid required. Key points ᔢ The specific electrical heat capacity of a liquid and a solid can be determined by an method. 123 15.3 Measuring by using Learning outcomes On completion should ᔢ be able describe specific and of this section, liquids to capacities by method you The a experiments using a heat of Measuring the to: heat a specifi c measure of solids method of specific liquid of Suppose a small you are piece electronic metal heat is of specific specific required metal. balance. then mixing capacity known capacities a solid heat to The The placed of a capacity of can be a determined solid by mixing it with capacity. determine mass metal into heat is of the the attached container specific metal of to is a heat piece boiling capacity measured of water . using thread. It is left c of an The there for mixtures. approximately the same using In a the mass temperature. to The ensure that temperature the of metal the and boiling the water water is are at measured thermometer . meantime, of the measured. The is used by water Mass some water stirrer the 10 minutes of hot to is is cold water measured. piece stir the of metal water is The placed initial is quickly gently. inside a polystyrene temperature The added highest to of the the cold cup. water water . temperature The is A achieved recorded. piece of metal = m kg 1 Initial temperature of the metal = θ °C 1 Mass of cold water = m kg 2 Initial temperature of cold water = θ °C 2 Final temperature of cold water = θ °C 3 –1 Specific heat capacity of water = c J kg –1 K w Heat lost by m piece × c of × metal (θ 1 – θ 1 ) = heat = m 3 gained × c 2 × c 2 The with specific a heat liquid similar to or that capacity solid used of of a – θ 3 × (θ w × ) 2 – θ 3 (θ 1 specific water ) 2 = m Measuring the (θ w m c × by heat liquid known – 1 θ ) 3 capacity of can specific be heat a determined capacity. liquid by The mixing it calculation is above. Example Calculate the energy required to: a Increase the temperature of 0.75 kg b Increase the temperature of 1.2 kg of of aluminium copper from from 10 °C 25 °C to heat –1 380 J kg a E b E capacity of aluminium and copper are 880 J kg –1 K respectively] = mcΔθ = 0.75 = mcΔθ = 1.2 × 880 × (60 – 25) = 23 100 J H H 124 × 380 × (45 – 10) = 15 960 J 60 °C. 45 °C. –1 [Specific to –1 K and Chapter 15 Thermal properties of matter Example Calculate the energy released when 1.5 kg of water cools from 90 °C to 25 °C. –1 [Specific E heat = capacity mcΔθ = of 1.5 water × = 4200 4200 J kg × (90 – –1 K 25) ] = 409 500 J H Example A kettle from rated 30 °C to at 2 kW is used to raise the temperature of 1.5 kg of water 100 °C. Calculate: a the energy required to raise the temperature of the water from 30 °C to 100 °C b the time taken to raise the temperature of the water from 30 °C to 100 °C. –1 [Specific heat capacity of water =4200 J kg –1 K ] 5 a Energy required E = mcΔθ = 1.5 × 4200 × (100 – 30) = 4.41 × 10 J H b Energy = power ×time 5 E t = 4.41 × 10 = = 220.5 s 3 P 2 × 10 Key points ᔢ The specific with heat another capacity substance of a (solid liquid or or liquid) solid of can be known determined specific heat by mixing capacity. 125 15.4 Latent heat Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this Change of section, Matter you energy to: gas. ᔢ explain the concepts of ᔢ explain a of to solid, a three solid, there are states it – solids, changes many liquids into particles a and liquid held gases. and When eventually together by into strong a bonds. melting a solid the term specific latent to vibrate of the solid. is temperature–time graphs particles heated, melting and rapidly these about particles increases, particles increases. also their gain mean energy. The resulting begin Eventually, in an moving enough positions. particles increase further energy The in apart is kinetic begin energy temperature and their absorbed by of the potential the solid, to causing determine more The energy use one boiling heat ᔢ in supplied Inside When and exists is state the bonds between the particles to break. The motion of the boiling particles becomes more disordered. The particles move freely within the points structure. ᔢ explain the cooling accompanies has that At become this a point in the heating the solid has melted and liquid. evaporation. As more rapidly. energy The increase further energy to in is supplied and At and this their by the of of the the the liquid the and liquid temperature liquid, a The energies to cause particles in the particles liquid. potential the stage, randomly process, to energy temperature absorbed break. heating is kinetic apart rapidly are become particles increases, particles increase. the a also At even begin between further state. gas vibrate resulting Eventually bonds much disordered has apart, this (Figures more an moving enough the particles moving point 15.4.1 in in the and 15.4.2). temperature gas boiling process, gas point boiling point liquid melting point liquid liquid melting solid solid and liquid and point gas solid mixture mixture time Figure 15.4.1 A heating curve (solid to liq uid to gas) At a Figure 15.4.2 change between the increases not the energy is change in Boiling is without a all the the that potential the in Melting state, particles kinetic A cooling curve energy make energy temperature of change of the increase Since 126 time of energy of particles, it a supplied up the the of particles. the used The particles substance follows is substance. is that to a the energy during dependent at break All change a bonds supplied supplied change on of the energy the of does state. kinetic state, there is no temperature. the process whereby a solid changes into a liquid without temperature. the process change in whereby a liquid temperature. changes into a gas (vapour) a Chapter Latent The Thermal properties of matter heat energy latent 15 required to change the state of a substance is known as the heat When a solid changes into a liquid, latent heat is required. The specific Definition latent a heat of substance fusion from a is the solid energy into required liquid to without a convert change unit in mass (1 kg) of temperature. The specific latent heat of fusion l f –1 The SI latent unit heat of of specific fusion latent is heat of calculated fusion using is the the J kg following . The specific is equation. the of energy required substance from without a change a in to convert solid to a 1 kg liquid temperature. Equation E = ml H E f – energy/J m – mass/kg l – specific H latent heat of f –1 fusion/J kg Example 5 The specific amount of latent energy heat of required fusion to of ice convert is 3.3 80 g of × 10 ice at 5 E = ml H = 0.08 × 3.3 × 10 –1 Jkg 0 °C . Calculate into water the at 0 °C. 4 = 2.64 × 10 J f Definition The specific unit mass latent (1 kg) of heat a of vaporisation substance from a is the liquid energy into a required vapour to convert without a The change in specific latent heat of temperature. vaporisation l , is the energy v –1 The SI latent unit heat of of specific latent vaporisation is heat of vaporisation calculated using is the the J kg following . The specific equation. required from a change to convert liquid in to a 1 kg of vapour substance without a temperature. Equation E = ml H E v – energy/J H m – mass/kg l – specific latent heat of v –1 vaporisation/J kg Example 6 The specific Calculate 100 °C to latent the heat amount steam at of of vaporisation energy of required water to is convert = ml H = × 10 250 g of –1 J kg . water at 100 °C. 6 E 2.3 0.25 × 2.3 × 10 amount of energy 5 = 5.75 × 10 J v Example Calculate to steam the at required to convert 1.2 kg of ice at –10 °C 100 °C. 3 Specific heat capacity Specific latent Specific heat Specific latent of ice = 2.1 × 10 –1 J kg –1 K 5 heat of fusion of ice = 3.3 × 10 3 capacity of water = 4.2 × 10 –1 J kg –1 J kg 6 heat of vaporisation of water = 2.3 × 10 –1 J kg 127 Chapter 15 Thermal properties of matter Energy required to raise the temperature of ice to 0 °C Exam tip 3 E = mcΔθ = 1.2 × 2.1 × 10 × (0 – – 10) = 25 200 J H If it is required to determine the Energy energy needed to change required to convert ice at 0 °C to water at 0 °C the 5 E temperature a change E = of of a substance state, use the without equation = ml H = 1.2 × 3.3 × 10 = 396 000 J f Energy required to raise the temperature of water from 0 °C to 100 °C mcΔθ H 3 E = mcΔθ = 1.2 × 4.2 × 10 × (100 – 0) = 504 000 J H If it is required to determine the Energy required to convert water at 100 °C to steam at 100 °C energy needed to change the state of a substance, use the equation E 6 = ml E H = ml H = 1.2 × 2.3 × 10 = 2 760 000 J v Energy required to convert 1.2 kg of ice at –10 °C to steam at 100 °C 6 = 25 200 + 396 000 + 504 000 + 2 760 000 = 3.69 × 5 The specific latent heat of fusion of ice is 3.3 × the heat of specific latent can heat be gases. vaporisation latent of fusion attributed In ice In In a solid. steam separate greater separation heat of when is only When is energy supplied, are seen in converted Boiling a gas – into A is in J kg reaching Factors its its that is affect area area air of move changing from from a solid slightly. that to Hence the so the far about to a of of the why to is by that liquid. the to the strong mean tightly that gas where and by their required reason heat quantities similar body that specific less is apart liquid the the together them liquid, latent specific seen liquids together energy a the be two solids, vibrate within are than tightly held can these of between molecules a liquid, remains The T able in it its eventually force of completely much mean the latent fusion. temperature start to constant energy 15.4.1 boil. (i.e. energy and its supplied compares rises. At this If boiling causes state energy the point). the evaporation changes more point, Bubbles liquid and from a to be boiling. liquid into temperature. of a room eventually water process point. the rate is 25 °C. If evaporates. changes liquid the by which the a Evaporation of state some The from with exposed to the surface surface). liquid water is boiling liquid to changes occurs evaporation increases exposed above above are The absorbs the (rate is to and It spilled point into a of gas on pure without point. boiling surface of yet the ᔢ blown vapour . boiling held free . larger between negligible. liquid. temperature temperature flow to will liquid room, to J kg boiling change ᔢ larger 128 a free greater boiling a are molecules the 10 much are separation are × –1 structures the increased the in particles when and is the changing is 2.3 difference particles are supplied the Evaporation ᔢ them liquid 100 °C, reaching and substance the floor water of the without Suppose the is the temperature the water), vaporisation Evaporation The The molecules than is differences molecules between the ice. water , forces (vaporised attraction of water vaporisation water) liquid The of the forces. intermolecular of to (solid intermolecular positions. heat of J –1 10 6 latent 10 at a gas without temperature. are: increasing the any into temperature) atmosphere (rate increases if a atmosphere) of the liquid (rate increases when air is Chapter Evaporation an athlete runs increases. sweat into the plays In skin body to as the for race. the body. This the important 100 m order covers vapour . a an to Thermal cooling the cool energy energy evaporates. is (latent The race, down, the the human body sweat required heat) is is to of matter temperature convert of properties Suppose produced. taken evaporation body. Thermal from the The the the sweat sweat surface causes of the cool. Table 15.4.1 Comparing evaporation and boiling Evaporation Change Occurs in During body thermal sweat role 15 of at Boiling state the occurs surface Change of the Occurs of state within occurs the body of the liquid liquid No bubbles are seen Bubbles are seen rising molecules having escape from Occurs at any Using the in a The of temperature kinetic container molecules kinetic in from the surface from the surface, decreases. kinetic can as be The energy a of of it as liquid Some the the it the have average the specific explain a range temperature why the Since of of have kinetic particles that a (boiling remaining sufficient surface of energy the liquid point) liquid evaporates liquid. evaporates at molecules temperature of concluded some model to cools energies. Occurs the the most energy substance that is make temperature (Figure speeds and sufficient energetic of the the the to a range break molecules remaining dependent up of therefore energy on the substance. remaining free average escape molecules of the kinetic energy remaining molecules decreases average Therefore, liquid liquid it decreases Figure 15.4.3 molecules Cooling effect associated with evaporation 15.4.3). Key points ᔢ Melting change ᔢ Boiling in ᔢ Latent At All ᔢ is the a or process process The is the liquid change the The heat of energy specific change ᔢ the by which a solid changes into a liquid liquid changes into a gas without a temperature. by which a without a change temperature. liquid ᔢ is in unit specific required to energy into gas state, mass is heat of latent without there supplied latent a is unit a no used of into to convert change change to of fusion solid heat convert required break of a a of a in substance from bonds substance without of liquid a a solid into temperature. temperature the liquid vaporisation mass in a is a in the a vapour the substance. substance. energy change substance into of the is in the required to temperature. energy without a change in temperature. ᔢ Evaporation reaching its is the process boiling whereby a liquid changes into a vapour without point. 129 15.5 Measuring Learning outcomes On completion should ᔢ be able describe an of this specific Measuring the section, you to: solid The experiment the specific specific mixtures. to latent of a describe an experiment the heat mass Some inside of water a of a fusion of ice calorimeter which is calorimeter . specific The a about can is be found measured 15 °C above by using room a method an of electronic The mass of the water temperature and the is calorimeter vaporisation of a specific heat capacities of the water and the is calorimeter to latent known. The liquid. initial temperature of the water is measured using a heat thermometer . of heat of fusion of solid are measure latent The measured. ᔢ latent heat placed of fusion specific heats (ice) balance. measure latent placed the gently ice mass used The Some into melts. of to the The water and T emperature of are blotted stirrer is calorimeter mass heat ice A temperature the the latent of water . lowest determine specific pieces the of water of the fusion = θ ice of of the is to they stir water is was are the is measured that ice until used dry and mixture then again. then until recorded. This will all The be added. determined as follows: °C 1 Mass of calorimeter = m kg 1 Mass of calorimeter and water = m kg 2 Mass of water = m = (m 3 Mass of water and – m 2 ) kg 1 calorimeter at end of experiment = m kg 4 Mass of ice used = m = (m 5 Final temperature of – m 4 water = ) kg 2 θ °C 2 –1 Specific heat capacity of water = 4200 J kg Specific heat capacity of calorimeter –1 K –1 Energy lost Energy lost by Energy + by ∴ × 4200 × (θ – θ 1 specific latent ) + to m 2 heat used × c melt × (θ 1 of –1 K Energy used to increase + calorimeter 3 The c J kg = water m = ice – θ 1 fusion can be temperature ) = m 2 l 5 calculated + m f × of melted 4200 × θ 5 from ice 2 the expression above. Measuring the a apparatus liquid until the is latent it is inner Mass to vessel of of boil over in to a measure Figure boiling. walls allowed collected used shown begins receiving the The is all then period liquid vapour jacket until and parts used of the 15.5.1. to time collected = Current = I amps 1 V oltage = V volts 1 Time = t seconds specific The the collect t is m latent liquid produced passes of is through apparatus the heat heated passes the of at vaporisation a through constant the condenser . become liquid. determined. kg 1 130 heat of vaporisation of liquid The a specific The mass of holes The steady. of rate in liquid The the liquid Chapter 15 Thermal properties of matter hole jacket heater liquid water out condenser water receiving Figure 15.5.1 Electrical energy supplied V 1 the is t = is = m 1 experiment heater vessel Measuring specific latent heat of vaporisation I The in l 1 energy + and to vaporise liquid + heat losses h (1) v repeated, changed required but the this new time mass the m potential of vapour difference which across condenses 2 in the same before. liquid, time This is which Mass of t is measured. because remains liquid heat The loss fixed at collected is its = heat dependent boiling m loss h in on time the t is the same temperature of as the point. kg 2 Current = I amps 2 V oltage = V volts 2 Time = t seconds I V 2 Equation (1) – Equation I V 1 t (I t – V I – 1 I m t = m 2 V 2 l 2 gives 2 V = (2) 1 1 t 2 l 1 ) = + – m v (m 2 h (I – m v ) l 2 V 1 l 2 1 l (2) v – 1 I v V 2 )t 2 = v (m – 1 m ) 2 131 Revision Answers found to on questions the that require questions calculation can be 7 9 a Describe accompanying CD. a Outline how a physical of a mercury-in-glass thermometer. b 1 the features property Give one [3] reason why glass is used in this type of which varies thermometer. with temperature may be used to temperature. b Suggest why [1] measure c State two d State one reasons the thermodynamic scale advantage is called an absolute scale. a Explain is used. [2] what is meant by a and one disadvantage thermometer over a of a platinum- [2] resistance 2 mercury of mercury-in-glass temperature why [3] thermometer over the same range. [2] thermometric 10 property. a Explain what is meant by the internal energy of substance. b State c Suggest three thermometric properties. why, on the Celsius scale, A piece of thermometers agree at the fixed may not between necessarily the fixed agree at piece A resistance points. thermometer is [3] placed 11 a Explain in pure 0 °C and its resistance is found to of resistance is 160 Ω. The be has in a liquid of A is found unknown to constant-volume measure the be gas unknown Bunsen flame. energy of [2] is meant by specific heat capacity a [3] specific heat capacity of temperature and –1 K . Calculate the amount heat energy is to raise temperature of 65 g of copper the from resistance a internal 3625 Ω. At thermometer required placed in the heat capacity. Copper –1 its to copper. what 385 J kg 100 °C, heated water b at is happens temperatures and 3 what points the but copper different Explain of [2] [3] b types a [1] 25 °C to 65 °C. [2] 850 Ω. thermometer temperature is used and 12 to is found A bicycle The to and bicycle is a rider have travelling a total along a mass of 90 kg. horizontal road brakes applied at a –1 be constant 65 °C. a Calculate the using the State your value of resistance the unknown until temperature thermometer. the braking [3] bicycle b answer in kelvin. Suggest a reason for the difference between on the resistance bicycle process, and rider 6.2 m s and and brake is thermometer. 5 State the principal features of a thermocouple. advantages 0. 15 kg. The is Briefly gas describe of a thermocouple over thermometer. a suitable the features of a the initial the the choice of thermometer a the temperature of a b the temperature of various to measure blast furnace temperature of boiling d the temperature of a measuring period 132 of the one positions in the flame [1] the whether a water [1] room. thermistor temperature year. energy brake in blocks heat capacity of the brake . Calculate: energy of the bicycle and rider kinetic in the energy brake converted into blocks [1] temperature rise of the brake [3] Describe specific an is of a [1] a electrical heat and capacity explain are used method of water. how to to the measure Include a the circuit measurements determine the in specific the heat [1] burner c Discuss the [4] capacity 8 of energy maximum diagram Bunsen of –1 K kinetic amount experiment a mass blocks. constant-volume the following: of the the [2] thermometer. State thermal of a 13 7 into During [2] c 6 total specific 1180 J kg thermal platinum-resistance rest. energy [4] b two to kinetic [2] a Describe comes the converted blocks. The –1 4 of are constant-volume blocks gas rider 65% . The the is readings of [2] the c speed suitable choice for laboratory over a [3] of water. [8] Revision questions 14 a Define the terms specific latent of fusion and 16 specific latent heat of vaporisation. b 25 g of ice at containing –12 °C 180 g of is added water at to a [3] polystyrene cup 26 °C. Explain 7 the following: a Sweating b The helps an temperature takes athlete of a cool liquid down. drops as [3] evaporation place. [3] Calculate: 17 i the amount of thermal energy required Describe heat convert ii the ice to water the final temperature [specific heat 3 4.2 × 10 of capacity at 0 °C the of [3] = specific latent 5 15 a Explain and b 10 one c State capacity heat two specific latent [6] Describe of an experiment vaporisation of to find water. the specific latent [6] of ice = of fusion 2. 1 of × ice 10 –1 J kg K , = is .] meant by the terms evaporation [2] similarity and between and the processes of boiling. differences evaporation the –1 J kg what evaporation to find ice. , boiling. State 18 heat 3 heat × of –1 J kg K specific 3.3 experiment of fusion [3] water. water an to between boiling. [1] the processes of [2] 133 16 Ideal 16. 1 Ideal gases and Charles’ A completion of this section, be able fixed state the gas mass use the a of gas graph is of heated at volume constant against pressure. temperature For is each temperature plotted. the result of such an experiment. When the graph is Figure 16.1.1 extrapolated, it laws cuts ᔢ law to: shows ᔢ theory you measured, should kinetic gases Learning outcomes On the equation of state for the temperature axis at – 273.15 °C. an 3 V/m ideal ᔢ gas understand absolute the concept of zero. Definition The volume directly of a fixed proportional mass to its of gas is absolute 273. 15 temperature, pressure is provided kept that temperature /°C the constant. Figure 16.1.1 Charles’ law V Equation V 1 Charles’ law can be used in the form 2 = T T 1 V ∝ V = 2 T Boyle’s law kT A fixed mass of gas is compressed at a constant temperature. For 3 V – volume of gas/m each T – absolute temperature/K k – proportionality pressure, experiment the are volume shown in of the Figure gas is recorded. The results of this 16.1.2. constant p/Pa p/Pa Definition The pressure of a fixed inversely proportional provided that kept the mass to its of gas is volume, temperature is constant. 1 3 3 /m V/m V Figure 16.1.2 Equation Boyle’s law 1 p ∝ Boyle’s law can be used in the form pV = p V 1 V = p 1 V 2 2 k 3 V – volume of p – pressure k – proportionality Pressure law gas/m of the gas/Pa constant A fixed the are mass of gas temperature shown in temperature of is Figure axis heated the at gas is 16.1.3. at constant recorded. When the volume. The graph is p 1 pressure law can be used in the form T 1 134 2 = T of each this pressure, experiment extrapolated, – 273.15 °C. p The For results 2 it cuts the Chapter p/Pa 16 Ideal gases and the kinetic theory Definition The pressure directly of proportional temperature, volume a fixed is mass to provided kept its of gas is absolute that the constant. Equation 273. 15 Figure 16.1.3 zero The experimental that when the temperature data graphs temperature is The SI from are It is unit equation of Charles’ law extrapolated, called possible. temperature. The p ∝ p = T The pressure law Absolute This temperature /°C absolute the of zero and they zero . of the temperature the pass It is Pressure through believed absolute on this or law is T – absolute p – pressure temperature/K k – proportionality of the gas/Pa constant show – 273.15 °C. to be Kelvin scale kT the the lowest scale of kelvin (K). state Equation All the gas equation laws of can state. be The combined constant into in one this equation equation –1 molar obeys gas the constant. gas It is equal to 8.31 J mol is known R and is as the called the pV = nRT –1 K . An ideal gas is one that n – number p – pressure/Pa of moles V – volume/m T – absolute R – molar of gas laws. 3 Example An to ideal gas prevent is contained heat losses. A in a cylinder piston is which attached is to surrounded one end of by the temperature/K insulation gas constant cylinder . –1 –4 The initial volume of the gas is 1.3 × 10 (8.31 J mol 3 m . The pressure –1 K ) and 5 temperature of i Calculate ii The the the gas are number 1.2 of × 10 moles Pa of and gas 310 K in the respectively. cylinder . Key points piston is –5 1.9 × 10 moved to compress the gas. The volume decreases to 3 m . The temperature increases to 650 K. Calculate the new ᔢ Charles’ law states that the pressure. volume of is directly i Using the equation of state pV = a fixed mass of proportional to pV number of moles of gas in the cylinder n its nRT absolute temperature, The gas that the pressure is provided kept constant. = RT ᔢ 5 1.2 × Boyle’s law states that the –4 10 × 1.3 × 10 pressure = 8.31 × of a fixed mass of gas 310 is inversely proportional to –3 = 6.06 × 10 mols its ii Using the equation of state pV = nRT, n is unchanged. ᔢ nRT The new pressure of the gas is p volume, provided temperature is The law Pressure kept that the constant. states that the = V pressure –3 6.06 × 10 × 8.31 × is 650 of directly a fixed mass proportional of to gas its = –5 1.9 × absolute 10 that the temperature, volume is provided kept constant. 6 = 1.72 × 10 Pa ᔢ An gas ideal gas is one that obeys the laws. 135 16.2 The kinetic Learning outcomes On completion should ᔢ be state able the kinetic ᔢ use ᔢ a speed section, of kinetic the and The you terms derive the Assumptions the to explain molecules a ᔢ use pV = by equation for deduce a the high that a gas gases is made up of many small speeds. theory molecules that The collisions ᔢ The intermolecular are make elastic up the (kinetic gas are energy is similar (same masses). conserved). The ᔢ the volume The ᔢ A of time large of forces during the occupied between the except gas by molecules the collisions between the molecules of the gas are collisions. is negligible when compared to the gas. is negligible when compared with the time collisions. number of molecules analysis can be are present; therefore the rules of applied. –2 translational ᔢ the statistical Nmc monatomic assumes at kinetic ᔢ ᔢ to deduce 3 the the All negligible, gas 1 gases randomly ᔢ mean square equation for of of of kinetic theory of pressure root mean square exerted theory moving volume pressure gases gases theory exerts of speed ᔢ kinetic particles assumptions gas define this of Assumptions of the to: theory the why of theory the kinetic gas energy The ᔢ Newtonian motion of the molecules kinetic mechanics is random. apply. of Using the molecules total monatomic ᔢ average energy of exerts kinetic theory to explain why a gas pressure gas. Suppose walls or a of a container the bourdon exerts a gauge. pressure gas are the container . they is container . moving undergo The on the around When a filled This kinetic inner in the change with a a of random The can theory walls molecules in gas. pressure be can the exerts be used manner because the to Newton’s second law of motion ( F why the of direction – over the exert surface a force area on of the the walls inner of the walls of the of of changes. Δp ) = , the Δt This container . gas the container , mu = container . the the walls the Δt molecules on manometer molecules with walls their a explain mv According pressure The colliding with a using to container . collide momentum, gas measured force As a is exerted result a F pressure is exerted on it ( p ) = A If the of temperature the container the temperature the average with of of a change greater pressure the gas the energy walls on exerted the on is walls the increased, kinetic When of of momentum force is The increases. kinetic collisions of increases. the the container inner the can occur greater of the be of and exerted used the increases. container . walls pressure temperature molecules much of the the theory more on the force the explain is walls why increased, means frequently. greater container gas This therefore A to that The molecules means the rate exert that the increases. Mean square speed and root mean square (r.m.s.) speed Suppose c , 1 If you value, 136 c a , gas c 2 , …, made up of N atoms having speeds as follows: c 3 were you is N to determine would have the square calculated of the each mean speed and square find speed the of mean the atoms Chapter 16 Ideal gases and the kinetic theory 2 that make up the gas. Mean square speed can be represented as either c Equation 2 or 〈c 〉 Mean The root mean square (r .m.s.) speed is the square root of the square speed 2 2 c square = mean speed. + c 1 2 〈c 2 + c 2 2 + … + c 3 N = 〉 N Example –1 Five gas molecules have –1 speeds of 100 m s –1 , – 250 m s –1 , 300 m s , Equation –1 275 m s and – 200 m s Calculate Root mean square 2 c a The mean square speed of the gas 2 molecules. 〈c √ 〉 speed 2 + c 1 = 2 2 + c 2 + … + c 3 N = N b The root c The mean a 〈c mean square speed of speed the 2 of + gas 2 (– 250) molecules. molecules. 2 100 the + 2 300 + 2 275 + (– 200) 2 4 〉 = = 5.56 × 10 –1 m s 5 z 2 2 100 + 2 (– 250) + 300 2 + 275 2 + (– 200) 2 〈c b –1 〉 √ = = 236 m s 5 100 + (– 250) + 300 + B 275 + (– 200) A –1 c c = = 45 m s 5 c l Derivation of the pressure exerted by a gas m c x Consider a cubic container of side l, containing N gas molecules, each of y mass m (Figure 16.2.1). C If you were randomly. to consider Suppose at a single one molecule, instant in it time would its be velocity moving is c about (Figure x 16.2.2). O D This velocity can be resolved into three components. (O , O x , O y ). The z Figure 16.2.1 molecule has velocity components as Deriving the pressure follows: exerted by a gas In the Ox direction – c x In the Oy direction – c c z y c In the Oz direction – c z 2 Also, c 2 = 2 c + c x 2 + c y 2 c z 2 = c 2 + x c 2 + c y z c y Assuming strikes that the the face molecule that was chosen moves back and forth and ABCD. c x The distance travelled by the molecule = 2l Figure 16.2.2 Resolving the velocity into components along the three axes distance The time between collisions with the face ABCD 2l = = speed c x Momentum of molecule just before hitting face ABCD = mc x Momentum of molecule just after hitting face ABCD = – mc x Change in momentum = (– mc ) – mc x = – 2mc x x 2 2mc Δp mc x Rate of change of momentum = = x = Δt l 2l ( ) c x (The the – sign face is removed because we are interested in the force acting on ABCD). 2 mc x Therefore, the force exerted on the face ABCD is l 137 Chapter 16 Ideal gases and the kinetic theory 2 mc x ( force The pressure exerted on the face ABCD = ) l 2 mc x = = 3 2 area l l 3 But the volume of the cube V = l 2 mc x ( force The pressure exerted on the face ABCD = ) l 2 mc x = = 2 area This is the pressure exerted by only one molecule, V l acting on the face ABCD. Since there are N molecules, all of them must be considered. 2 mc x 1 Pressure (exerted by first molecule) p = 1 V 2 mc x 2 Pressure (exerted by second molecule) p = 2 V 2 mc x 3 Pressure (exerted by third molecule) p = 3 V 2 mc x N Pressure (exerted by Nth molecule) p = N V T otal pressure acting of face ABCD = p + p 1 +p 2 2 + … mc 2 mc x 2 mc x 1 mc x 2 x 3 + N + V p N 2 = + 3 + V … + V V m ( = V This can be written in terms of mean 2 2 c + 2 c x + square c mean square speed be 〈c c x N ) speeds. 2 + c 2 + c x 1 〉 + 3 x 2 the 2 … x 2 2 Let c x 1 2 + … + c x 2 x 3 N = N 2 Nm〈c 〉 x Therefore p = V Since the motion of the molecules is 2 equation for p in terms of 〈c random, we or 〈c y 2 2 〉 Nm〈c = 2 〈c = 〈c But, c = + c x 2 Therefore, 〈c 〈c 〉 〈c 2 〉 + 〈c 〉 〉 y 2 〈c c z x Therefore, 2 + y 2 = 〉 2 c Equation V z 2 = 〉 z 2 〉 y 2 Nm〈c = V 2 〉 x 2 〉 y = V Therefore, obtained z x p have 〉 Nm〈c So could 2 〉 2 + 〈c 〉 z 2 = 3〈c 〉 x 1 2 pV Nm = 〈 c 〉 1 2 3 Or 〈c 〉 2 = 〈c 〉 x 3 p – pressure V – volume of the gas/Pa 1 Nm 2 Therefore, 3 of the pressure of the gas now becomes p = 〈c gas/m 3 N – number of m – mass one molecules – mean mass of V molecule/kg But, density ρ = Nm = volume V 2 〈 c 〉 square speed of the 1 2 molecules Therefore, the pressure is p = ρ 〈c 3 138 〉 〉 the Chapter Total kinetic energy of a monatomic 16 Ideal gases and the kinetic theory gas 1 Nm 2 The equation p = 〈c to several microscopic molecules equation and with the relates properties speed the 〉 a macroscopic property (pressure) V 3 of the equation of (number of molecules). state for an molecules, Let us ideal now gas mass of compare ( pV = the this nRT). 1 2 pV = Nm 〈c 〉 (1) 3 pV = nRT (2) Definition By comparing equations (1) and (2) we obtain the following. Kinetic 1 energy of all the gas 2 Nm 〈c 〉 = nRT molecules 3 3 1 3 2 Multiply both sides of the equation by = Nm 2 3 1 2 Nm 〈c 〉 ) = c = 〉 nRT 2 3 2 ( 〈 2 m – mass of N – total n – number – mean gas molecule/kg nRT 3 2 1 number of of gas moles of molecules gas 3 ( 2 Nm 〈c 〉 ) 2 = nRT 2 〈 c 〉 square speed of the 2 molecules 3 Therefore, the total kinetic energy of all the gas molecules is nRT R – molar gas constant 2 –1 (8.31 J mol Therefore, the kinetic energy of the gas molecules is proportional to T absolute temperature of the gas (E ∝ –1 K ) the – absolute temperature/K T). k In order you to divide determine the the average expression for the kinetic total energy kinetic of a single energy by molecule, the number of Definition molecules present. 1 T otal kinetic energy of all the molecules 3 ( = 2 Nm 〈c 〉 ) = 2 1 Kinetic energy of a single molecule ( = 2 m 〈c 〉 ) N = nN , where N is the total number of molecules, n kinetic energy of a gas molecule 3 nRT 2 N 1 3 2 = m 2 But Translational nRT 2 is the 〈 c 〉 number A kT = 2 2 m – mass – mean of gas molecule/kg 23 of moles and N is the Avogadro’s constant (6.02 × 10 ). 2 〈 A c 〉 k speed of the molecules R And square = , where k is known as the Boltzmann constant. k N – Boltzmann constant A –23 (1.38 3 Therefore, the kinetic energy of a single molecule = × 10 –1 J K ) kT T 2 – absolute temperature/K Example A balloon contains a the number b the average c the total of 0.60 mol helium of helium atoms in the at 310 K. Key points Calculate: balloon ᔢ kinetic kinetic energy energy of of a the helium helium atom atoms in the in the balloon [Boltzmann constant = 1.38 × 10 kinetic theory has several can be assumptions. balloon. ᔢ –23 The The kinetic theory used to –1 J K explain why a gas exerts pressure. 23 Avogadro constant = 6.02 × 10 ] ᔢ The average energy 23 a Number of atoms = N = nN = 0.60 × 6.02 × 10 of a translational monatomic kinetic gas 23 = 3.612 × 10 A 3 3 molecule 3 is given by –23 b Average kinetic energy = kT = × 2 1.38 × 10 × kT 2 310 J 2 ᔢ The total kinetic energy of all given by the –21 = 6.42 × 10 J molecules 23 c T otal kinetic energy = 3.612 × 10 –21 × 6.42 × 10 in a gas is 3 = 2.32 × 10 J 3 nRT 2 139 17 The first 17 . 1 The first law Learning outcomes On completion should ᔢ be state able of this law law thermodynamics of thermodynamics The first section, you to: the first of The first law of thermodynamics law of energy. to the It of ther modynamics states energy that supplied the to is change the simply in system the internal plus the principle energy work of a done of conservation system on the is equal system. of The thermodynamics first law of thermodynamics can be expressed mathematically as follows: ᔢ derive done an by expression for a the work gas. Equation The first Definition The first law of ΔU = ΔU – law ΔQ that the change energy of energy supplied the work a system done to on is the the in ΔW change in internal energy of system/J internal equal to system ΔQ – energy supplied to the system/J ΔW – work the done on the system/J plus system. It is important equation to understand the sign convention used when applying the above. ΔU is positive ΔU is negative ΔQ is positive ΔQ is negative (+) (–) is positive ΔW is negative when (–) when by a is energy when energy internal energy when (+) internal the when (–) work done the when (+) ΔW The gas thermodynamics thermodynamics the states + of work is is work is is energy being being being being is increasing. decreasing. supplied to removed done on done the from the by the system. the system. system. system. gas inlet Consider (Figure movable piston traps a gas cylinder 17.1.1). the gas The inside that has a movable cross-sectional the cylinder . area As long of as piston the attached piston there is a is to A. one The pressure end piston difference valve between the pressure, gas the contained piston will in the begin cylinder moving and freely. the external Now, atmospheric suppose a gas of atmospheric volume V is inside the cylinder . gas is The piston will move to the right until pressure gas at pressure p the and volume pressure of the equal to atmospheric pressure p V If the valve is opened to allow more gas to enter the cylinder , the pressure Figure 17.1.1 inside the because more Δ x cylinder more collisions piston will F external per begin atmosphere will begin molecules second to with a pressures of move force are the increase are acting to F. to gas the The same. being on the right. piston The (Figure added inner The gas stops piston 17.1.2). and walls of slowly moving moves It there increases are the going pushes when to cylinder . back the through a be The the internal distance and x atmospheric pressure gas and at pressure volume The work done by the gas against ΔW = force = F × Figure 17.1.2 140 atmospheric pressure is given by p V + ΔV × Δx distance moved in the direction of the force Chapter 17 The first law of thermodynamics force But pressure = area ∴ F Work = done p by × A the gas against But the atmospheric change in pressure volume = ΔV p = × A A × × Δx Equation Δx ΔW Work When done work is by the being gas against done by atmospheric the gas, ΔW is pressure ΔW = pΔV = pΔV ΔW – work p – pressure/Pa done /J ΔV – change negative. 3 The In same this expression case, ΔW is can be used when the gas is being in volume/m compressed. positive. Applying the first law of thermodynamics Example A fixed mass of an ideal gas absorbs 1500 J of heat energy and expands 4 under a constant pressure of –2 to a the volume of 4.2 × 2.5 × 10 –2 Pa from a of 2.1 × 10 3 m 3 10 m . Calculate the change in internal energy of gas. Heat Since supplied the Work to pressure done by the gas remains gas ΔW is ΔQ = 1500 J constant, = pΔV = 2.5 = 420 J 4 Using the first Change Note of volume that in law of work –2 (4.2 10 × –2 10 – 2.1 × 10 ) thermodynamics internal since × energy was of done gas by ΔU the = ΔQ + = 1500 = 1080 J gas a ΔW + minus (– 420) sign is needed in front ΔW Example An ideal gas is contained in a cylinder which is surrounded by insulation –4 to prevent heat losses. The initial volume of the gas is 2.5 × 10 3 m . The 5 pressure and i Calculate ii The temperature the piston × new 10 number is –5 2.1 of moved of to the gas moles is of compress 1.1 gas the × in 10 the gas. Pa and 320 K respectively. cylinder . The volume decreases to 3 m pressure . The of temperature the gas and increases explain why to 750 K. the Calculate temperature of the the gas increases. ii The work internal i Using done energy the on of the the equation of gas is 86 J. Determine the increase in the gas. state pV = nRT pV The number of moles of gas in the cylinder n = RT 5 1.1 × 10 –4 × 2.5 × 10 = 8.31 × 320 –2 = 1.03× 10 mol 141 Chapter 17 The first law of thermodynamics ii Using the equation of state, pV = nRT is unchanged. nRT The new pressure of the gas is p = V –2 1.03 × 10 × 8.31 × 750 = –5 2.1 × 10 6 = The molecules When a the greater the to molecules mean ΔW = gas the moving with means increase. of are collide This kinetic temperature iii the velocity. molecules the of Since energy the of all compressed about the that 3.06× piston, average temperature its Pa randomly moving the 10 at they kinetic of molecules, a velocities. rebound energy gas there high is is of with all proportional an increase in gas. +86 J Energy supplied to the system ΔQ = 0 J since the cylinder is insulated. Using The the first change in law of thermodynamics internal energy of the gas ΔU = ΔQ + = 0 + = +86 J ΔW 86 Example A gas movable cylinder is fitted with a piston which can move without friction piston contains 0.055 mols of an ideal gas at a temperature of 300 K and a 5 pressure of 1 × 10 Pa (Figure 17.1.3). Calculate: insulated i the volume ii the internal of the gas energy of the gas. cylinder Suppose the temperature of the gas is increased to 360 K and the pressure Figure 17.1.3 is kept constant. Calculate: iii the change iv the external v the total in internal work amount energy done of by of the energy the gas supplied –1 [molar i gas Using constant the = equation 8.31 J mol of gas state pV nRT to the gas. –1 K = ] nRT 0.055 × 8.31 × 300 –3 V olume of gas V = = = 1.37 × 10 3 m 5 p ii The the of an internal gas. all The the ideal energy an temperature molecules gas of 1 is given that ideal of gas the make is gas up 10 dependent is the × on dependent gas. The the on total temperature the kinetic kinetic energy of by 3 E = nRT K 2 3 ∴ U = nRT 2 3 Internal energy U = 142 3 nRT 2 = × 2 0.055 × 8.31 × 300 = of energy 206 J Chapter iii Change in temperature Change in internal of the gas = 360 – 300 = 17 The first law of thermodynamics 60 K 3 energy ΔU = nRΔT 2 3 = × 0.055 × 8.31 × 60 = 41 J 2 iv External The new work done volume by of the the gas gas is given must nRT first 0.055 × by be ΔW = pΔV determined. 8.31 × 360 –3 V = = = 1.65 × 10 3 m 5 p External work done by 1 the gas ΔW × 10 = pΔV 5 = v Using Since T otal the first work law was energy of done supplied 1 × 10 –3 (1.65 thermodynamics by the gas to the gas ΔQ = × –3 10 – 1.37 ΔU = ΔQ ΔW = – 28 J ΔU – ΔW + = × 10 ) = 28 J (– 28) = 69 J ΔW 41 – Example 5 At a temperature of 100 °C and pressure of 1.01× 10 Pa, 1 kg of steam 3 occupies 1.67 m . At occupies 1.04 10 If water the –3 1 kg of × at same temperature and pressure, 1 kg of water 3 m 100 °C is converted to 1 kg of steam at100 °C. Calculate: i the energy ii the work iii the increase in internal iv the increase in potential supplied done against 6 [l = 2.26 × 10 to produce the this change atmosphere energy energy of the molecules of water . –1 J kg ] v i Energy supplied to produce change Q = ml v 6 = 1 × 2.26 = 2.26 × 10 6 ii Work done against the × 10 J atmosphere ΔW = pΔV = 1.01 × 10 = 1.69 × 10 Key points 5 3 (1.67 – 1.04 × 10 5 ) ᔢ J The first states iii Increase in internal energy ΔU = ΔQ + 6 2.26 of thermodynamics change in internal ΔW energy = law the × 10 of a system is equal to 5 + (–1.69 × 10 ) the energy supplied to it plus the 6 = 2.09 × 10 J work iv At a change of state, there is no change in temperature. All ᔢ energy supplied is used to increase the potential energy of done and not their kinetic The the increase in system. work done by pressure a gas is at equal to energies. the Therefore, the the constant molecules on the potential energy of the pressure multiplied by the molecules change in volume of the gas. 6 = 2.09 × 10 J. 143 17 .2 Molar heat Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this capacities Molar section, you The define the molar required to: In ᔢ heat term the case p–V diagrams capacities heat to and capacity increase the of large a gas, of a substance temperature changes of in is the one amount mole pressure of and it of by thermal one volume energy degree. occur when molar heat supplied with thermal energy. The change in volume and pressure when capacity a ᔢ explain why capacity is at greater capacity a the constant than at molar the or defined heat liquid under is heated two is negligible. particular The heat capacity of a gas can be conditions. pressure molar constant solid ᔢ Molar heat capacity at constant pressure. ᔢ Molar heat capacity at constant volume. heat volume for gas The molar heat capacity of a gas at constant pressure C , is the amount p of ᔢ perform calculations using energy required to raise the temperature of one mole of a gas by one p –V degree, when the pressure remains constant. diagrams. The molar heat capacity at constant volume C , is the amount of v energy required degree The movable when molar to the heat raise the volume temperature remains capacity at of one mole of a gas by one constant. constant pressure is greater than the molar piston heat capacity at constant volume. heat Consider then gas atmospheric pressure gas must external gas contained to the expand work potential Figure 17.2.1 a supplied and gas. and by a cylinder order move moving kinetic in In the the energy for piston. piston. of at the a the In this Also, gas pressure pressure p. to Heat process, the heat molecules energy remain the gas supplied (Figure is constant, has to the do increases the 17.2.1). Heating a gas at constant pressure Now consider When fixed volume the the gas is its temperature. no external same gas heated, Since, contained all the the in energy volume of a cylinder supplied the to having it container is is a used volume to fixed, V. increase the gas does V heat work. temperature of a This gas means when its that less volume energy is fixed. is It required follows to raise that C the > C p Molar heat capacity at constant pressure and constant volume v are related gas as Figure 17.2.2 follows (Figure 17.2.2): Heating a gas at constant –1 C Equations = nC H = R, where R is the molar gas constant (R = –1 8.31 J mol K ). p–V indicator diagrams diagram is a graph showing how the pressure p of a gas varies Δθ nC H E = v p with E C Using An E – p volume volume V during a change. The work done in each stage can be Δθ determined. v – its is energy Suppose represented by the a gas point has A. a pressure The gas and then volume, expands such while that its its state pressure H n – number of remains moles by C – molar heat capacity the fixed. gas is Its new given by state ΔW is = represented pΔV. If the by the volume point of the B. gas The is work kept done fixed and at p constant C – molar its pressure C. No is increased, the new state would be represented by the point pressure heat capacity work is done by the gas during this change. Suppose the gas is now at v compressed, constant represented Δθ – change while keeping the pressure fixed. The new state would be volume in temperature of by the point D. The work done on the gas is given by ΔW = the pΔV. If the volume of the gas is kept fixed and its pressure is decreased, gas the new the gas energy state. that 144 state of the The it would during gas gas hasn’t this is be represented change. zero. starts off changed During The at the state. by internal point The the the A net point entire energy and effect A. cycle, of a all work the gas returns of No to the is is change done in dependent the point changes is A, by internal on its meaning zero. Chapter 17 The first of fixed of thermodynamics pressure/Pa Example A law mass pressure, of an ideal volume gas and in a heat pump temperature as undergoes shown in a cycle Figure of 17.2.3 changes B (not 919 K 5 20 × 10 drawn to scale). C No heat is internal supplied energy of to the the gas gas is from as A → B and C → D. The increase in 5 11 × 10 505 K follows A 5 492 K 2.5 × 10 A → B Using the 1300 J the first B → C law of –1200 J thermodynamics C → D and the data – 450 J supplied, 5 determine 1 × 10 190 K D following: i the work done on the gas from A ii the work done on the gas from B iii the heat iv the increase v the heat vi the number to B and C C and D to D -3 -3 0.42 × 10 to to 1.8 × 10 A 3 volume/m supplied to the gas from B to C Figure 17.2.3 First i ii law of in internal supplied of to the moles of gas gas thermodynamics of the from D being ΔU = gas to from D to A A used. ΔQ + ΔW From A to B, ΔW = ΔU + ΔQ = 1300 – 0 = 1300 J From C to D, ΔW = ΔU + ΔQ = – 450 – 0 = – 450 J From B ΔV 0. = to C there This is no means ∴ From D to ΔV 0. This = A there is means supplied to the no = no volume is done of the on or gas, by therefore the gas. 0 no = gas in work change that ΔW Heat change that ΔW ∴ iii energy in work volume is done of the on or gas, by therefore the gas. 0 for B to C, ΔQ = ΔU = – 1200 ΔW – 0 = 1200 J Key points iv The internal energy is is fixed, energy of dependent the total a on gas is dependent temperature. change in internal on Since its the energy of state. The internal temperature the gas at during A ᔢ the The molar heat capacity of constant pressure C gas at the amount a , is p complete From A cycle to is zero. B, ΔU = to +1300 J raise mole From B to From C C, ΔU = –1200 J ΔU = – 450 J of when to D, the a the of energy required temperature gas by one pressure of one degree, remains constant. From D to A, ΔU = ? ᔢ All these internal energy values should add up to zero, because The molar heat capacity at ΔU constant volume C , is the v from A to A is zero. amount From D to A, ΔU = 0 – (1300 + –1200 + – 450) = Heat ΔQ supplied = ΔU – to ΔW the = gas 350 for – D 0 to = energy required to +350 J raise v of A, the mole of when 350 J temperature a the gas by one volume of one degree remains constant. vi Using the equation of state pV = nRT pV The number of moles of gas in the cylinder n ᔢ = The molar heat capacity at RT constant 5 2.5 × 10 is greater –3 × 1.8 × 10 than = = 8.31 pressure × the molar heat capacity at 0.11 mols 492 constant ᔢ p–V diagrams illustrate and volume. the volume can be used changes of a in to pressure gas. 145 Revision Answers found to on questions the that require questions calculation can be 8 accompanying CD. 8 A cylinder without friction gas 1 Explain what is meant an ideal b absolute at a with and a piston contains temperature by: of which can 0.022 mols 280 K and a move of an pressure ideal of 5 1.6 a is fitted gas × 10 Pa. [1] Calculate: 2 A bubble the of zero. gas [1] rises from surface. The pressure the at bottom the of bottom a pond of the to pond i the volume ii the internal Suppose the of the gas energy temperature [2] of of the the gas. gas [3] is increased to 5 is 2.5 × 10 Pa and the pressure at the surface is 330 K and the pressure is kept constant. 5 1.0 × 10 Pa. The volume of the bubble at the bottom Calculate: 3 of the pond bubble 3 A at is 2.5 cm the cylinder the volume of the surface. contains temperature, . Calculate 1.8 mol 25 °C iii the change in iv the external v the total internal energy of the gas and of the a gas at pressure room inside work amount done of by the energy gas [2] supplied is 3.6 when × an 10 Pa. The additional temperature 4.5 mol of gas increases is [Molar to the 4 the cylinder. Calculate the new pressure a gas is Explain what is of a gas heated the is to V at 330 K a temperature at constant is meant by: the molar heat capacity at constant volume the molar heat capacity at constant of percentage increase in pressure. [2] 220 K. Explain why the molar heat capacity at constant the volume of is greater than the molar heat capacity the constant volume for a gas. [3] [3] c a Explain b Write what down is meant the by an equation of ideal gas. state for [1] an ideal the symbols ideal gas has a volume of the a temperature of a State four 1.9 × 3 10 m gas is 1.0 ×10 300 K. The b The two [1] assumptions kinetic pressure of the kinetic theory. [4] gas is p theory and of gases the volume can V of show an that ideal the gas is of given Pa. The the and 5 the between [3] pressure at relationship gas, used. –3 An State quantities. 10 explaining is ] pressure. gas? c –1 K ii at 5 8.31 J mol i pressure What = [5] b The constant inside cylinder. The volume gas pumped 9 into the [2] –1 60 °C to gas. the 5 cylinder [2] [3] by the expression compressed 1 –3 until its volume and pressure is 1. 1 ×10 2 3 m pV= and Nm 〈 c 〉 3 5 1.6 × 10 Pa i the ii the final respectively. Calculate: where number of moles of gas present i temperature of the 3 6 A cylinder of volume 6.5 × 10 gas. at a pressure of 1.8 × 10 m contains and a the mass of a gas molecule. ii helium temperature what the following symbols mean: N 2 3 Pa is State [3] 7 gas m [2] c and 〈 Use the kinetic of [2] 〉 expression energy temperature 300 K. c i State what is of a to deduce gas the molecule mean at a T. [3] meant by the internal energy of Calculate: a a the amount b the mean of gas in the container ii kinetic energy of the substance. helium atoms Using the total the container. kinetic energy of the helium atoms the expression the change mass energy and of an ideal expands gas under absorbs a 1100 J constant 2. 1 × 10 –2 Pa from a volume –2 volume of Calculate 146 of 3.6 the × 10 of 1.9 × heat pressure 4 of internal in b ii energy to of explain an gas is proportional to the change in [3] temperature A fixed in in ideal 7 derived [2] why c [2] [2] 10 3 m to a 3 m change in internal energy of the gas. [5] of the gas. [2] Revision questions 11 A fixed as mass shown of an ideal gas undergoes a 8 cycle ABCA below. 4 volume / 10 10 3 m A 8 6 4 2 C B 0 5 10 15 20 25 30 5 pressure / 1 0 a State when b the it Copy and energy in undergoes Calculate change A c change the to the work energy of the on the gas [1] during the B. [2] the during table the below relating the cycle ABCA. [6] Work done Energy Change on supplied internal to energy of gas/J gas/J the B gas cycle ABCA. done complete changes Change internal Pa A → B → C +650 C → A +315 in gas/J -520 147 18 Thermal 18. 1 Thermal energy conduction Thermal Learning outcomes one On completion should ᔢ be able explain of this section, transfer or energy more of can the and be convection transferred following three from one point to another by either methods: you ᔢ conduction – a ᔢ convection – ᔢ radiation no medium is required. to: what is meant by a medium is required. thermal – medium is required. Energy can be transferred in a conduction vacuum. ᔢ describe the vibrations process and of electron lattice diffusion Thermal ᔢ explain and use the concept Thermal thermal explain conduction what is meant by thermal region any net of high of one vibrations explain a process how land and sea temperature movement because convection ᔢ is by which thermal energy flows from conductivity a ᔢ conduction of of and of the two to a region material itself. mechanisms. electron of low temperature Thermal These without conduction mechanisms are occurs called lattice diffusion breezes are formed Lattice vibrations ᔢ explain how ocean currents are In a non-metal such as ceramic there are no free electrons. If some hot produced. coffee is poured ceramic the mug, coffee atoms in adjacent their walls is it into in thermal atoms energy wall with atoms to the the flows in mug, are the as is inner as process outside called the well. walls These of lattice of until the heat flows mug, outer wall room temperature vibrate, collide from the When the to with the process (Figure In bonds. begin then This hot. by inner which 18.1.1). at gain kinetic energy net flow kinetic of thermal energy energy transferred Figure 18.1.1 strong they atoms mug. becomes ceramic As vibrations coffee it by the energy. repeats of together walls gain contact hot outside bonded they vibrating and to with vibrate begin mug inner atoms contact begin the ceramic adjacent neighbours of a to Conduction by lattice vibrations Electron diffusion Metals of hot spoon. the in the their 148 In a the conductors begin energy there When collide the energy. fast-moving process, is are a free The collide this energy If free with moving in the Since other thermal process transfers metal electrons atom. This a transmitted placed process, electrons. thermal heat. electrons is vibrating they In of quickly spoon vibrating. with structure, kinetic the good thermal metal, metal they within this very structure. time by are soup, at a is spoon up around pot of gain the hot is called is the energy are electron rate a pot the within atoms every moving transfer being faster in of randomly soup, kinetic and energy placed handle electrons atoms much the some of transferred diffusion. than In lattice Chapter vibrations. In a vibrations, but metal, some of the thermal energy is transferred by 18 Thermal energy transfer lattice Definition are good this occurs conductors of to heat a lesser and degree electricity than electron (Figure diffusion. Metals 18.1.2). The coefficient conductivity kinetic energy transferred metal atoms in hot thermal heat per unit rate area of flow per unit electrons temperature electrons metal of the fast-moving of to fast-moving is end gradient, heat flow is faces thin of of the a at right when angles parallel-sided material, under the to the slab steady state soup conditions. metal atoms vibrate gain Figure 18.1.2 as kinetic net flow of thermal energy l they θ energy Thermal 2 conductivity sample Conduction at 2 θ 1 rate θ Conduction by electron diffusion θ The > 1 occurs which at different thermal rates energy in is different thermal transferred by lagging conductors. thermal conduction Figure 18.1.3 Coefficient of thermal conductivity depends on: ᔢ the cross-sectional ᔢ the material ᔢ the temperature from area which the conductor is made Equation Consider a slab of gradient material across of the conductor . cross-sectional area A and length l. The θ Q – θ 1 temperatures at the ends of the conductor are maintained at θ and 1 (θ > θ 1 ). This is referred to as steady state = θ 2 – kA t ( 2 ) l conditions. 2 Q –1 The sides of the conductor are completely lagged θ so – that The temperature gradient is defined are no heat – rate of flow – coefficient of heat/W or J s t θ 1 losses. there k 2 of thermal as l –1 conductivity/W m –1 K 2 Q The rate of flow of heat through the conductor ( t A ) is expressed as – cross-sectional area/m follows: θ – 1 θ 2 –1 – θ Q – 1 ∝ equation can be temperature gradient/K m l 2 A t The θ l re-written as follows: θ Q – – kA ( temperature θ 1 = t 2 ) l θ 1 The constant of conductivity . transferred (Figure Good proportionality The in the negative direction k, sign in is called indicates which the the that coefficient thermal temperature is of ther mal energy is being decreasing θ 18.1.3). thermal 2 conductors have a high coefficient of thermal distance along sample conductivities. –1 (e.g. Poor copper = thermal 390 W m conductors –1 (e.g. glass The graph conductor = 0.8 W m in Figure varies –1 K –1 silver have a low = 420 W m coefficient –1 K , 18.1.4 with , of –1 wood shows distance = 0.15 W m how along it the –1 K ) thermal K ) temperature when conductivity. –1 the sides across are sample a insulated. Figure 18.1.4 temperature gradient is constant. with lagging The Temperature difference across a thermal conductor (lagging) 149 Chapter 18 Thermal energy transfer The temperature graph varies θ in with Figure distance 18.1.5 along shows it not how when temperature gradient is temperature gradient decreases the constant. the temperature sides Heat are not escapes across insulated. from the a conductor The sides and the 1 as the distance from the hotter side increases. Example θ 2 –5 distance along A copper rod of is arranged is maintained length such that 0.6 m it is and cross-sectional completely lagged on area the 7.85 sides. × One at 18.1.6). 100 °C and Calculate the the other rate of end flow is of maintained thermal at rod (thermal conductivity copper Figure 18.1.5 end of copper rod = 0 °C energy –1 copper without 2 m sample (Figure sample 10 through the –1 390 W m K ). lagging lagging Temperature difference across a thermal conductor (without 0 °C 100 °C lagging) 0.6 m Figure 18.1.6 Under steady state conditions θ Q – θ 1 = – kA t 2 ( ) l Q 100 –5 = – 390 × 7.85 × 10 × t ( – 0 ) 0.6 W = 5.10 W Example An to ideally an The lagged free end aluminium at compound aluminium the of is point bar the of copper maintained at which bar length the bar at consists 20 cm is of long a maintained 0 °C copper (Figure and copper and of at 100 °C 18.1.7). aluminium conductivity of copper –1 of aluminium = 220 W m copper = 390 W m 12 cm bars long joined cross-sectional and Calculate –1 (Thermal bar equal are the free the area. end of the temperature joined. –1 K , thermal conductivity –1 K ) rod lagging aluminium rod 0 °C 100 °C 12 cm 20 cm Figure 18.1.7 Under and Let steady state aluminium the conditions, are the temperature at same. the the point Q where 100 = 390 × A × t ( × – ( – 0.12 + flow of the two heat heat bars through loss meet θ ) = 210 θ × A × ( from be – = ( 0.20 = 7800 78 θ = 7800 θ = ) – 78 θ 7800 = 103.2 150 θ 0 0.20 210 θ ) 25.2 θ 25.2 θ of prevents θ 0.12 100 390 rate (Lagging 75.6 °C ) the the copper sides.) Chapter 18 Thermal energy transfer Convection In is fluids (liquids convection. temperature of in the a fluid therefore liquid to a result liquid above is of low a to sets main is transferred of transferred change. bottom than the up form temperature density the dense sinks process heat of at less the energy region becomes The process a the from rise. gases) Thermal to as beaker , and from due liquid bottom and convection of to When becomes the because thermal region the bulk some warmer . above causes currents the a energy it. the in of high movement water It is heated expands The less (Figure change transfer and cooler dense 18.1.8). density of denser liquid In the this liquid. liquid Land and sea convection breezes currents The specific During above the the replace it. heat day, land capacity the land rises This and creates of heats the a water up is much cooler sea much air breeze larger faster from (Figure than than above that the the of sea. sea soil. The rushes hot in air to 18.1.9). heat Figure 18.1.8 warm air Convection currents in a rises liquid cooler above rushes land air from the in replace land heats the air up above faster sea to than the the land sea sea during the Key points day ᔢ Figure 18.1.9 Thermal energy is transferred The formation of sea breezes (day time) by conduction, convection and radiation. During than the cooler , a the land night, sea. The denser breeze air the air reverse above from (Figure process the above sea the occurs. is land The warmer rushes land and in to cools therefore replace more rises. it. This quickly The ᔢ Thermal by creates conduction electron ᔢ Electron diffusion mechanism for warm air transfer rises ᔢ air from above The in rushes in to air above the coefficient faster heat per is thin the of Colder of flow per unit at right when angles the a to parallel-sided the slab sea of the material, under steady ᔢ The formation of land breezes (night time) conditions. Thermal region convection of thermal of high is the energy from temperature to a currents region currents sun rate area night a the thermal gradient, faces transfer Ocean unit heat flow state Ocean of the sea sea the main energy down than during Figure 18.1.10 is temperature cools the replace land land is thermal the of the lattice metals. conductivity land or vibrations. 18.1.10). cooler occurs diffusion heats denser occur up the water as a result ocean, rushes of warm in and the change water rises convection in density because its currents of sea water . density are set As decreases. the as a of bulk low temperature movement result of a of density due to the fluid change. up. 151 18.2 Measuring Learning outcomes On completion should ᔢ be able describe of this thermal conductivity Experiment to find the thermal section, you good conductivity of a conductor to: an experiment to find θ 3 θ the thermal good conductivity of 4 a conductor θ water flowing 1 ᔢ describe an experiment to find 2 the thermal poor conductivity of in θ at a constant rate a conductor. l A lagging electrical Figure 18.2.1 In the long there is case to a lagged used One the to bar rate. of good a conductors, measurable measurable to prevent determine end coil Experiment to measure the thermal conductivity of a good conductor give is heating of is the cooled When heat is by steady thermometers temperature the bar losses state length the an sides are steady), θ θ of flow of heat through the θ – kA t Where A between is θ the and cross-sectional θ 1 The rate and k is – the ( area bar . shown (i.e and in The that other coils the at bar 18.2.1. end a reading are the experiment Figure The θ 3 is sufficiently of constant on recorded. all the The 4 given by: θ 2 ) l of the heater . θ 2 1 = , be ensures experiment, conducting conductor Q should This this reached , 1 rate bar of is electric through conditions the In conductivity with flowing become of difference. gradient. from thermal heated water have the temperature the thermal (1) conductor conductivity and of l the is the distance conductor . 2 at which thermal energy is being removed by the water is given by: Q m = t where m/t is the rate of × c flow of × (θ w t the – 3 water θ ) (2) 4 and c is the specific heat w capacity of Equation water . (1) and equation θ – 1 – kA (2) θ l equated to ) = c (θ w t – 3 θ In a the large value of k ) conductivity of a conductor case of a poor conductor , cross-sectional through 152 the 4 Experiment to find the thermal poor determine m 2 ( are the sample. area. the This sample allows for must a be large thin rate of and should flow of have heat Chapter steam 18 Thermal energy transfer in steam chest steam brass θ out base 2 sample θ brass 1 Figure 18.2.2 In this Experiment to measure the thermal conductivity of a poor conductor experiment, Thermometers heated it is a using poor disk a are the steam negligible. are constant Under in chest conductor , are sample inserted it is placed holes (Figure can steady be in between the 18.2.2). assumed state brass two Since that the heat conditions, brass slabs. the slabs. The upper sample losses is from the temperature slab thin θ sides and θ 1 the of rate of loss thermal The rate and the of heat energy of flow rate loss of of flow from is heat by the of heat bottom through of the the brass sample disc. is The is and 2 equal main to form convection. through the sample θ Q – – kA given insulation by: θ 1 = t is 2 ( ) l (1) brass disk θ 1 where 2 A = πr and r is the radius of the disc and l is the thickness of the sample. thermal The rate of loss of heat from the bottom brass slab is given energy loss by: Figure 18.2.3 Q Δθ = mc ( × t where m is the mass of the brass disc ) Δt (2) and c is the specific heat capacity of temperature / °C brass. In is order to heated determine directly the with rate the at which steam the chamber . brass disc When the cools, the brass temperature of disc the θ 1 brass disc is steady, brass disc is covered θ is recorded over the a sample with an period and steam insulator of time chamber (Figure until it are 18.2.3). removed The approximately and the temperature 5 °C less than 1 the of previous the graph steady at θ state is value. determined A cooling (Figure curve is then plotted. The slope 18.2.4). time /s 1. Equation (1) and equation (2) are equated to determine the value of k Figure 18.2.4 Measuring the rate of heat loss by convection from the brass disc θ – θ 1 – kA ( Δθ 2 ) l = mc Δt Key points ᔢ When determining conductor ᔢ When should determining sample should be the be thermal long the thin and thermal and conductivity of a good of a poor conductor, the thin. have conductivity a large conductor, cross-sectional the area. 153 18.3 Radiation Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this Thermal section, you Hot objects higher to: away ᔢ explain what is meant by radiation the per emit energy temperature second by by of a process the thermal called object, the radiation. thermal more radiation. energy Thermal is The transmitted radiation is made up thermal of electromagnetic waves with a continuous range of wavelengths. radiation These ᔢ explain what is meant by thermal surface equilibrium ᔢ understand are also wavelengths electromagnetic that good good absorbers emitters of radiation of Suppose a a body small it can from be object X, either at a infrared thermal chamber T 18.3.1). (Figure whose reflected or temperature Since walls the concept of by the convection are the visible is regions incident of the on the absorbed. T is placed maintained chamber or is at a inside an evacuated, temperature conduction. All the heat cannot energy is be transmitted by a thermal radiation. If T until temperature > T 1 , the object loses energy by thermal radiation 2 body. its becomes T . If T 2 ᔢ to radiation 2 understand black the When 1 evacuated transmitted ᔢ span spectrum. sketch the spectrum of a black thermal radiation until its < T 1 , the object gains energy by 2 temperature becomes T . In either case, the 2 body radiator and the effect of state Stefan’s Prevost’s law. will become T eventually. It should be noted that energy 2 absorption temperature ᔢ temperature and emission theory temperature as surroundings of its is does exchanges not states surroundings equal to the cease its rate that rate of at this point. when of a body emission absorption of is of at the same radiation radiation to from the the surroundings. non-conducting Therefore, is thread at and the in the same emitting equilibrium previous demonstration temperature energy with by its as its thermal even though surroundings, radiation. It is it is said the still to object X absorbing be in ther mal surroundings. T 1 The rate at depends which on the energy flows temperature from of the an object by ther mal radiation object. X It follows also evacuated chamber T 2 a would Good Figure 18.3.1 rise the water the heat equal of that the the in water better in can perfect one and is can that B cools the of is of thermal otherwise of at outer painted over faster a the radiation is temperature A Bunsen water water black. are of If of that water and placed can the time, in at B. burner . over in 100 °C surface radiation can A into is two painted temperature it A. can The be silver of the shown black surface surface. using cans ther mal period than silvered in of the water The repeated the drying surfaces. of absorbs out B. lighted becomes absorber that boiling placed a absorber emitters measured B good a can room The A cans are thermometer period B temperature. two of time. increases It more is can Equal placed used be at to shown quickly than A. example is of temperature bitumen A good of a radiation; surroundings. and be are from dried on its than can Another pointed A can water the of is is thermal also temperature radiation 154 cans distance measure are cans, experiment volumes that surface water radiates The both which of volumes metal outer in body above equal identical that a emitter absorbers Suppose and that good the hot. the crops. black This thermal all of The is concept an radiation radiation of a In is called is body countries, absorbs effective which black some surface means a black incident is a crops energy of it. theoretical It A are thermal drying body. on by crops. black should one. body be Chapter Energy distribution body A spectrum of a Thermal energy transfer black radiator black body radiator characteristic constant Figure in the 18 its is at a one that temperature. temperature 18.3.2 radiator of shows consists a constant typical emits Black of a thermal body continuous spectrum radiation radiation range obtained which from of from a a is source at wavelengths. black body temperature. power radiated 2 per unit area / W m visible infrared region region T 0 500 1000 1500 2000 wavelength /μm Figure 18.3.2 Since the Spectrum of a black body radiator graph is curved it means that the energy carried away by Exam tip radiation the area is not under evenly the distributed graph gives the across total the range energy of wavelengths. radiated per unit Also, time per Notice unit surface area at a temperature of Figure 18.3.3 shows what that, happens to the distribution curves as a black of a black body radiator is the curve shifts to the left increased. the visible emitted region of radiation falls the in the electromagnetic radiated 2 per temperature increases, the and power the body distribution temperature as T unit spectrum. The area / W m λ changes from max colour red to of the yellow body to white. red violet 5500 K 5000 K 4500 K 4000 K 3500 K 0 500 1000 1500 2000 wavelength /μm Figure 18.3.3 From the the Effect on spectrum as temperature increases graphs temperature car ried This away can cur ve be peaks emitting by it can of the the said, at a be shorter because lower radiation seen black in that body distribution wavelengths at higher wavelength. the the changes. visible The increases temperatures, If a region body of is the cur ve changes proportion with the hot of the as energy temperature. distribution enough, it electromagnetic will begin spectr um. 155 Chapter 18 Thermal energy transfer At around the red body 1200 K, end of changes There is a the the visible spectr um. from red relationship to wavelength At higher yellow between to that is emitted, temperatures, the lies mostly colour of in the white. λ of each cur ve and its temperature. max It can be expressed as follows λ T = constant max This relationship Stefan’s The area is known as Wien’s displacement law . law under each cur ve gives the total energy E, radiated per unit time Definition per unit under Stefan’s law states that the rate energy is radiated from a the is power proportional of the to graph is at a temperature proportional the T. Stefan’s fourth power law of states the that the temperature area of body expressed in kelvin. black Stefan’s body area at the which sur face law can be expressed mathematically as follows. the fourth temperature of the Equation body expressed in kelvin. Stefan’s Law 4 P = σAeT P – energy σ – Stefan’s radiated A – surface e – emissivity T – surface per second/W –8 constant (5.67 × 10 –2 W m –4 K ) 2 When an area/m of object sur roundings. difference the body (e = 1 for a black body) temperature/K radiates energy, it also absorbs The net energy emitted by an between the energy emitted by the absorbed by equation below. the object. The net energy energy object is object radiated per from the equal and to the second the energy is given by the Equation 4 P = σAe(T 4 – T net P ) s – net – Stefan’s energy radiated per second/W net –8 σ constant (5.67 × 10 –2 W m –4 K ) 2 A – surface area/m e – emissivity T – surface T – temperature of the body (e = 1 for a black body) temperature/K of surroundings/K s Example A of blackened 40 °C is sphere temperature 156 (e suspended of = 0.25) inside a of radius box 12 cm, which is initially held at a at a temperature constant 110 °C. a Calculate the rate b Calculate the initial of absorption net rate of of energy by absorption of the sphere energy by inside the the box. sphere. Chapter a T = 273.15 + 110 = Rate area of of sphere energy Thermal energy transfer 383.15 K 2 Surface 18 A = –2 4πr = 4π(12 × 10 2 –1 ) = 1.81 × 10 2 m absorption 4 P = σAeT = (5.67 = 273.15 –8 b T Net rate × of 10 + 40 = = × 10 4 )(0.25)(383.15) = 55.25 W 313.15 K absorption 4 P –1 )(1.81 of energy 4 σAe(T – T ) s –8 = (5.67 × 10 –1 )(1.81 × 10 4 )(0.25)(383.15 4 – 313.15 ) = 30.5 W Example The emissivity of a person’s skin is 0.74. Normal body temperature 2 is 310 K. 0.37 m temperature the exposed of of skin 308K. is exposed Calculate to the the net atmosphere energy which radiated per is at a second from skin. 4 P = 4 σAe(T – T net ) s –8 = 5.67 × = 3.66 W 10 4 × 0.37 × 0.74 × (310 4 – 308 ) Key points ᔢ Thermal from a radiation region of The rate at the high electromagnetic ᔢ is process by temperature which to a thermal region of energy low is transferred temperature by waves. which thermal energy flows by radiation depends on temperature. ᔢ When a body thermal ᔢ Good ᔢ A black body Stefan’s body in is is thermal back absorbers theoretical ᔢ is energy are a also perfect good with between emitters absorber of another body, there is a flow of them. of thermal thermal energy. energy. The concept is a one. law states that proportional expressed equilibrium and forth in to the rate at the fourth which power energy of the is radiated from temperature of a the black body kelvin. 157 18.4 Global warming thermal Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this energy The section, you greenhouse Energy from explain the greenhouse discuss applications transfer of thermal conduction, radiation. of This Sun and effect reaches the radiation. heats causes wavelength the energy convection of up the Earth The in the radiation Earth. This form of passes light easily temperature of and short through the the Earth effect rises. ᔢ the infrared atmosphere ᔢ applications transfer wavelength to: and by and the Sun. Sun.) of infrared the fuels warming ᔢ is produces significantly infrared dioxide of Earth Earth from the known of the to as emitting the is the rise is the The further . carbon war ming . The The term of the wavelength of causes the heating burning This from that energy process gas. The coming than longer trapped effect . long that the This dioxide radiation. lower prevents greenhouse of than much Earth. even infrared longer Earth atmosphere volumes global start leaving Earth large to in to radiation temperature radiation temperature up this (The Carbon the of fossil contributes consequences of global are: melting of Caribbean ᔢ climate ᔢ extinction the is polar very ice caps prone to resulting rising sea in increasing sea levels. The levels changes of plant and animal Applications of thermal life forms. energy transfer The vacuum flask The is vacuum designed out of the between flask. the convection. radiation the heat flask such The walls. The by it hot is flask The glass entering loss keeps that is a the conduction hot for and cold thermal double-walled vacuum walls from liquids difficult are eliminates silvered. outside (Figure of the glass heat The liquids energy loss The 18.4.1). cork stopper silvered walls contents vacuum plastic Figure 18.4.1 158 A vacuum flask by container cold. travel vessel silvered flask. to with The flask into a conduction surfaces cork or vacuum and reduce stopper reduces Chapter The solar Solar in water homes box and copper The an the which insulated box the copper later is Solar pipes heats tank. with either effect). The warms conductor) warm glass are water the in is or infrared trapped, up in an energy transfer box, plastic is a surface an it, the good the 18.4.2). up escape inside of absorber because water insulated are heats cannot and use surface. and up for there (Figure glass radiation with water insulated blackened surface contact heat of warming black stored a through blackened to insulated with enters gets used consists the contact wavelength and are heater Inside radiation plastic The suggests, water thermal covered radiation (good up. storage Longer or name solar infrared box. glass the The make (greenhouse radiation. them box wavelength through as hotels. insulated pipes, Thermal heater heaters, and insulated Short the water 18 of the inside storage tank for use. sunlight pressure storage resistant outlet tank inlet absorber glass or plate plastic (black coated) electric sheet thermally heat support (roof ) Figure 18.4.2 exchanger contact with (pipe the in insulated booster box thermal absorber plate) A solar water heater Key points ᔢ Short wavelength ᔢ The Earth absorbs ᔢ The Earth then cannot dioxide the heat ᔢ The temperature ᔢ The more warming some carbon takes to of radiation of re-radiates penetrate cause infrared this easily enters the atmosphere. energy. longer wavelength infrared atmosphere. Greenhouse be the gases radiation, such as which carbon trapped. Earth dioxide is rises and pumped this into is the called global atmosphere, warming. the more global place. 159 Revision Answers found 1 to on questions the Copper that require questions calculation can be 9 7 accompanying CD. and glass conductivities. mechanisms have used to this thermal difference transfer in thermal 8 terms energy of in the State Explain Write the thermal glass. what what rod of length 0.8 m and cross-sectional the [6] linear heat flow symbols by conduction mean. [3] is meant by thermal radiation. [2] an equation for Stefan’s –5 law of black body area radiation × to find [4] copper 6.0 of the formula for explaining 9 A experiment each material. 2 an conductivity different Explain Describe and explain what each term means in the 2 10 m is arranged such that it is completely equation. lagged on 100 °C and Calculate through the sides. One the the the other rate end 3 An = copper rod. 390 W m ideally bar 12 cm lagged long 26 cm and of copper the end the and of the of K aluminium thermal (Thermal at an bar consists aluminium is the at a of its the sphere of radius 6 cm surroundings. Calculate sphere if it absorbs is the 40 kW of in equilibrium temperature power from the conductivity copper 120 °C at which and = conductivity of aluminium a Explain b What c 0 °C. Calculate the are is the meant by global consequences of warming. global [3] warming? Suggest three ways we can help reduce global warming. [3] copper 390 W m = what [3] the free [3] copper 11 [3] end joined. of surroundings. length area. The free maintained point are at of bar 12 –1 K 220 W m An electric iron is coils. The electric electrical power opened iron is to expose switched the on bare and a heating constant , –1 thermal blackened of of –1 (Thermal A with [2] maintained bars 10 10 °C. energy conductivity cross-sectional is at [4] at ) to aluminium temperature maintained maintained of compound equal is –1 joined bar is of flow –1 copper end –1 K is supplied to it. The coils glow red ) hot. Sketch a graph to show the variation of temperature a along the compound bar. One of from 4 Explain 5 When how land and the ways by which thermal energy is lost [3] sea breezes are formed. the other [6] heating two coil methods is by by convection. which thermal Name energy the is lost. determining the thermal conductivities b copper and glass, the choice of dimension used Explain different. State what dimensions are used [4] 13 Describe heater Describe an experiment to find the 160 of copper in the form the air heating is blown coil over glows less brightly it. [2] the and principal features explain the design of in a solar terms water of thermal thermal energy conductivity some and why. 6 why is when very [2] of of a cylinder. [6] transfer. [5] Revision questions 9 161 19 Phases 19. 1 A of kinetic Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this matter model for solids, liquids and gases Density section, you The density Density to: is of a substance defined as the gives mass an per idea unit of how concentrated volume. The symbol matter used is. to –3 represent ᔢ define ᔢ relate the term density is ρ (rho). The SI unit Definition the difference structures and of density is kg m density in Equation the densities of solids, m Density is defined as the mass per ρ liquids and gases to simple = ideas V unit of the spacing, ordering volume. and –3 ρ motion of – density/kg m molecules m – mass/kg V – volume/m 3 ᔢ describe for ᔢ a solids, describe simple liquids an the appreciate by the of such model gases Brownian movement provided and experiment demonstrate and kinetic to motion evidence for The and distinguish an between crystalline and therefore of by a the substance density of is defined water . as the Relative density density of has the no units dimensionless. experiment the kinetic model for solids, liquids and gases structure A of is density divided molecules A ᔢ relative substance kinetic model may be used to explain the properties of solids, liquids non-crystalline and gases. Matter is thought to be made up of many tiny particles. These solids. particles particle tend can to attract refer to solids, each atoms, matter are liquids typical arrangement of other . ions and the or They also molecules. gases. particles Figures that tend to The three 19.1.1 make up move (a), a about. common (b) solid, and (c) liquid The term states show and a of the gas. Equation Solids Relative density density of substance In a solid, the particles are held closely together by strong forces of = attraction. density of The spacing between the particles is therefore very small. The water particles to move are arranged about positions. As a within result in an the of orderly solid. this, manner . Instead, solids have The they particles vibrate fixed are about shapes and not their free fixed volumes. Liquids In a that in spacing ordering of very small well arrangement about their fixed Figure 19.1.1 (a) 162 a free to vibrate positions Structure of a solid the solid. solid. ordering of particles of spacing ordered particles motion of a liquid, force The There very is of attraction separation less ordering small well about Figure 19.1.1 (b) a liquid particles particles than arrangement ordering in free to vibrate positions Structure of a liquid motion of at high is a very is weaker slightly solid. than more The than particles large particles distributed; particles their fixed in the the spacing ordered particles motion of between between there is randomly no particles order moving randomly speeds Figure 19.1.1 (c) Structure of a gas Chapter are able take to the move shape throughout of the the container body they of are the in liquid. and As their a result, volumes 19 Phases of liquids are fixed. Gases In a microscope gas, solid with matter or the particles liquid. each particles The other are and far are far apart particles the apart walls from from move of each each about the other container other , when randomly the at holding force of compared high the speeds, gas. attraction with a colliding Since the between them light is negligible. As a result, a gas fills up any space that is available. smoke cell Brownian The motion apparatus used to demonstrate Brownian motion is shown in Figure Figure 19.1.2 19.1.2. The It cell using a is called of a small illuminated microscope. particles around consists are seen as the side The specks. is containing the smoke adjusted The haphazard cell and microscope bright haphazardly. Brownian from The transparent bright motion so particles that specks of the some the are are observed a smoke seen smoke Brownian motion smoke. regular atoms moving particles array throughout is of extending the lattice motion atoms Explanation – The movement of the smoke particles is due to air Figure 19.1.3 molecules bombarding them from all sides. The haphazard motion The structure of a of crystalline solid the smoke rapidly in particles all suggests that the air molecules are moving around directions. a If larger smoke haphazardly particles because are the used, the bright randomness of the specks are collisions seen moving averages monomer out. Figure 19.1.4 Brownian motion provides evidence for the kinetic model of polymer chain less units A polymer chain matter . Key points Structure of crystalline and non-crystalline solids ᔢ In a crystalline regular pattern crystalline shows a solid , that solid simple is the atoms, repeats quartz. structure ions itself within Metals of a or are molecules the also crystalline are crystal. An crystalline arranged example solids. in of Figure Density is per volume. unit an amorphous throughout an the amorphous substances. solid, there structure. material The atoms is in is There glass. this a ᔢ solid. random Relative the is no definite Glass case arrangement are is a pattern. mixture arranged to of of the An form an the mass density density of of a is the ratio substance water. It has no of to the units. atoms example silica as a 19.1.3 density In defined a and of ᔢ other A kinetic explain amorphous liquids model the and can be properties used of to solids, gases. structure. ᔢ Polymers units consist that (Figure repeat of long chains themselves. of Each molecules. repeating Each unit chain is called consists a that of random monomer ᔢ the be can be coiled polymer 19.1.6 motion molecules demonstrates are in continuous motion. 19.1.4). Polymers may Brownian up is below semi-crystalline or tangled. The semi-crystalline show the or amount or difference amorphous. of tangling amorphous. between The the Figure two long polymer determines 19.1.5 and in whether Figure structures. In a ions chain ᔢ a crystalline or regular within In amorphous an random atoms the the are pattern itself a ᔢ solid, molecules atoms, arranged that repeats crystal solid, there arrangement throughout the of is the structure. Polymers consist of long chains of molecules. Each chain consists of units that repeat themselves. Each repeating unit is called a monomer. ᔢ Polymers or Figure 19.1.5 A semi-crystalline polymer Figure 19.1.6 can be semi-crystalline amorphous. An amorphous polymer 163 19.2 Pressure Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this Pressure section, you The per to: pressure unit area acting on on the a surface surface. is The defined SI unit of as the force pressure is exerted the normally pascal (Pa). –2 From ᔢ define pressure ᔢ derive an A expression for the block definition of in of follows mass 2 kg that 1 Pa rests on = a 1 N m table as shown in Figure 19.2.1. the Calculate pressure wood it the pressure exerted on the surface of the table. a fluid –1 [Use ᔢ recall the various g = to measure ] instruments Area used 9.81 N kg in contact with the surface of the table = l × b pressure. –2 = 5 × = 0.004 m –2 10 × 8 × 10 2 Definition Force Pressure is defined as exerted on table = mg the force = acting normally per unit 2 × 9.81 = 19.62 N area. force 19.62 3 ∴ pressure = = = area 4.91 × 10 Pa 0.004 Equation Pressure F p in a fluid = A A fluid p – pressure/Pa fluids. F – force/N called A – area/m is a substance Above the that Earth’s has the surface, ability there to is a flow . thick Liquids layer of and gas. gases This are layer is 5 the atmosphere. The atmosphere exerts a pressure of 1.01 × 10 Pa on 2 the Earth’s felt by This us. surface. This prevents atmosphere. of a lake. In is though because our The this Even bodies the pressure insides from pressure case the this becomes diver of our collapsing is seems body under more large, exert the on a is usually outward pressure significant experiencing an it atmospheric pressure. exerted diver at not by the pressure the bottom as well 5.5 cm as the In 5 cm a acts pressure fluid, exerted pressure equally in all by the water increases with in the lake depth. At above a him. particular depth, pressure directions. 8 cm In Figure 19.2.2, a container is filled with a liquid. The pressure in the Figure 19.2.1 liquid is at same the point D greatest is Consider A B C depth deeper a the in than area bottom the container cross-sectional h at liquid A, of of of B and and height the the C, h, base of container . are therefore and is filled the The at therefore with a the at fluid container is points same a of A A, B C pressure. higher are The pressure. density (Figure and ρ. The 19.2.3). pressure increases V olume Mass D of of W eight fluid fluid of fluid in the container = density = mass of × = cross-sectional volume fluid × = area × height = Ah ρAh gravitational field strength = ρAhg liquid Therefore, the force exerted on A = ρAhg Figure 19.2.2 force Pressure exerted on the surface A = ρAhg = = area It follows by a that vertical the difference distance Δh in a in pressure fluid of Δp, density between ρ ρgh A is two given by points ρgΔh. separated The h A expression indicates area base. of the derivation Figure 19.2.3 164 the that This same the simply pressure means expression at that would any if have a depth is cylinder been independent was used obtained. in of the the Chapter Example A diver the is 10 m diver at below this of matter the surface of a lake. Calculate the pressure exerted of water = ρgΔh depth. 3 [Density Phases Equation Δp on 19 = 1 × –3 10 kg m Δp 5 , atmospheric pressure = 1 × 10 – difference – density in pressure/Pa g – gravitational field strength/N kg Δh – difference Pa, –3 –1 g = 9.81 N kg ρ ] of fluid/kg m –1 Pressure due to water = ρgh 3 = T otal pressure acting on 1 × in height/m 4 10 × 9.81 × 10 = 9.81 × 10 Pa to diver gas at a open particular = pressure due to atmosphere + pressure due to = 1 × 5 10 × 9.81 × the water pressure 5 to atmosphere p 5 10 = 1.981 × 10 Pa A Instruments used to measure pressure h The U-tube This device density ρ. manometer consists Mercury of is a U-shaped commonly tube used. containing The U-tube a liquid of known manometer can B be used to measure connected to the the pressure container of a holding gas. the One gas. end The of the other tube end is is open to the liquid atmosphere. The pressure at the point A is atmospheric pressure P . at The A density pressure at height plus gas is h the point B is the atmospheric actually the same pressure pressure as the exerted (Figure pressure at by the 19.2.4). the liquid The point column pressure of of the Figure 19.2.4 A U-tube manometer B. curved The pressure of the gas is given by p = p + metal tube ρgh A The Bourdon The at Bourdon one end, the gauge, the pointer (Figure The gauge gauge which the to consists is of a connected pressure move. causes The curved to a the scale is metal pointer . tube to tube. When The a straighten calibrated to gas out measure tube is is closed connected slightly pressure to causing directly 19.2.5). barometer A barometer is inverted measure consists in a tray, of a also atmospheric long glass containing pressure. tube partially mercury. Depending on The the filled with barometer mercury. is atmospheric used It to pressure Figure 19.2.5 the height (Figure of the 19.2.6). mercury The in the glass atmospheric tube pressure will is either given increase being measured pressure, or A Bourdon gauge decrease by vacuum p = ρgh A where ρ is the density h is the height of of mercury, mercury in g is the the gravitational field strength, column long glass tube Key points h mercury ᔢ Pressure is defined as the force acting normally per unit p area. A ᔢ The pressure in a fluid depends on depth, gravitational field strength and density. ᔢ Pressure Bourdon can be measured using U-tube manometer, barometer or a gauge. Figure 19.2.6 A barometer 165 ρ 19.3 Hooke’s law Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this Hooke’s section, you A spring the to: by ᔢ understand the and terms is shape and state stretching, law and define the tensile length define by by making spring, the a coil from a piece a force is required. applied force is called pressing, the terms stress, strain force is 19.3.1). constant using ᔢ the a If of the metal. spring tensile force. In is If order to change lengthened the applied force is called a the spring compressive is force. When compressive force Hooke’s spring made tensile a ᔢ modulus law of shortened force the Young a is called A an mass metre applied to a spring extension. is attached rule. A to Suppose its spring it and length is attached the additional increases. to extension masses are a The rigid increase support produced attached is to in (Figure measured the spring and and the extension produced in each case is measured. Young modulus The data Force is obtained the Extension and rigid is can be manipulated is the therefore variable plotted used to variable being on plot a and is graph measured the y-axis. of extension therefore as a Figure plotted result 19.3.2 of a against on the change shows a force. x-axis. in force typical graph support that is obtained by stretching a spring. extension spring metre rule A mass O Figure 19.3.2 From O Figure 19.3.1 Demonstrating Hooke’s law the and can be Graphical representation of Hooke’s law graph A. force In you this expressed can region, seen the that mathematically F there extension = is is a straight line proportional to portion the between force. This as ke Exam tip The term k, in the expression is called the spring constant. It is defined –1 Sometimes pay on close a F against attention question e to is plotted. the axes as the force per In the region unit extension. Its unit is N m . So given OA, the spring is said to obey Hooke’s law. paper. Definition Hooke’s law extension to elastic Stress, F Consider states that produced the force the Definition limit is The proportional provided not strain a is applied, the the force constant acting per k is defined unit as extension. that exceeded. and the Young cylindrical spring piece of material modulus of length l, having a cross- A sectional (Figure l area of 19.3.3). material. The A. Suppose This stress force is exerted a force called on F a the is applied tensile on force material is one end because the force of it is the material stretching acting normally the per –2 Figure 19.3.3 166 Defining tensile stress unit cross-sectional area. The SI unit for stress is the pascal (Pa) or N m Chapter Definition 19 Phases of matter Equation F Stress is defined as the force acting stress = A per unit cross-sectional area. F – force/N A – cross-sectional 2 area/m –2 Unit Suppose (Figure the force 19.3.4). F The causes the strain material exerted on to the of stress produce /Pa an material is or N m extension the ratio e of the A extension units produced because it is to a the ratio original of length of the material. Strain has F no lengths. e l Definition Equation Figure 19.3.4 Defining tensile strain e Strain is defined as the ratio of the strain = l extension the to the original length of material. e – extension/m l – original Strain no Another quantity of importance is the is a length/m ratio of lengths and has units Y oung modulus . This is the Equation ratio of the tensile stress to the tensile strain. The SI unit for the Y oung –2 modulus is also the pascal (Pa) or tensile N m Young modulus (E) tensile Example A metal strain –2 E – Young wire of length 2.0 m is clamped vertically. A load is attached to –7 it stress = extends 0.56 mm. The cross-sectional area of the wire is 1.1 × 10 modulus /Pa or N m and 2 m Calculate i the strain ii the force in the applied wire to the wire. 11 [Y oung modulus of wire = 2.0 ×10 Pa] –3 e 0.56 × 10 –4 i Strain = = = l F/A ii E = 2.8 × 10 2.0 Fl = e/l Ae EAe 11 F = = EA × strain = (2 × 10 = 6.16 N –7 × 1.1 × 10 ) –4 × 2.8 × 10 l Key points ᔢ Hooke’s law applied, provided spring states that that constant k the the is extension elastic ᔢ The defined ᔢ Stress is defined as the force ᔢ Strain is defined as the ratio limit as the is not the force acting of produced per unit is proportional to the force exceeded. acting per unit cross-sectional extension to the original extension. area. length of the material. ᔢ The Young modulus is the ratio of the tensile stress to the tensile strain. 167 19.4 Experiment to determine the Young Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this Experiment to section, you The a to: to ᔢ describe an experiment Y oung length a of piece the Young modulus of metal in the form of wire of a wire. can material The be like copper extension very small. can produced In order to be determined when a produce load is by using applied a this experiment, a piece of wire having a measurable length metre is of at least used. wire. In a this rigid wire experiment support, and mass the support the to because supporting (Figure adjacent other attached needed, is used the it 19.4.1), to end each as to the test keep compensates two other . the for pieces One wire. wire of wire The wire is are used attached as reference vertical. temperature The a wire has reference changes to reference and a wire sagging is of beam. beam The diameter gauge. test in of one a modulus copper E to extensions determine measure modulus of Several the test wire, measurements d, is are measured taken at using different a micrometre positions on screw the wire wire and the average value is determined. This reduces the random error in reference the value of d wire The original measuring vernier scale A load wire The fixed mass is and length first the This extension is ᔢ The test wire using is a l, is measured balance. measured is repeated several also repeated when can be Measurements load the measured experiment experiment wire. of using a metre rule or tape. used to original be to It using is a times, if using the attached V ernier unloading determine then masses elastic the test scale. increasing the to limit loads. from was the The test exceeded. taken: length of the wire l is measured using a metre rule or tape. Figure 19.4.1 Experiment to determine ᔢ The diameter of the wire d is measured using a micrometre the Young modulus of a metal gauge. ᔢ The mass of the ᔢ The extension each of the load wire is is measured measured Determination of the Young The results Original of the experiment length Diameter of of can wire wire using using a a balance. vernier scale. modulus be represented = l m = d m = π 2 as follows: 2 d πd 2 Cross-sectional The 168 results can be area of entered wire in a table ( 2 ) such = m 4 as the following. screw a Chapter 19 Phases of matter Table 19.4.1 m/kg F = mg/N Extension/m (loading) Extension/m (unloading) 1 2 3 4 5 6 A graph results of in force the against extension is plotted (Figure 19.4.2) using the table. force /N extension /m Figure 19.4.2 The Plot a graph of force against extension gradient of the linear region of stress Y oung modulus the F = graph e = determined. Fl ÷ strain is = A l eA F The gradient of the graph is e l Therefore, the Y oung modulus = gradient × A force/N Example Figure 19.4.3 length 2.0 m shows the results of an experiment using a metal wire with 42 and diameter 1.1 mm. 2 area of wire = π ( 1.1 ) = π × ) 2 –7 9.5 10 ( 2 = 2 –3 d Cross-sectional × 10 2 m 42 4 Gradient of straight line = = 7.0 × 10 –1 N m –3 0.6 × 10 0 0.6 extension /mm l Y oung modulus = gradient of straight line × Figure 19.4.3 A 2.0 4 = 7.0 × 10 11 × = 1.47 × 10 Pa –7 9.5 × 10 169 19.5 Elastic and Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this distinguish brittle and section, you Ductile recall the between example ductile, polymeric materials stress–strain ductile, materials ductile brittle and material of a is can ductile force-extension obeyed. easily material graph The be for point a is stretched copper . ductile A is and Figure material. called formed the 19.5.1 In limit the of into a wire. shows region a An typical OA, Hooke’s proportionality. Beyond graphs this for graphs to: law ᔢ deformation Force–extension A ᔢ plastic point Hooke’s law is not obeyed and the graph is no longer linear . polymeric The point B is called the elastic limit. This is the maximum load which materials a ᔢ understand the terms proportionality, the limit of elastic limit body and the ᔢ distinguish between elastic a is experience removed. point point C is is material and still When reached called breaks. regain the force where the The yield in there is point. graph also its original size increased a marked The point illustrates and shape, beyond the increase in D the is the elastic extension. point regions once at which where there and is plastic load limit, The yield point can elastic defor mation (O to B) and plastic defor mation (B to D). In the deformation. elastic force region, is the removed. original shape material In and the size returns plastic when to its region, the original the force is shape material and does size not when return to the its removed. Definition force /N Elastic deformation returns to its – original the material shape and size C B when the external force is D removed. A Definition Plastic does deformation not return to – its the material original shape O and size when removed from the external force is extension /m it. elastic plastic deformation Figure 19.5.1 material deformation Force–extension graphs for ductile materials – metal (copper) breaks force /N at this point Brittle Glass materials and extension gradient is only cast iron graph (Figure an material for good brittle 19.5.2). elastic will are There region. return to examples materials This its is no a brittle that shape materials. straight plastic means original of is line region once and the with on the force The a force– steep graph. is There removed, the size. extension /m Figure 19.5.2 Force–extension graphs for Polymeric materials An of brittle materials – (glass and cast iron) is example usually Hooke’s force /N a polymeric non-linear law. A small Stress–strain Strain–strain show extension /m Figure 19.5.3 Force–extension graphs for polymeric materials – (rubber and elastic) 170 the polymeric not return has been its are produces similar applying materials. to force is 19.5.3). rubber . This a The means large force–extension that it does not graph obey extension. graphs graphs effects material (Figure In the original permanently and to force–extension removing case length of the when deformed. loads on ductile the load graphs. ductile, material, is Figures brittle the removed. 19.5.4–6 and material The does material Chapter In the case of the brittle material, the material will return to its 19 Phases of matter original Definition shape In and the shape size case and unloading of unit the the size. The ultimate polymeric It should process, hysteresis. per if volume. pointed is lost between The stress material, be energy area tensile as the rubber the out exceeded. gets returns during The curves actually not material that heat. two is effect the is in its known represents warmer to loading the the as ultimate maximum It maximum lost tensile stress withstand. elastic energy is a stress shown point is material on a as the can the stress–strain curve. process. breaking stress /Pa The original and point stress /Pa stress /Pa loading loading unloading unloading strain Figure 19.5.4 Strain Figure that strain strain A ductile material Figure 19.5.5 A brittle material Figure 19.5.6 A polymeric material energy 19.5.7 obeys shows Hooke’s how law. the The extension work varies done for with an force for extension of a e material is given force /N by 1 the shaded area. The area of the triangle is × base × F height. 2 1 ∴ work done = Fe 2 Since as work strain is being done on the material, energy is stored in the material energy. 1 ∴ strain energy = Fe 2 e extension /m Example A thin strain steel suspended of the wire from wire. the the extension ii the energy an of length ceiling. A 1.2 m mass of and diameter 4.0 kg is 0.6 mm attached to produced stored assumption in in the you the steel modulus F/A i E = lower energy Strain energy end wire. made in your calculation. for steel = 2.0 ×10 –1 Pa, g = 9.81 N kg Key points ] Fl ᔢ Elastic deformation – the = e/l Force Figure 19.5.7 wire 11 [Y oung the is Calculate: i State initially exerted Ae on material wire = 4.0 × shape 9.81 N force 2 0.6 × and is size to its when original the removed from external it. 2 –3 d returns 10 2 Cross-sectional area of wire = π ( 2 ) = π ( ) 2 m ᔢ Plastic deformation material F/A (4.0 × does not – the return to its 9.81)(1.2) –4 E = = = e/l × × 10 original m ( and size when the 10 11 π shape 2 –3 0.6 8.3 ) 2 (2.0 × 10 external force ) ᔢ 1 When a is removed from material is it. stretched, 1 4 ii Energy stored in the wire = Fe = 2 × (4.0 × 9.81) × (8.3 × 10 ) external work is done on the 2 material. The energy stored in –2 = In the calculations, it is assumed that 1.63 Hooke’s × 10 law is J obeyed. the material is stored as strain energy. 171 Revision Answers found 1 to on a questions the that require questions calculation can 10 Calculate: be accompanying CD. Distinguish between the structure of i the spring ii the work constant done in [2] compressing the spring by crystalline 35 mm. and non-crystalline solids. 7 Give b an example Describe the example 2 a Explain b Describe of of each. structure a what of commonly is meant you a polymer. Give used by would a Explain what one polymer. Brownian [3] motion. by the terms: demonstrate i stress [1] ii strain [1] iii Young modulus. [1] Some bridges are designed such that many cables, Brownian made of high-tensile steel, are used to support the [3] roadway. A Interpret the results of such an experiment. [2] 8.0 cable Distinguish between a solid and a liquid by particular –3 of 3 meant [2] motion. c is [2] 8 how [2] [2] × is cable has a cross-sectional area 2 10 m and length 40 m. The tension in this 650 kN. reference 11 to the spacing, ordering and motion of the [Young particles. [3] 4 a b Define the Derive an term pressure expression for and the state its SI pressure unit. modulus exerted by b A the Young modulus of a i the extension ii the strain 9 a Describe, material. can steel wire initially of length 1.4 m mass 0.5 mm of 3.5 kg is is suspended attached to from the the 10 Pa] the cable stored in [5] the cable. [2] the to aid of a measure diagram, the the Young apparatus modulus of a of Describe copper the wire. method [4] used to determine the ceiling. lower end measurements. [4] of c the of energy with used required A × and b diameter 2.8 [2] length thin = Calculate: that Define steel a [4] a the [2] fluid. 5 of Describe how the measurements taken can be wire. used to determine the Young modulus. [4] Calculate i the extension ii the energy State an produced stored in the assumption you in the steel wire [3] wire. made 10 [2] in your a Define b Distinguish calculation. the terms stress between and elastic strain. and [2] plastic deformation. [2] 11 [Young modulus for steel = 2.0 × 10 Pa, 11 –1 g 6 = 9.81 N kg a State Hooke’s b Explain what law. is [2] mean by the term spring constan t. c A spring is Give [1] compressed variation example by applying a force to for each a a b a polymeric c a ductile of this force F with and sketch a force–extension graph the following: brittle compression x material [2] material [2] material. [2] each material, use the terms plastic and elastic to is describe shown of it. For The an ] their behaviour as indicated by the graphs. below. [6] force /N 12 Give an example of each of these materials. 120 80 For 40 a ductile ii a brittle iii a polymeric each strain 0 10 20 30 40 compression/mm 172 i of material material these graph. [1] [1] material. materials, sketch [1] a possible stress– [3] Revision questions 13 Define the following a limit b elastic of c yield terms: 15 proportionality [1] limit A and light steel rigid wire bar as is suspended shown horizontally by a 10 brass below. [1] point. [1] 10 14 Aluminium A piece to A a of rigid load of has a Young aluminium wire support. The 30 N is modulus of length diameter attached to of of 7 . 1 × 10 1.5 m the the free Pa. is wire attached is brass 1.5 mm. steel end. Calculate: a the stress b the extension on the c the strain wire [2] produced energy stored [2] in the wire. [2] 12 kg The length 12 kg is of each attached wire to the is 2.2 m. When bar, it remains a mass of horizontal. 11 [Young modulus of brass = 1.0 × 10 Pa 11 Young modulus a Calculate b Given of the that steel tension the the is 6.0 brass × 2.0 in × each 10 10 Pa] wire. cross-sectional –7 wire = [2] area of the brass 2 m , calculate the extension of wire. c Calculate d Determine the [3] energy the stored diameter of in the the brass steel wire wire. [2] [3] 173 Module Answers to the selected structured 3 Practice multiple-choice questions questions can and be found exam to on questions 6 the Which of evaporation accompanying CD. a the following and Boiling boiling occurs of at statements is true about the water? any temperature evaporation occurs 100 °C Evaporation occurs at and Multiple-choice questions b boiling 1 Which of the following thermometers can be measure the temperature at various positions of produced by a Bunsen A platinum-resistance The A thermocouple c A mercury-in-glass external and pressure. rate of evaporation changes in the and surface boiling are unaffected area of the water. Evaporation and boiling occur only at the surface thermometer of b temperature the burner? d a any on a by flame dependent used c to is the water. 3 7 thermometer What is the pressure of a gas of density 0. 12 kg m –1 d A constant-volume gas and thermometer root mean square velocity of 1200 m s ? 4 a 2 Which of the following is not an assumption of a theory The size of compared b of The force the molecules volume is negligible occupied attraction by between the the 8 when 144 Pa The first ΔU gas. molecules = is change 3 The collisions d The duration A car to is has rest a by is and –1 a 10 Pa 2.5 × 10 can be Pa into thermodynamics ΔW. When there law is of no a gas change undergoes in expressed an temperature thermodynamics for an as isothermal of the gas. isothermal is inelastic. a the + of collision time of thermal mass of their average 60% energy the the in brake specific car is brought kinetic the 9 ΔU c – ΔQ = ΔW energy brakes is is ΔW the wire from of capacity = A force–extension What components heat a b ΔU d ΔQ = ΔQ when collisions. 55 kJ. The brake. total negligible between energy the is graph amount extension a 0.004 J b 0.001 J c 0.009 J d 0.005 J of of wire work 2 mm is done to = ΔW shown in – ΔU below. stretching the 3 mm? –1 510 J kg the of applying car. The 25 kg are kinetic converted the d law ΔQ change, negligible. to × 5 The first c compared 5.76 gases? the of b the c kinetic 48 Pa K brake . What is the increase in temperature of components? 4.3 °C b 0.004 °C c 2.6 °C d 0.23 °C F /N 4 An insulated of two composite metals P and Q. rod of P length and Q 80 cm are of the consists same 30 lengths. The thermal –1 400 W m of P is at K a –1 and 300 W m a temperature of 12 ° C. What and Q conductivities of –1 are P and Q are –1 K respectively. One 90 °C is the temperature and one at the end end of Q is point where 20 at P e /mm 2 joined? 62 °C b 57 °C c 48 °C d 51 °C 10 5 According to Stefan’s law, the rate at which The length l of transferred from a black body is given by a material X is measured when energy various forces is 3 F are applied to it. The graph below which shows the results of this investigation. Which of the equation? following is false? 2 a P = σAT c P = σAT b P = σAT d P = σTA 4 a The b The force material c The ultimate d The work Hooke’s law up to 30 N. –1 1.22 m 174 obeys 4 to constant of tensile done in 1.24 m the material stress is stretching is 0.65 J at is 750 N m 35 N. the material from Module 13 F /N a b Explain what is specific heat ii specific latent an Practice meant i Describe 3 by questions the following: capacity heat exam of copper of fusion experimental of method [2] ice. to [2] measure 35 the specific heat capacity of a liquid. [6] 33 30 c A kettle water is at rated 25 °C switched on at is 2.0 kW. A poured and mass of into it takes a 800 g of kettle. The kettle is 2.3 minutes for the water 15 to start boiling. The 8.6 minutes for the half kettle is left on and it takes mass of water to decrease its original value. Use the data to by calculate: l /m 1.20 1.24 1.22 i the specific heat capacity ii the specific latent heat of water [3] of vaporisation of water. iii [2] State one assumption used in your calculations. Structured questions [1] 11 a Explain what b Explain how c is a meant by physical temperature. property which varies with measure temperature Describe the the resistance temperature of a of a may [1] substance be used of a a State four b Explain i to substance. principal features 14 ii platinum- thermometer. Discuss the advantages and disadvantages of the a [4] iii d the the following air inner [2] inside a in-glass same e A a thermometer temperature student using a which measures the be a the used temperature of in a b the temperatures do not exerts kinetic a has air [4] theory: pressure on the [4] been inside the tyre increases after driven pressure [3] decreases the when some air tyre. Three molecules have [2] speeds v, 2v and 4v. Calculate: liquid thermometer thermometer. The the theory. mercury- [4] platinum-resistance that may and kinetic a range. mercury-in-glass notices thermometer the using tyre pressure escapes from platinum-resistance of walls air car the assumptions and i the mean ii the root square speed mean square gas heated of the speed molecules of the [2] molecules. [2] student c agree. They 2.4 mol of a is at a constant pressure 5 do, however, temperature Explain why agree of when steam this is used above to measure pure boiling of the × 10 Pa. The increases from water. so. 4.0 Molar [3] heat temperature 250 K capacity to of –1 pressure 12 a b Explain what is i Conduction iii Radiation. Explain what meant by ii meant Convection by thermal c state Describe energy i a its SI and transfer metal unit. state in State and the i the amount ii the change iii the work a Explain mechanism for thermal i used to at constant of energy in volume done by the supplied of the to the gas gas [2] [2] gas. [2] what is meant by: i tensile stress [1] ii tensile strain [1] iii Young thermal ii a ceramic cup. the choice of dimensions experimentally conductivity a good conductor determine modulus. [1] [6] Sketch stress–strain graphs for the following and the give material gas .Calculate the following: spoon explain the –1 K [3] b d gas conductivity 15 and 29 J mol the the following: [6] is is of 300 K. an example of each type. the i A brittle ii A ductile material iii A polymeric [2] of: ii a poor conductor. material [2] [4] material [2] 175 20 Analysis 20. 1 Analysis Learning outcomes On completion should be able of this and interpretation and interpretation Plotting section, you In experimental One to: way of unknown ᔢ draw straight line graphs determine data data is is often by collected. drawing a This data suitable must graph to be analysed. determine constants. following guidelines should be used when drawing graphs. data ᔢ ᔢ work, analysing using The experimental graphs gradients Choose a scale that is suitable (e.g. 1 cm to 5 units, 1 cm to 10 units). and Do not use scales such as 1 cm to 3 units. intercepts ᔢ ᔢ rearrange equations to obtain The at straight scale should be chosen such that the points being plotted occupy a least half the graph paper . line form. ᔢ The and x- and the ᔢ The graph ᔢ A or ᔢ If × the data either If be should be between T wo an one usually the mx + c of are to is called general the line to m. be It linear a are quantities being plotted title. the points relationship, equal being a numbers non-linear the data when the line of plotted. of data relationship, points. Do changed is other a at usually y-axis. of plotting not on graph time. variable. only quantities straight a plotting Since intercept a relationship responding the The appropriate represent a the temperature/°C). best fit points on a use smooth a curve straight line points. the equation is follow required all an there through can on with height/m, to follow that labelled line. variable. plotted used investigate quantity experiment, The = the drawn quantities quantity y of be T/s, given be to adjacent manipulated be so appear experiment only y-axis appear data d/cm, should drawn side the should (e.g. should a should ᔢ y-axes units are line the is This on y = y-axis as c. is is + c. called The In the second variable being constant Consider y-axis). quantities, The responding mx is x-axis. quantity known and two quantity the The one ( x-axis between is changed in variables. gradient Figure or slope 20.1.1. y 2 B(x ,y 2 ) A and B lie on the straight line. The coordinates of A and B are ( x 2 , y 1 and (x , y 2 y ) respectively. The gradient of the line passing through A ) 1 and B 2 1 A(x ,y 1 is ) given by: 1 (0,c) y – y – x 2 Gradient (slope) 1 = x 2 1 Example x-axis x 1 x 2 A system is oscillation Figure 20.1.1 oscillating T is with dependent simple on the harmonic length of motion. the The oscillator x. period It is of known A straight-line graph that T and x are related by the following equation: –b T The of following the case. 176 table oscillator It is is required shows varied that the and the = Ax results the of period constants A an of experiment oscillation and b be where is the measured determined. x/m 0.40 0.50 0.60 0.70 0.80 0.90 T/s 2.85 2.32 2. 15 2.01 2.01 1.90 length in each Chapter The equation has to be rearranged such that a linear form is 20 Analysis and interpretation obtained. b T T aking log on both sides of = Ax the equation: 10 b lg T = lg (Ax ) lg T = lg A + lg (x lg T = lg A – b A straight line graph The gradient The y-intercept lg T and lg x of the is are would line is be ) b lg x obtained if lg T is plotted against lg x – b lg A determined as shown in the following table. x/m 0.40 0.50 0.60 0.70 0.80 T/s 2.85 2.32 2. 15 2.01 2.01 1.90 –0.397 –0.301 –0.097 –0.046 lg (x/m) lg (T/s) A line The In 0.455 of best graph order of to fit lg find 0.407 is T –0.222 –0. 155 0.365 0.332 0.90 0.303 0.279 drawn. against the lg x gradient is of shown the in line, Figure two 20.1.2. points A and log (T / s) B are chosen 0.5 on the line. These points are not one of the experimental data points and A should be sufficiently far apart to produce a large right-angled triangle. 0.4 A B – – (– 0.38, 0.45) (– 0.065, 0.285) B 0.285 Gradient = –b – 0.3 0.45 = = – 0.52 – 0.065–(– 0.38) Therefore, From the b graph, = the 0.2 0.52 y-intercept = 0.25 0. 1 lg A = 0.25 A = 10 0.25 Therefore, = 1.78 0 In the event that measurement point A is the from chosen. y-intercept the The graph, a cannot point y-intercept lg T = lg A – b lg x 0.45 = lg – 0.52 lg A = 0.252 A = 10 A is be on determined the line calculated is as by direct chosen. follows: Suppose 0.4 the 0.3 0.2 0. 1 0 log (x / m) Figure 20.1.2 (– 0.38) 0.252 = 1.79 177 Analysis and interpretation: Practice exam questions Answers to questions that require calculation can be found on the accompanying CD. 1 A system is oscillating such that the period T is related by the following expression: n T = , kx where x is the length of the oscillator in mm, and k and n are constants. The length shows 2 the x is varied and the period T is measured. The table below results. x/mm 200 250 300 350 400 450 500 T/s 0.622 0.696 0.762 0.823 0.880 0.933 0.984 a Plot b Use A a the graph resonant tube movable a suitable given is to is length adjusted that determine loudspeaker allow the so that f. The length of is placed resonance occurs. length of the tube below Fundamental frequency you value l, the frequency of the measured. The table Length will such that the piston. A frequency is graph l/m of k air determine and inside sound and n. [8] it [4] can be varied using end of the tube. coming from the Resonance occurs is varied k n. at the opened shows the f/Hz to a For loudspeaker at the fundamental and the fundamental frequency results of the experiment. 429 286 215 172 143 0.20 0.30 0.40 0.50 0.60 1 a Plot a graph of against l. [4] f b 3 Use In an of the experiment copper, at various results 4 graph an to determine measure electric times are to is shown heater the is specific used measured. The in the table speed to of sound heat heat electric it in the capacity and heater the is tube. of rated at 90 180 270 360 420 Temp 26.2 49.2 72.3 95.3 118 134 a Plot b Use c Determine A long a graph the of graph tube temperature to the is filled radii are determine heat with the viscous fluid. When time The taken for results radius time of them the r/mm t/s –1 velocity v/cm s –1 lg (v/cm s lg (r/mm) ) to against the capacity to the of reach specific the travel T 150 W. The [4] heat block of are falling through are capacity a small with distance shown in the of copper. [5] copper. terminal velocity spheres experiment block time. a viscous fluid. Several allowed 1.5 kg below. 0 T/°C a [5] temperature Time/s different 178 the of metal spheres when falling terminal 90.0 cm table [1] below. 1.00 1.50 2.00 2.50 3.00 60.0 26.7 15.0 9.6 6.7 of through velocity, is the measured. Analysis In this experiment, sphere by the terminal the following velocity v is related to the radius and r of interpretation: Practice exam questions the equation: n v 5 = kr , where a Copy b Plot c Determine In is an and a a and to of value to the recorded. The is moved closer is constants. the table. that of k edge of a [5] will allow and measure string. The is experiment are graph the experiment piece n complete suitable attached by k of the table. The modulus 300 g the corresponding vertical to determine k and n. [4] [3] table. A l to n. the Young length you mass metre is of repeated for various values l and of l wood, a attached rule distance values of hanging d is d are and metre to free over rule end the recorded. The table string recorded. The d l d d/m 0.060 0.050 0.032 0.020 0.011 0.005 l/m 0.800 0.750 0.650 0.550 0.450 0.350 3 l 3 /m Width of ruler Thickness It is of known w = ruler that 3 cm t d = 6 mm and l are related by the following equation: 4mg d where due in to m, a m ( = is the gravity, and Copy 3 3 Ewt t is mass E is the and ) l attached the Young thickness complete of the the metre modulus the ruler rule in of wood, in m. kg, w g is is the the acceleration width of the ruler table. [5] 3 6 b Plot c Determine d Use An graph your alloy length are a in of table d to the form wire to is the below against gradient graph the attached The of the l . of estimate of a wire 1.80 m wire shows line obtained. the Young is and and the [5] the attached its the [3] modulus to a diameter rigid is of wood. [3] support. The 0.5 mm. Several corresponding extension x is original weights measured. results. F/N 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 x/mm 0.40 0.70 1. 10 1.45 1.80 2.30 3.30 5. 10 a Plot a graph b Estimate the c Use graph your of F against work to F done x. in [4] stretching determine the the Young wire by modulus 3.0 mm. [3] of [4] the alloy. 179 List of physical constants −11 Universal gravitational constant G = 6.67 × 10 g = 9.80 m s = 6380 km = 5.98 2 N m –2 kg –2 Acceleration Radius of due the to gravity Earth R E 24 Mass of the Earth M × 10 kg E 22 Mass of the Moon M = 7.35 × 10 kg M 5 Atmosphere atm = 1.00 × 10 –2 N m –23 Boltzmann’s constant k = 1.38 × 10 –1 J K 9 Coulomb constant = 9.00 × 10 2 N m –2 C –31 Mass of the electron m = 9.11 × 10 kg e –19 Electron charge e = 1.60 × 10 C 3 Density of water = 1.00 × 10 Resistivity of steel = 1.98 × 10 Resistivity of copper = 1.80 × 10 = 400 W m –3 kg m –7 Ω m –8 Ω m –1 Thermal conductivity of copper –1 K –1 –1 Specific heat capacity of aluminium = 910 J kg K Specific heat capacity of copper = 387 J kg Specific heat capacity of water = 4200 J kg Specific latent heat of fusion = 3.34 × 10 Specific latent heat of vaporisation = 2.26 × 10 –1 –1 K –1 –1 K 5 of ice –1 J kg 6 of water –1 J kg 23 Avogadro constant N = 6.02 × 10 per mole A 8 Speed of light in free space c = 3.00 × 10 = 4π = 8.85 × 10 h = 6.63 × 10 u = 1.66 × 10 –1 m s –7 Permeability of free space μ × 10 –1 H m 0 12 Permittivity of free space ε –1 F m 0 –34 The Planck constant J s –27 Unified atomic mass constant kg –27 Rest mass of proton m = 1.67 × 10 R = 8.31 J K σ = 5.67 × 10 = 1.67 × 10 kg p –1 Molar gas constant –1 mol –8 Stefan–Boltzmann constant –2 W m –27 Mass of neutron m n 180 kg –4 K Glossary A Destructive C out Absolute refractive index The ratio of Centre of gravity The point speed of light in a vacuum to the which all the weight of a body speed of light 180°, in the The medium. lowest to temperature or a number a Waves phase meet difference path of difference half of an wavelengths) act. giving zero (with appears odd Absolute interference phase through of the of Centripetal force The a reduced or zero resultant unbalanced force displacement. possible (0 K or –273. 15 °C). required to keep an object moving in a Diffraction Acceleration The rate of change of circular The wavefronts velocity. Charles’ law The volume of a fixed The eye’s ability to of gas is directly proportional to of an the shape of its lens in order to absolute temperature, provided produce a focused image measure of on the the retina. closeness the pressure Coherent is kept waves object a the measured value to the true that have and difference the gap. piece of number glass of or equally line drawn. the hence a between This is the distance constant moved from phase a constant. Waves same frequency value. of passes through A large Displacement of or grating with spaced The out wave that plastic Accuracy a its Diffraction adjust when mass edge Accommodation spreading path. a fixed point in a stated them. direction. Air resistance A force which opposes Compression The region on a Drag force the motion of an object moving longitudinal wave where the motion through air. are moving towards each A solid where there is a Conduction The process by arrangement of the atoms thermal energy flows in an which object in opposes the a fluid. a material A material that can which be random of other. Ductile Amorphous A force particles easily stretched and formed into a solid from wire. throughout Amplitude from the the The structure. maximum equilibrium a displacement position. region region the of of higher lower temperature temperature movement of the to a E without material itself. Efficiency Angle of incidence The angle between Constructive interference Waves output the incident ray and the normal. in phase (with a phase difference reflection The angle between zero, or a path difference of a reflected ray and the normal. number of wavelengths) ratio the of power collision A giving energy is refraction The angle between greater resultant refracted ray and the normal. Convection The collision process by The rate of change of displacement. thermal of energy flows from higher temperature to a a Positions midway between lower temperature due to its to the on a stationary is wave. The maximum at this movement point. density of the fluid as the a is and size removed it. of potential energy The energy bulk result of by a body when deformed. a Electric amplitude material shape external force possessed nodes The original region region Elastic Antinode which which from angular in a when Angular velocity power displacement. returns the useful conserved. Elastic deformation Angle of the input. whole kinetic the to of Elastic Angle of The meet current The rate of flow of change. charge. Archimedes’ principle When a body Couple Two equal and opposite forces Electric is totally or partially submerged in a whose lines of action do not potential possessed fluid, it experiences an upthrust which Critical angle The angle of equal to the weight of the fluid which the angle of by a charged refraction is in an a ray travelling from a energy due to its electric field. 90° for Electromagnetic displaced. The body incidence for position is energy coincide. dense to spectrum less Electromagnetic waves arranged in 23 Avogadro constant 6.02 × 10 per mole optically dense medium. order Critical damping The system comes of Electromagnetic rest after one Crystalline Are kilogram, metre, wave solid The atoms, ions of oscillating mole and that and or magnetic fields ampere, wave electric second, molecules kelvin, A oscillation. consists units wavelengths. to B Base their are arranged in a at right angles to each regular candela. other. pattern Black body A perfect absorber that repeats itself within the of Electron diffusion A mechanism by crystal. thermal radiation. which Boiling A substance absorbs energy state from a liquid to a in a change in law The temperature. pressure of place gas Damping The process whereby a fixed mass amplitude of an oscillating A line drawn through the points Boyle’s takes metals. Equipotential without conduction and D changes thermal having the same gravitational system potential. of gas is inversely proportional to its decreases over time. Energy volume, provided that the temperature Degree Celsius A unit used to The capacity or ability to do measure work. is kept constant. temperature. Evaporation Brownian motion The haphazard Density The mass per unit liquid motion of particles. Derived quantities Physical changes than the base process into a by gas which a without quantities reaching other The volume. its boiling point. quantities. 181 Glossary F Mechanical I a First law of thermodynamics The Ideal gas A gas that obeys the gas wave substance A wave through that which requires to laws. propagate. change in internal energy of a system Image distance Distance between the Molar is equal to the energy supplied to the image and the optical centre of heat thermal system plus the work done on the capacity energy the Impulse The product of a force and A standard degree to of increase temperature of for which it acts on an of one mole of a time substance point amount required lens. system. Fixed The the by one degree. object. Molar heat capacity of a gas at constant hotness that can easily be reproduced. Inelastic collision A collision in which pressure Focal length The distance between the kinetic energy is not The amount of energy conserved. required to raise the temperature of one optical centre of the lens and the focal Inertia The reluctance of a body to mole of a gas by one degree, when the point of the lens. start moving when it is at rest or the pressure remains constant. Free body diagram A diagram showing reluctance of a body to stop moving Molar heat capacity of a gas at constant the forces acting on a body. when it is in motion. volume Frequency The number of oscillations Intensity The power per unit The amount of energy required area. to raise the temperature of one mole of per unit time. Internal energy The random a gas by one degree when the volume Frequency response The range of distribution of the kinetic and remains constant. frequencies that can be detected by potential energies of the particles that Mole the human ear. make up the The amount contains Friction A force which opposes of substance that substance. the same number of particles motion. in 12 g of carbon-12. K Fundamental frequency The lowest Moment frequency that a vibrating string can product of a force and the or Kelvin pipe The The SI unit of perpendicular temperature. distance of the line of produce. Kinetic body energy by Energy virtue of its possessed by a action of Monomer motion. the force from The unit that a pivot. repeats itself in G Kinetic theory of Geostationary satellite A satellite that assumes that a gases gas is A theory made up that a polymer. of N has to a period be at the of 24 hours same point and appears above the many at small high particles moving randomly speeds. Natural frequency Earth all the The frequency with time. which a system oscillates without L Global warming The increase in applying temperature of the Earth as a result Latent the greenhouse Gravitational field heat where a The The region the periodic driving energy mass state of a required to Newton substance The force required to give a around –2 without body external force. effect. change a an of experiences a change in mass temperature. of 1 kg an acceleration of 1 m s . a Lattice vibration A mechanism Newton’s first by law A body stays at rest force. which Gravitational field strength in acting per unit thermal solids without free potential The work moving unit mass from infinity if moving uniform continues velocity to unless move acted with upon The amplitude of an the by external force. a eventually period of decreases to zero Newton’s of time. law of attraction gravitation between two The force bodies is point. Linear Gravitational potential energy momentum of a body by virtue of in a mass which of directly a proportional to their masses and velocity. A wave in which the inversely square of the proportional distance to the between them. gravitational field. effect The heat gets trapped or in the in the same direction Newton’s second law The rate the energy of transfer. change of mome ntum is in Loudness greenhouse are process as by and wave oscillations Greenhouse product its Longitudinal position The The body’s energy a or to over a place done oscillation in takes electrons. mass. Light damping Gravitational conduction The force The subjective sensation of proportional to the appl ied fo rce and Earth’s sound that depends of sound. on the amplitude takes place in the directio n in which atmosphere. the Lower fixed the point The temperature force acts. Newton’s third law If a body A exerts a H of Harmonic The nth harmonic is n times pure melting atmospheric ice at standard Node M and the Mass The amount of matter substance by one degree. in a body. It is a measure then body opposite force on a B on is energy wave zero. of a replenished Energy that (fossil fuels). body’s Normal to be A line drawn at right angles inertia. a oscillate. Mean Hooke’s law The extension produced square speed 2 c 1 2 + c 2 2 + c 3 2 proportional to force applied, provided surface. Normal is 〈c 〉 A force the 182 elastic limit is not exceeded. that acts N at = reaction 2 + … + c right angles when one N that an body A. stationary amplitude exerts contained cannot system fails B, Non-renewable required to increase the temperature of a The body Positions where The amount of heat energy Heavy damping on equal pressure. the fundamental frequency. Heat capacity force contact with another. body is in to Glossary provided O the Object distance that no external forces act on system. Specific latent heat of fusion energy required to convert The unit mass Distance between the Principle of moments For a body (1 kg) of a substance from a solid to object and the optical centre of the lens. that Oscillation An object is moving is in equilibrium, clockwise and forth about a fixed The notes other than is sum equal of to the liquid without the Specific latent a change in temperature. heat of vaporisation of the anticlockwise moments The energy required to convert unit the about fundamental moments point. sum Overtone the back the same pivot. mass (1 kg) of a substance from a note. Progressive energy is wave A wave in transferred from which one liquid point to to a vapour without a change in temperature. P another. The Path difference wave profile moves. Speed The Stefan’s The difference in distance rate law of The change rate at of distance. which energy R is travelled by two waves that interfere. Period The time taken to complete proportional one Radian cycle Phase or A The angle subtended at oscillation that of the the fraction has been of centre of a length to the circle by an arc equal in of the An error that occurs as φ × result 2π of the experimenter and property of an or phenomenon that can error that with an The depends on below sensation of the frequency The region on wave where the moving away from each return to its original shape An image where the pass the external force is The change wave when in travelling direction To restrict the oscillations of of between because Polymers A wave to one material chains of the of a Energy one index The body by virtue of its at that of the of error unit charge electrical in The Relative density by a or position. work done converting from to rate which at other forms. work is Renewable energy natural sources geothermal, Resonance Energy (sunlight, amplitude system the frequency the The degree of the of a of is waves, of vectors wind, velocity falling a fluid. driver The force acting normally per Root acting mean The on a in of square by an object when the of conductivity heat per vector unit The area rate per of unit system. sum of gradient, when the heat the is at right angles to the faces of a body. parallel-sided slab of the material, speed steady state conditions. area. 2 c mass law of gas The is pressure directly of a fixed 〈c √ 2 + c 1 2 Pressure 〉 = 2 + c 2 2 Thermal + … + c 3 its absolute The condition N under √ equilibrium which two objects in physical N proportional contact to maximum reached matches under unit The constant thin Pressure of an enhanced the natural frequency Resultant vector result. hotness body. flow reproducibility of derived from temperature measure in etc.). The oscillating being done. The error The ratio of the density flow Precision wave. constant of a substance with the density of water. state energy the direction. Thermal Power is individual each A Terminal velocity per resultant point T of possessed The more ratio a Potential difference or the sin r consists molecules. energy two point, two Temperature Potential a change sin i plane. that per area. wave. a Refractive transverse at sum Systematic speed length. of it. Polarise When arrive displacements occurs unit normally it. removed and per acting cross-sectional algebraic in long through size media from The force displacement a when Stress rays does and and opposite superimpose. extension Superposition image Refraction not in other. the actually material and The waves The when particles sound. Plastic deformation wave formed same frequency travelling Strain unit Real A the a sound of of expressed the instrument. subjective of are directions are that or be longitudinal Pitch above power body value. Rarefaction measured is an true object wave waves amplitude in The the results λ Physical quantity of kelvin. two = is a π Phase difference the fourth temperature Stationary error body circle. completed. Random black in the radius to a the revolution. measure radiated from temperature, with each other exchange no provided heat energy. The two objects are at the S that the volume is kept constant. same Principal axis A line that passes centre of curvature of a lens light is neither reflected are said to be A quantity that has in thermal equilibrium. such magnitude that and through Scalar quantity the temperature only. Thermal radiation The process by nor Simple harmonic motion Period motion which thermal energy is transferred refracted. in which the acceleration is proportional Principle of to the displacement from a fixed point energy Energy can neither be destroyed, but can be one form to of of high low temperature temperature by waves. The International System of Units. Thermistor A non-linear device with a another. Snell’s law The ratio thermally is a sensitive resistor. constant. sin r For any system, the momentum before collision is after heat capacity The amount of measuring A device used for temperature. equal heat momentum Thermocouple total Specific the region conservation of momentum to a region electromagnetic sin i Principle of a converted SI units from to created and directed to the fixed point. nor from conservation of energy required to increase the Thermodynamic scale A temperature collision, temperature one degree. of 1 kg of a substance by scale that properties is independent of any of particular the substance. 183 Glossary Thermoelectric of an are e.m.f. joined The two generation dissimilar metals together. Thermometric property effect when varies A physical continuously Triple with wave oscillations direction property that Transverse at are of wave energy point of which A ice, in which perpendicular to the the water The and Virtual temperature water The rate of change of displacement. transfer. water Velocity image appear to An pass image where the rays through. vapour W temperature. Threshold of are hearing The minimum in thermal equilibrium (273. 16 K or 0.01 °C. Wavelength intensity of sound that can The distance between two be successive crests or troughs. U detected by the human ear. Weight Threshold of pain The Upper fixed intensity at which pain is the point The temperature an Timbre steam The subjective sensation sound that depends on the number Torque of a produced couple above pure boiling with The a atmospheric water at pressure. Work The distance A force acting vertically product and on an object placed in of of a force and the between A quantity that has and incidence within the angle, is the greater ray is than the internally A triangle showing denser three forces medium direction. the Vector triangle of modulus Tensile the magnitude When direction of the Y two forces. reflection the V one Vector quantity internal in a fluid. note. product distance moved force. Young the forces 184 on of upwards overtones angle gravity of Upthrust Total by ear. standard of exerted object. experienced of in The force minimum critical reflected. acting on an object. by tensile strain. stress divided Index Headings in bold indicate glossary terms. cast iron 170 cataracts destructive 105 cathode-ray oscilloscopes (CRO) 10, 70 interference diffraction 82, 83, dimensions 4–5 84–5, 86, 87 , 88, 89 91 A CD players centre of absolute refractive absolute zero index displacement 83 gravity 38, 16–17 , 62–4, graphs 67 , 76 17 72 centripetal acceleration 48–9 distance 16 135 centripetal force absorbers 9, displacement–time 39 49 diverging lenses 102, 103 154 changes acceleration 17 , 18–19, of charged centripetal acceleration gravitation 55 circuits, division, uncertainty 15 objects law 30 134, double electrical 135 slit experiments drag force 86, 90–1 71 drivers 37 69 104 circular accuracy of 126 48–9 Charles’ accommodation state 62–3 measurements motion 48–53, 65 ductile materials 170, 171 12–13 coefficient of resistance coefficient of thermal 114 dynamics 26–33 addition scalars conductivity 149 6 E coherent uncertainty 6, 32–3 7 ears combining air resistance vectors Earth echoes concave energy lenses amorphous solids amperes 10 efficiency angle of 116 45 collision 33 29 elastic deformation 76, pendulums electric conservation of energy conservation of momentum reflection angle of refraction electric current electrical velocity constant-volume gas thermometers 29 measurement proportionality electromagnetic spectrum 10 electromagnetic waves 96 116 angles of 10, quantity 17 72 constants 71 32 73 constant angles circuits 42 72 angle of 170–1 51 93 incidence critical 57 , 152–3 elastic conical 64, 56, 95 103 148–50, 163 conductors amplitude 102, 43 conduction (A) 54, 78 52–3 alternative 100–1 6 37 compression aircraft 86 14 collisions vectors waves 96–7 , 154 54 73 electron diffusion 148–9 constructive interference 86, 87 , 88, 89 measurement 9 emitters continuous flow projectile motion converging angular velocity 92, of units lenses equations of state cooling curves cooling effects F 41 angle fields, (cathode-ray focal conductors focal currents, 126, Bourdon 128, gauges ocean law 134, 129 D 165 materials 170, motion 102 102 focus depth force 36–41 104 centripetal force charged time sea breezes objects 49 30 151 171 circular deformations Brownian length point 68 135 day brittle 164 151 155–6 damped oscillations Boyle’s pressure 94 29 43 154, motion 51 170–1 163 dynamics degrees Celsius (°C) 26–7 112 gravitational force C density depth of field depth of focus of 38–9 10–11 104 vectors cameras 40–1 104 polygons curves 30 162 moment calibration 57 29 9 radiation 54–5, 111 70 flutes 10, 110, 163 2 body boiling 10, points fluids, solids current-carrying black oscilloscopes) 4 current 104 gravitation 68 fixed quantities balances biofuels depths 73 52–3 crystalline beam 102–5 104 couples CRO units 12–13 129 129 critically damped oscillations base 128, 3 165 physical measurement 126 field base in evaporation critical barometers 154 57 71 eyes aircraft 135 110, 102 errors B of 41, 3 36 cornea banking 171 20–1 103 105 constant 148–59, motion 42 104 principle 67 , of equipotentials cookers Avogadro 42–5, equations equilibrium convex astigmatism 102, energy 93 humour Archimedes’ of 48 conversion antinodes lenses 64 conversion 6, 151 7 angular frequency aqueous 148, 154 122–3 energy convection vectors methods 23 6, 7 103 derived quantities/units 2, 14 185 Index force–extension force–time free graphs (F–t) body diagrams free fall 170 graphs methods horizontal 28 projectile hydroelectric 38 motion energy hypermetropia specific 22–3 heat logarithmic 43 capacity responses long-sightedness 105 longitudinal 55 120–3, 124–5 101 105 waves 76, 78–81, 95 I free oscillations loudness 62 frequency 64, frequency response 69, 76, 92, 95, 94, lower fixed 101 ice 111, 127 , 128, 101 point (ice point) 111 130 100 ideal gases 118, 134–9 M friction 36–7 impulse fuel 28 43 in fundamental frequencies 92, 94, phase waves incidence fundamental notes 92, specific angles 82 magnetic 72 resonance magnifying glasses imaging (MRI) 71 103 94 indices fusion, 77 , 95 latent heat of 72 manometers 165 127 industry, sound inelastic waves collision 94 marbles, 33 mass oscillations 29, 62 30 G inertia gamma gases rays 118, 97 of internal 128 molar heat capacity matter thermodynamics geostationary iron 144 162, 97 oscillations 100, 101 phases 118 of thermal 170 mean lamina, 66–7 , 70 9 62 matter 86–7 energy systems measurement 94 irregular-shaped 163 centre of gravity 39 140–1 satellites 96, levels interference 136–9 heat of intensity 126 latent phases mass-spring waves instruments state theory 29 infrared 134–9 changes kinetic 96, 162–71 properties square measurements mechanical 57 speed melting 118–31 136–7 8–15 waves 76 126 K geothermal glass energy 43 mercury-in-glass 170 metals kelvin gliders, oscillations (K) 62 metre kinematics global positioning satellites (GPS) global warming energy 44, 158–9 models 129, kinetic theory of force–time graphs 17 , 96, 8 97 specific heat capacity molar heat capacity 144 149 11 mole sea breezes heat 3 151 126–9, 40–1 130–1 momentum 17 lattice vibrations graphs gauges 89, methods, moment motion velocity–time 71, 124–5 176–7 line screw microwaves 136–9 28 relationships latent straight 134, L land, plotting gases 63 lagging non-linear micrometre mixing graphs 8 64 162–3 170–1 displacement–time (m) 67 graphs deformations rules metres kinetic 116 16–25 57 kinetic thermometers 168 112 26–7 , 32 148 monatomic 18–19 gases 139 laws gratings, diffraction 84–5, monochromatic 91 gravitation gravitation monomers motion gravitational constant 26–7 , gravitational field 29, 32, motion strength 116 circular equations LCDs (liquid crystal potential gravity, centres of 38, 26–7 , projectile simple 102, 29, 32, 49 22–5 103 44–5 lenses 65 8 56 energy 48–53, 20–1 81 laws potential measurement lens formulae gravitational displays) 30 length gravitational motion 140–5 54–5 gravitational force 17 73 thermodynamics gravitational fields 90–1 163 49 54 refraction light 54 54–7 103, harmonic 62, 63, 65, 67 104 39 MRI (magnetic resonance imaging) light greenhouse guitars effect 158 multiplication, diffraction gratings double experiments musical 86, polarisation refraction harmonic notes 80–1 N 94 capacity narrow (C) 118–25, graph loss momentum Newton, crystal displays (LCDs) night liquid-in-glass 83 69 Isaac 26–7 , 29, 32, 81 126 heavily damped oscillations diffraction 26 153 curves gap 11 natural frequency liquid heating plotting 144–5 linear heat 68 100–1 linear heat 94 104 72–3 lightly damped oscillations hearing instruments 90–1 myopia H 15 84–5 94 slit uncertainty thermometers 68 114, time sea breezes 151 115 nodes 92, 93 liquids helicopters 30 noise changes homogeneous equations of law non-crystalline circular motion heat 128, solids 129, relationships non-renewable matter 11 130–1 50 of 163 151 non-linear phases 186 currents 166 latent horizontal 126 5 convection Hooke’s state 101 162–3 energy 42 49, 54 71 Index non-uniform normal velocity reactions 17 speed radians normals 16–17 , 9, 92, 148, 154–7 damping 94 waves 96, 70 97 mass-spring O random errors 12, currents rarefactions 78 ray 103 direction vectors diagrams spring balances waves 78 images 102 73, waves phase waves 77 , state changes angles 72–3, state equations 73 92, 94, index relative density P renewable energy 111, thermometers 114–15, projectiles pan 22–5 resistive force 51, conductors interference 63, 29 86–7 66 resolution of resonance resonance instruments law vectors instruments 94 line motion 48, 63, 64, 166–7 , 170–1 stress 166–7 , 170–1 68–71 tubes 94, resultant vectors 76 ripple 17 strain 95 tanks 83, graphs 170–1 6 stringed periods 94 156 7 stress–strain percussion 150 128 36–7 straight pendulums 95 149, 116 Stefan’s current-carrying conditions 42 steel resistance state 162 steam 100 path difference, 92–3, 72 steady parallel waves 95 refractive pain thresholds 135 95 stationary parabolic 95 126 82 refraction overtones 92–3, 95 62–71 reflection of 9 102 reflection out 70 7 standing centres oscillations 66–7 , 62 151 real optical systems 13 oscillations opposite 136–7 springs musical radio ocean 91 77 , 48 72 radiation notes, spectrometers R 29 instruments 94 88 subtraction periods of oscillation 63, 76 rockets 30 scalars phase 77 , 82 root mean square (r.m.s.) speed 6 136–7 uncertainty phase difference 77 roots, uncertainty vectors phases of matter 162–71 rubber 14 15 6 170 superposition physical quantities/units systematic pitch errors plastic deformations 170–1 direction vectors 7 thermometers satellites 56, 57 temperature 114–15, 110–31, 6–7 conduction polarisation breezes 148, 151 81 second-order diffracted light 91 energy lenses transfer 148–59 102 seconds (s) 10 equilibrium of force 110, 154 38–9 semi-crystalline polymers 163 heat polymeric materials polymers 163 170, loss 153 171 SHM (simple harmonic motion) 62, 63, measurement 65, gravitational 56, 10–11 154–7 57 short-sightedness 104 temperature potential difference 9, 67 radiation potential, 152–3 151 convection 80, 148–50, 80 sea polygons 135 116 scalar quantities P, 13 T same platinum-resistance pole 12, S 94 Polaroid 82 2–7 coefficients of resistance 10 SI units 2, 64 114 potential energy 44–5, 67 sight 102–5 tensile power 42, 44, 45, stresses 166 102 simple harmonic motion (SHM) 62, terminal velocity powers, uncertainty 63, 65, measurements 148–50, slit diffraction 152–3 84 thermal convection 148, thermal energy loss thermal energy transfer 151 3 Snell’s pressure kinetic law 72 153 164–5 solar theory 136, heat energy 42, 43, 159 148–59 137–8 solar molar conduction 12–13 single prefixes 37 67 thermal precision of 36, 15 capacity water heaters 159 thermal equilibrium thermal radiation 110, 154 144 solids p V diagrams 144–5 changes of state 126 thermistors thermodynamics 115 140 latent heat 128, 130 thermocouples Pressure law principal axes of matter 162, specific moments progressive waves thermodynamic scales heat capacity thermodynamics 112, 112 121 waves 88, 89, 94–5 thermoelectric 76, 79, heat capacity 115 118–25 thermometers 10–11, 112, 114–17 , 124, 22–5 specific latent heat 127 , 130–1 153, proportionality effect 93 specific motion 140–5 40–1 sound constants 154 54 specific latent heat of fusion specific latent heat of vaporisation 127 thermometric V 116 163 102 principle of p 115, 134–5 phases projectile 154–7 (pressure–volume) diagrams properties 110, 111 144–5 127 , threshold of hearing threshold of pain 100, 101 130–1 Q 100 spectra timbre quantities 2–7 electromagnetic 96 time radiation 94 67 155–6 displacement–time graphs 17 , 63 187 Index force–time graphs measurement velocity–time torque 40, 28 V W 10 graphs vacuum flasks 158 vaporisation, specific latent heat 127 , internal reflection waves 76, wavelengths vector triangles vehicles manometers 16–19, waves waves 38 weight 48, 62–3 graphs 96, callipers 72, 76–97 , 76, 90–1, 93 154 9, 29 wide gap diffraction wind energy wind instruments 83 43 18–19 8 work 42, 94 43 97 vertical uncertainty circular motion 50 14–15 X virtual circular motion images 102 49 visible electromagnetic waves 96, 97 X-rays analysis 96, 97 4–5 vitreous units 72, 94 vernier unit 159 159 165 velocity–time uniform 6–7 52 velocity ultraviolet 128, 78–81 U ultrasound heaters 73 vector quantities transverse U-tube 72, water 41 130–1 total water 18–19 humour 104 2–7 volts unpolarised waves (V) Y 10 80 volume upper fixed point (steam point) 111 Young measurement upthrust modulus Young’s molar p V heat capacity diagrams 166–9 9 36 double slit experiment 144 144–5 Z thermodynamics 140 zero-order 188 diffracted light 91 86, 90–1 Physics for Unit 1 CAPE® Achieve your potential Developed guide in will CAPE® exclusively provide Physics, Written by an Physics syllabus information key designed ● Engaging the ● ● to the with and an additional team outcomes activities of examination, easy-to-use enhance Caribbean Examinations support to Council®, maximise your this study performance 1. experienced in learning you Unit with from your that teachers this study double-page the study help syllabus of you the and guide Each contains subject , the in covers format . and develop experts such a the all CAPE® the topic range essential begins of with features as: analytical skills required for examination Examination tips with essential advice on succeeding in your assessments Did You Know? boxes to expand your knowledge and encourage further study This study choice also questions examiner Physics The guide and feedback, includes sample to build a fully interactive examination skills and answers confidence Caribbean Examinations Thornes subjects at to CSEC® produce and a Council series (CXC®) of with in O x f o rd has Study multiple- accompanying preparation for the CAPE® worked Guides exclusively across a wide with range of CAPE®. How of incorporating examination. Nelson Pa r t CD, University P re s s to get in touch: web www.oup.com/caribbean email schools.enquiries.uk@oup.com tel +44 (0)1536 452620 fax +44 (0)1865 313472